(a) General
requirements. Accessory uses and structures may be developed as permitted
in this section provided such uses are located on the same lot or
parcel of land as the principal use, and such uses are incidental
to, and do not alter, the use of land as permitted within the specific
district in which they are located.
(b) Accessory
structures.
(1) Attached accessory structures. A fully-enclosed, attached accessory
structure shall be made structurally a part of the main building and
shall comply in all respects with the requirements of this chapter
applicable to the principal structure. Open patio covers shall be
regulated by subsection (d) of this section. Decks shall be regulated
by subsection (f) of this section.
(2) Detached accessory structures. Detached accessory structures shall
satisfy all of the following requirements:
(A) Shall not exceed the height of the principal structure on the building
site;
(B) Shall conform to the front and side yard requirements of the applicable
district;
(C) Shall maintain a minimum separation of six feet between the detached
accessory structure and the main building; and
(D) If less than 450 square feet in gross floor area, the structure shall
be located a minimum distance from the parcel’s rear property
line equal to the height of the structure. However, if the structure
is 450 square feet or more in gross floor area, the structure shall
conform to the same rear yard setback requirement as required for
main buildings in the applicable district.
(E) For detached fireplaces and landscape structures with a height less
than six feet, they shall maintain the minimum side yard setback for
the district, and maintain a minimum five foot rear yard setback.
If the height is greater than six feet, said structures shall comply
with subparagraph (2)(D) above.
(F) Recreational play structures including swings, playgrounds, etc.,
shall maintain the same side yard setback for the district, with a
minimum five foot rear yard setback.
(d) Patio
covers. Patio covers may be erected as accessory structures in conjunction
with the principal use on the building site subject to the following
requirements:
(1) A wholly enclosed covered patio shall maintain the same yard requirements
as set forth for the main structure.
(2) An open patio cover may be erected within the required rear yard
to a minimum of five feet from the rear property line. Such structure
shall maintain the same front and side yards as required for the principal
structure on the building site.
(3) Patio covers located within the Planned Community (PC) District,
Multiple Family (RM) District, or Affordable Family/Senior Housing
(AF/SH) District where individual lots for each residential units
are not created shall be permitted only upon the approval of a site
plan and building designs by the Planning Commission. Issuance of
building permits shall be approved upon a finding of consistency with
the Planning Commission approved plans.
(e) Tennis
courts. The tennis courts permitted in the Agri-Business (A), Residential/Agriculture
(RA), Hillside Residential (HR), Single-Family-40,000 (RSE-40,000),
Single-Family-20,000 (RSE-20,000), Single-Family-10,000 (RS-10,000),
Single-Family-7,000 (RS-7,000), and Single-Family-4,000 (RS-4,000)
districts shall conform to the following development standards:
(1) Location. No tennis court shall be permitted to encroach into the
rear, side, or front yard setback. In addition, tennis courts shall
be located no closer than 40 feet from any dwelling on an adjacent
lot.
(2) Grading: The total depth of fill area shall not exceed four feet
in height. The use of retaining walls to support this fill is prohibited.
The total depth of cut area shall not exceed 12 feet in height, provided
the cut slope or retaining wall is not visible from adjoining properties.
Tennis courts shall not be located on areas where the natural slope
is in excess of 25%.
(3) Fences. The fencing around tennis courts shall not exceed 12 feet
in height and shall be screened, unless otherwise approved by the
Environmental Administrator.
(4) Lighting. The maximum height for tennis court lighting (fixture and
pole) shall not exceed 18 feet. All such lights shall be shielded
so as to confine all direct rays to the subject property and minimize
spillover outside of the tennis court area.
(5) Required review. All tennis courts not requiring a conditional use
permit shall be reviewed by the Environmental Administrator to determine
compliance with the standards set forth in this subsection and to
set conditions to minimize adverse impacts of tennis courts on nearby
properties. Such conditions of approval may include such items as
screening and landscaping.
(f) Decks.
For purposes of this subsection, “decks” shall mean any
platform construction more than 30 inches above finished grade. Decks
may be erected as accessory structures in conjunction with the principal
use on the building site subject to the following requirements:
(1) Attached decks.
(A) Setbacks.
(i)
Front yard setback. Attached decks shall conform to the front
yard requirements of the applicable district.
(ii)
Side yard setback. If an attached deck is 450 square feet or
more in gross floor area, the deck shall conform with the side yard
requirement of the applicable district. If the attached deck is less
than 450 square feet in gross floor area, the deck may extend into
a side yard not more than 40% of the applicable district requirement
or three feet, whichever is greater.
(iii)
Rear yard setback. If an attached deck is less than 450 square
feet in gross floor area, the deck may be located a minimum distance
from the rear property line equal to the height of the structure from
finish grade or a minimum of five feet, whichever is greater. However,
if the deck is 450 square feet or more in gross floor area, the deck
shall conform to the same rear yard setback requirement as required
for the principal structure in the applicable district.
(B) Attached decks over six feet in height measured from finished grade
shall not exceed 40% of the total length of the main building elevation
to which it is attached.
(2) Detached decks. Detached decks shall comply with the requirements
for detached accessory structures in subsection (b)(2) of this section.
(g) Additional
development standards for accessory structures in residential districts.
Accessory structures located in the Hillside Residential (HR), Single-Family-40,000
(RSE-40,000), Single-Family-20,000 (RSE-20,000), Single-Family-10,000
(RS-10,000), Single-Family-7,000 (RS-7,000), Single-Family-4,000 (RS-4,000),
Residential Garden-7,000 (RG-7,000), Residential Garden-4,000 (RG-4,000),
Multiple-Family (RM), Affordable Family/Senior Housing (AF/SH), and
Planning Community (PC) districts shall be subject to the development
standards for that district, as well as the following requirements:
(1) Exterior sides which are to enclose the structure shall be finished
with wood, stucco, masonry, or other material of similar texture and
durability.
(2) The roof material shall be wood shingle or shake, slate, tile, asphalt
shingle, or other material of similar appearance, texture, substance,
and durability.
(3) Roof eaves and gables shall be no less than 12 inches, measured from
the vertical side of the unit, unless otherwise approved by the Planning
Director or, upon referral, the Planning Commission.
(4) Exterior finish colors for accessory structures shall be the same
as the principal structure.
(5) Prohibited materials. The following building materials shall not
be used in the construction and finish of an accessory structure:
(A) Exterior sides of accessory structures shall not use metal siding
and/or exposed metal supports, cloth, canvas, plastic sheeting, corrugated
fiberglass, or corrugated metal.
(B) Roofs of accessory structures shall not use cloth, canvas, plastic
sheeting, corrugated fiberglass, or corrugated metal.
(C) The use of the above finish materials may be used upon review by
the Planning Director and confirmation by the Planning Commission
if it is determined that the material will have a finish appearance
of either wood, stucco or masonry, or is used in such a manner that
it is not visible from any off-site properties.
(D) Accessory structures listed on the inventory of historic and cultural
landmarks and/or located in designated historic districts. Existing
accessory structures located in a designated historic district or
listed on the City’s inventory of historic and cultural landmarks
shall be subject to all provisions of this section with the exception
of prohibited building materials where said material is used as a
finish material on an existing structure.
(h) Exempted
structures. An “exempted structure” shall be subject to
the following requirements:
(1) Prefabricated sheds. Prefabricated sheds with a projected roof area
of 120 square feet or less are exempt from the provisions of this
section.
(2) Awnings. Awnings that use prohibited materials shall be permitted
if they meet the following provisions:
(A) In all residential districts where the awning is structurally attached
to the principal permitted structure and does not extend more than
54 inches from the wall surface to which it is attached.
(B) In all nonresidential districts where the awning is structurally
attached to the principal permitted structure shall be subject to
review and approval by the Planning Commission and/or Planning Director
per applicable provisions of this title.
(i) Accessory structures with prohibited materials. Any existing legal nonconforming accessory structure with prohibited materials shall be subject to Section
9-3.533 Nonconforming Uses, Lots, and Structures.
(Ord. No. 869, § 2, 2002; Ord. No. 881, § 2; Ord. No. 1046, § 4, 2017; Ord. No. 1077, § 3, 2020)
(a) Purpose. The purpose of this section is to allow and regulate accessory
dwelling units (ADUs) and junior accessory dwelling units (JADUs)
in compliance with California
Government Code Sections 65852.2 and
65852.22.
(b) Effect of conforming. An ADU or JADU that conforms to the standards
in this section will not be:
(1) Deemed to be inconsistent with the City’s general plan and
zoning designation for the lot on which the ADU or JADU is located.
(2) Deemed to exceed the allowable density for the lot on which the ADU
or JADU is located.
(3) Considered in the application of any local ordinance, policy, or
program to limit residential growth.
(4) Required to correct a nonconforming zoning condition, as defined
in subsection (c)(7) below. This does not prevent the City from enforcing
compliance with applicable building standards in accordance with Health
and Safety Code Section 17980.12.
(c) Definitions. As used in this section, terms are defined as follows:
"Accessory dwelling unit" or “ADU”
means an attached or a detached residential dwelling unit
that provides complete independent living facilities for one or more
persons and is located on a lot with a proposed or existing primary
residence. An accessory dwelling unit also includes the following:
"Accessory structure"
means a structure that is accessory and incidental to a dwelling
located on the same lot, including attached or detached garages, covered
patios, storage sheds and cabanas.
"Building height"
means the vertical distance from finished grade or flood
protection elevation to the topmost point of the roof of a building
or to the highest point of a structure other than a building, as shown
in Figure 2. Chimneys, finials, and other rooftop architectural projections
are not included in determining building height.
For structures in hillside areas, allowable building height
shall be determined by connecting an imaginary line, at the applicable
building height standard, between a series of vertical lines drawn
at the uppermost and the lowermost finish grades of a building (typically
measured at a point five feet away from the vertical building wall),
as shown in Figure 3. For purposes of this definition, “hillside
area” means an area in which the average slope of the building
footprint area is 10% or more. For structures in hillside areas that
are constructed on a foundation system that include one or more retaining
walls or other retaining system, the measurement to establish allowable
building height shall be measured from five feet outside of the retaining
wall or system used to support the building.
Figure 2: Building Height on Level Lot
|
Figure 3: Building Height on Hillside
|
“Complete independent living facilities”
means permanent provisions for living, sleeping, eating,
cooking, and sanitation. Cooking provisions shall include the use
of built-in appliances such as built-in ovens or stoves, as opposed
to counter-top ovens and hot plates.
"Efficiency kitchen"
means a kitchen that includes each of the following:
(1)
A cooking facility with appliances.
(2)
A food preparation counter that is of reasonable size in relation
to the size of the junior accessory dwelling unit.
(3)
Food storage cabinets that are of reasonable size in relation
to the size of the junior accessory dwelling unit.
"Junior accessory dwelling unit" or “JADU”
means a residential unit that satisfies all of the following:
(1)
It is no more than 500 square feet in size.
(2)
It is contained entirely within an existing or proposed single-family
structure. An enclosed use within the residence, such as an attached
garage, is considered to be a part of and contained within the single-family
structure.
(3)
It includes its own separate sanitation facilities or shares
sanitation facilities with the existing or proposed single-family
structure.
(4)
If the unit does not include its own separate bathroom, then
it contains an interior entrance to the main living area of the existing
or proposed single-family structure in addition to an exterior entrance
that is separate from the main entrance to the primary dwelling.
(5)
It includes an efficiency kitchen, as defined in subsection
(c)(5) above.
"Nonconforming zoning condition"
means a physical improvement on a property that does not
conform with current zoning standards regardless of whether the nonconforming
condition was lawfully created in compliance with all applicable ordinances
and laws at the time the lot or physical improvement was created.
"Public transit stop"
means a location, including, but not limited to, a bus stop
or train station, where the public may access buses, trains, subways,
and other forms of transportation that charge set fares, run on fixed
routes, and are available to the public.
(d) Review process. The following two review processes apply to proposed
ADUs and JADUs under this section:
(1) Building permit review. The following four categories of ADUs or
JADUs are allowed with only a building permit if all of the general
requirements listed in subsection (e) below are met:
(A) Integrated ADUs and JADUs on single-family lots. One detached or
attached ADU with no maximum size limit and one JADU is allowed on
a lot that contains a proposed or existing single-family dwelling,
regardless of the underlying residential zoning, if the integrated
ADU and JADU meets all of the following requirements:
(i)
Location. The ADU and JADU is located either:
a.
Within the space of a proposed single-family dwelling, or
b.
Within the space of an existing single-family dwelling, or
c.
In the case of an ADU only, within the space of an accessory
structure as defined in subsection(c)(2), plus up to 150 square feet
of additional habitable floor area to accommodate ingress and egress;
(ii)
Has exterior access that is independent of that for the single-family
dwelling;
(iii)
Has minimum interior side and rear setbacks sufficient for fire
and safety, as dictated by applicable building and fire codes; and
(B) New Detached ADUs on single-family lots. One detached, new-construction
ADU is allowed on a lot with a proposed or existing single-family
dwelling (in addition to any JADU that might otherwise be established
on the lot under subsection (d)(1)(A) above), regardless of the underlying
residential zoning, provided the detached ADU meets each of the following
requirements:
(i)
The side- and rear-yard setbacks are at least four feet; and
(ii)
The total floor area is 800 square feet or smaller; and
(iii)
The peak height above grade does not exceed the applicable height
limit in subsection (e)(6) below.
(C) Converted ADUs on multifamily lots. One or more ADUs within portions
of existing multifamily structures that are not used as livable space,
regardless of the underlying residential zoning. Non-livable space
that may be converted to an ADU may include, but is not limited to,
storage rooms, boiler rooms, passageways, attics, basements, or garages,
provided each converted ADU complies with State building standards
for dwellings. At least one converted ADU is allowed within an existing
multifamily structure, and the maximum number of ADUs that may be
created within an existing multifamily structure is equal to 25% of
the existing multifamily dwelling units within that structure.
(D) New detached ADUs on multifamily lots. No more than two detached
new construction ADUs are allowed on a lot that has an existing or
proposed multifamily structure, regardless of the underlying residential
zoning, provided each new detached ADU meets both of the following
requirements:
(i)
The side and rear yard setbacks are at least four feet. If the
existing multifamily structure has a rear or side yard setback of
less than four feet, the City will not require any modification to
the multifamily structure as a condition of approving the ADU.
(ii)
The peak height above grade does not exceed the applicable height
limit provided in subsection (e)(6) below.
(2) Zoning-compliance review.
(A) Except as allowed under subsection (d)(1) above, no ADU may be created
without both a building permit and a zoning-compliance review to ensure
that the proposed ADU is in compliance with the standards set forth
in subsections (e) and (f) below.
(B) The City may charge an application fee, adopted by City Council resolution,
to reimburse it for costs incurred in the zoning-compliance review
of an ADU.
(C) The zoning-compliance review of an ADU is a ministerial action, without
discretionary review or a hearing.
(e) General ADU and JADU requirements. The following requirements apply to all ADUs and JADUs that are approved under subsection
(d)(1) or (d)(2) above:
(1) Zoning.
(A) An ADU or JADU subject only to a building permit under subsection
(d)(1) above may only be created on a lot located within a single-family
or multifamily zoning district. The City has no mixed-use zoning district.
(B) An ADU or JADU subject to zoning-compliance review under subsection
(d)(2) above may only be created on a lot in areas zoned to allow
single-family or multifamily dwelling residential use.
(2)
Timing. The City must approve
or deny an application to create an ADU or JADU within 60 days from
the date that the City receives a completed application. If the City
has not approved or denied the completed application within 60 days,
the application is deemed approved unless either:
(i) The applicant requests a delay, in which case the 60 day time period
is tolled for the period of the requested delay; or
(ii)
When an application to create an ADU or JADU is submitted with
a permit application to create a new single-family or multifamily
dwelling on the lot, the City may delay acting on the application
for the ADU or JADU until the City acts on the permit application
to create the new single-family or multifamily dwelling, but the application
to create the ADU or JADU will still be considered a ministerial action
without discretionary review or a hearing.
(3) Application denial—Comments. If the City denies an application
to create an ADU or JADU, the City must provide the applicant with
comments that include, among other things, a list of all the defective
or deficient items and a description of how the application may be
remedied by the applicant. Notice of the denial and corresponding
comments must be provided to the applicant within the 60 day time
period established by subsection (e)(2) above.
(4) Demolition permits. A demolition permit for a detached garage that
is to be replaced with an ADU is reviewed with the application for
the ADU and issued at the same time.
(5) Fire sprinklers.
(A) Fire sprinklers are required in an ADU if sprinklers are required
in the primary residence.
(B) The construction of an ADU does not trigger a requirement for fire
sprinklers to be installed in the existing primary dwelling.
(6) Height.
(A) Except as otherwise provided by subsections (e)(6)(B) and (e)(6)(C)
below, a detached ADU created on a lot with an existing or proposed
single-family or multifamily dwelling unit may not exceed 16 feet
in height.
(B) A detached ADU may be up to 18 feet in height if it is created on
a lot with an existing or proposed single-family or multifamily dwelling
unit that is located within one-half mile walking distance of a major
transit stop or a high quality transit corridor, as those terms are
defined in Section 21155 of the
Public Resources Code, and the ADU
may be up to two additional feet in height (for a maximum of 20 feet)
if necessary to accommodate a roof pitch on the ADU that is aligned
with the roof pitch of the primary dwelling unit.
(C) A detached ADU created on a lot with an existing or proposed multifamily
dwelling that has more than one story above grade may not exceed 18
feet in height.
(D) An ADU that is attached to the primary dwelling may not exceed 25
feet in height or the height limitation imposed by the underlying
zone that applies to the primary dwelling, whichever is lower. Notwithstanding
the foregoing, ADUs subject to this subsection (e)(6)(D) may not exceed
two stories.
(7) Rental term. No ADU or JADU may be rented for a term that is shorter
than 30 calendar days. This prohibition applies regardless of when
the ADU or JADU was created.
(8) No separate conveyance. An ADU or JADU may be rented, but, except
as otherwise provided in
Government Code Section 65852.26, no ADU
or JADU may be sold or otherwise conveyed separately from the lot
and the primary dwelling (in the case of a single-family lot) or from
the lot and all of the dwellings (in the case of a multifamily lot).
(9) Owner occupancy.
(A) An ADU permitted after January 1, 2020, but before January 1, 2025,
is not subject to an owner-occupancy requirement.
(B) Unless applicable law requires otherwise, all ADUs that are created
on or after January 1, 2025 are subject to an owner-occupancy requirement.
A natural person with legal or equitable title to the property must
reside on the property as the person’s legal domicile and permanent
residence.
(C) As required by state law, all JADUs regardless of when they are created
are subject to an owner-occupancy requirement. A natural person with
legal or equitable title to the property must reside on the property,
in either the primary dwelling or the JADU, as the person’s
legal domicile and permanent residence. The owner-occupancy requirement
of this paragraph does not apply if the property is entirely owned
by a governmental agency, land trust, or housing organization.
(10) Deed restriction. Prior to issuance of a building permit for an ADU
or JADU, a deed restriction must be recorded against the title of
the property in the County Recorder’s office and a copy filed
with the Director of Development Services. The deed restriction must
run with the land and bind all future owners. The form of the deed
restriction will be provided by the City and must provide that:
(A)
Except as otherwise provided in
Government Code Section 65852.26,
the ADU or JADU may not be sold separately from the primary dwelling;
and
(B)
The ADU or JADU is restricted to the approved size and to other
attributes allowed by this section; and
(C)
The deed restriction runs with the land and may be enforced
against future property owners; and
(D)
The deed restriction may be removed if the owner eliminates
the ADU or JADU, as evidenced by, for example, removal of the kitchen
facilities. To remove the deed restriction, an owner may make a written
request of the Director of Development Services, providing evidence
that the ADU or JADU has in fact been eliminated. The Director may
then determine whether the evidence supports the claim that the ADU
or JADU has been eliminated. Appeal may be taken from the Director’s
determination consistent with other provisions of this Code. If the
ADU or JADU is not entirely physically removed, but is only eliminated
by virtue of having a necessary component of an ADU or JADU removed,
the remaining structure and improvements must otherwise comply with
applicable provisions of this Code; and
(E)
The deed restriction is enforceable by the Director of Development
Services or designee for the benefit of the City. Failure of the property
owner to comply with the deed restriction may result in legal action
against the property owner, and the City is authorized to obtain any
remedy available to it at law or equity, including, but not limited
to, obtaining an injunction enjoining the use of the ADU or JADU in
violation of the recorded restrictions or abatement of the illegal
unit.
(11) Building and safety.
(A)
Must comply with building code. Subject to subsection (e)(11)(B)
below, all ADUs and JADUs must comply with all local building code
requirements.
(B)
No change of occupancy. Construction of an ADU does not constitute
a Group R occupancy change under the local building code, as described
in Section 310 of the
California Building Code, unless the building
official or Code Enforcement Division officer makes a written finding
based on substantial evidence in the record that the construction
of the ADU could have a specific, adverse impact on public health
and safety. Nothing in this subsection (e)(11)(B) prevents the City
from changing the occupancy code of a space that was uninhabitable
space or that was only permitted for nonresidential use and was subsequently
converted for residential use in accordance with this section.
(f) Specific ADU requirements. The following requirements apply only to ADUs that require zoning compliance review under subsection
(d)(2) above.
(1) Maximum Size.
(A) The maximum size of a detached or attached ADU subject to this subsection
(f) is 850 square feet for a studio or one-bedroom unit and 1,000
square feet for a unit with two or more bedrooms.
(B) A new attached ADU that is created on a lot with an existing primary
dwelling is limited in area to 50% of the floor area of the existing
primary dwelling or the limits in subsection (f)(1)(A) above, whichever
is less.
(C) Application of other development standards in this subsection (f),
such as lot coverage, may further limit the size of an ADU. However,
no application of the percentage-based size limit in subsection (f)(1)(B)
above or the lot-coverage limit in subsection (f)(3) below may require
the ADU to be less than 800 square feet.
(2) Setbacks.
(A) Subject to subsection (f)(2)(B) below, an ADU subject to this subsection
(f) must conform to a 30 foot front yard setback.
(B) If the front yard setback is the only location on the lot where an
ADU may be lawfully constructed, then the ADU may encroach into the
required front yard setback as necessary to enable the construction
of an 800 square foot unit.
(C) An ADU subject to this subsection (f) must conform to four foot side
and rear yard setbacks.
(D) No setback is required for an ADU that is subject to this subsection
(f) if the ADU is constructed in the same location and to the same
dimensions as an existing structure.
(3) Lot coverage. A new attached or detached ADU under this subsection
(f) is subject to a lot-coverage limit of 0.35, subject to subsection
(f)(1)(C) above.
(4) Passageway. No pathway that is unobstructed clear to the sky and
extends from a street to one entrance of the ADU is required.
(5) Parking.
(A) One off-street parking space measuring at least nine feet wide by
19 feet long is required for each ADU on the property where the ADU
is located. The required parking space may be provided in a garage
or carport or on a driveway or within a paved setback area and may
be configured as tandem parking. If the owner elects to provide the
parking space in a garage or carport, the garage or carport is subject
to any applicable zoning standards of Title 9 of this Code.
(B) The new attached or detached ADU and primary dwelling must use the
same driveway apron to access the street, unless a separate driveway
apron for the new ADU is required by the fire authority.
(C) Exceptions. No parking under subsection (f)(5)(A) is required in
the following situations:
(i)
The ADU is located within one-half mile walking distance of
a public transit stop, as defined in subsection (c)(8) above.
(ii)
The ADU is located within the Los Rios Historical Residential
District or the Mission Residential Zoning District.
(iii)
The ADU is integrated into a proposed or existing primary residence
or garage or other accessory structure under subsection (d)(1)(A).
(iv)
When on-street parking permits are required but not offered
to the occupant of the ADU.
(v)
When there is an established car share vehicle stop located
within one block of the ADU.
(vi)
When the permit application to create an ADU is submitted with
an application to create a new singlefamily or new multifamily dwelling
on the same lot, provided that the ADU or the lot satisfies any other
criteria in subsections (f)(5)(C)(i) through (f)(5)(C)(v) above.
(D) No replacement. When a garage, carport, or other covered-parking
structure is demolished in conjunction with the construction of an
ADU or if a garage, carport or other covered-parking structure is
converted to an ADU, those off-street parking spaces are not required
to be replaced.
(6) Architectural requirements.
(A) The exterior sides of the ADU shall be covered with wood, stucco,
masonry, or other material of the same appearance and durability.
Metal siding shall not be permitted.
(B) The roof material of the ADU shall be wood shingle or shake, slate,
tile, or other material of the same appearance and durability.
(C) The roof eaves and gables of the ADU shall be no less than 12 inches,
as measured from the vertical side of the unit.
(D) If the ADU would be visible from an adjoining public right-of-way,
the materials and colors of the exterior walls, roof, windows and
doors of the ADU must match the appearance and architectural design
of those of the primary dwelling.
(E) If the ADU would be visible from an adjoining public right-of-way,
the roof slope of the ADU must match the dominant roof slope of the
primary dwelling, if feasible. The dominant roof slope is the slope
of the largest portion of the roof.
(F) Exterior lighting of the ADU must be limited to down-lights or as
otherwise required by the building or fire code.
(G) The ADU must have an independent exterior entrance, apart from that
of the primary dwelling.
(H) Fencing, landscaping, or privacy glass may be used to provide screening
and prevent a direct line of sight to contiguous residential property.
(7) Historical protections. The architectural treatment of a new attached
or detached ADU to be constructed on a lot that has an identified
historical resource listed on the California Register of Historic
Resources must comply with all applicable ministerial requirements
imposed by the Secretary of the Interior.
(8) Septic system. If the ADU will connect to an onsite water-treatment
system, the owner must include with the application a percolation
test completed within the last five years or, if the percolation test
has been recertified, within the last 10 years.
(9) Ridgeline protection. No ADU, or grading related to construction
of an ADU, shall be permitted within 200 feet (horizontal) of a General
Plan designated ridgeline, or as designated on a final City subdivision.
(g) Fees. The following fees apply to all ADUs and JADUs approved by
the City under this section.
(1) Impact fees.
(A) No impact fee is required for an ADU that is less than 750 square
feet in habitable floor area.
(B) Any impact fee that is required for an ADU that is 750 square feet
or larger in habitable floor area must be charged proportionately
in relation to the habitable floor area of the primary dwelling unit
(e.g., the habitable floor area of the primary dwelling, divided by
the habitable floor area of the ADU, times the typical fee amount
charged for a new dwelling). “Impact fee” here does not
include any connection fee or capacity charge for water or sewer service.
(2) Utility connections and fees. ADUs are subject to the utility connection
requirements and fees or charges imposed by the applicable utility
provider.
(h) Nonconforming zoning code conditions, building code violations, and
unpermitted structures.
(1) Generally. The City will not deny an ADU or JADU application due
to a nonconforming zoning condition, building code violation, or unpermitted
structure on the lot that does not present a threat to the public
health and safety and that is not affected by the construction of
the ADU or JADU.
(2) Unpermitted ADUs constructed before 2018.
(A) Permit to legalize. As required by State law, the City may not deny
a permit to legalize an existing but unpermitted ADU that was constructed
before January 1, 2018, if denial is based on either of the following
grounds:
(i)
The ADU violates applicable building standards; or
(B) Exceptions.
(i)
Notwithstanding subsection (h)(2)(A), the City may deny a permit
to legalize an existing but unpermitted ADU that was constructed before
January 1, 2018, if the City makes a finding that correcting a violation
is necessary to protect the health and safety of the public or of
occupants of the structure.
(ii)
Subsection (h)(2)(A) above does not apply to a building that
is deemed to be substandard in accordance with California Health and
Safety Code Section 17920.3.
(i) Nonconforming ADUs and discretionary approval. Any proposed ADU or JADU that does not conform to the objective standards set forth in subsections
(a) through
(h) of this section may be allowed by the City with a zone variance, in accordance with Section
9-2.351 of this Code.
(Ord. No. 1097, § 2, 2022; Ord. No. 1101, § 3, 2022; Ord. No. 1106, § 4, 2022; Ord. No. 1113, § 4, 2023)
(a) Purpose.
The purpose of this section is to regulate personal, medical, and
commercial marijuana uses. Nothing in this section shall preempt or
make inapplicable any provision of State or Federal law.
(b) Personal
use.
(1) For purposes of this subsection, personal recreational use, possession,
purchase, transport, or dissemination of marijuana shall be considered
unlawful in all areas of the City to the extent it is unlawful under
California law.
(2) Outdoor cultivation. A person may not plant, cultivate, harvest,
dry, or process marijuana plants outdoors in any zoning district of
the City. No use permit, building permit, variance, or any other permit
or entitlement, whether administrative or discretionary, shall be
approved or issued for any such use or activity.
(3) Indoor cultivation.
(A) A person may not plant, cultivate, harvest, dry, or process marijuana
plants inside a private residence, or inside an accessory structure
to a private residence located upon the grounds of a private residence,
or inside any other enclosed structure within any zoning district
of the City. No use permit, building permit, variance, or any other
permit or entitlement, whether administrative or discretionary, shall
be approved or issued for any such use or activity.
(B) To the extent a complete prohibition on indoor cultivation is not
permitted under California law, a person may not plant, cultivate,
harvest, dry, or process marijuana plants inside a private residence,
or inside an accessory structure to a private residence located upon
the grounds of a private residence, unless the person is issued an
indoor cultivation permit by the Planning Division. A person may not
plant, cultivate, harvest, dry, or process marijuana plants inside
any enclosed structure within any zoning district of the City which
is not either a private residence or an accessory structure to a private
residence located upon the grounds of a private residence.
(C) The Planning Division will issue application and processing guidelines
for the indoor cultivation permit. No indoor cultivation permit shall
be issued prior to the release of these guidelines, and no permit
shall be granted which has not complied fully with the application
and processing requirements.
(c) Medical
use.
(1) Cultivation of medical marijuana pursuant to Section 11362.77 of the California
Health and Safety Code is subject to the cultivation requirements laid out in Section
9-3.502(b).
(2) The establishment or operation of any medical marijuana collective,
cooperative, dispensary, delivery service, operator, establishment,
or provider shall be considered a prohibited use in all zoning districts
of the City. No use permit, variance, building permit, or any other
entitlement or permit, whether administrative or discretionary, shall
be approved or issued for the establishment of any collective, cooperative,
dispensary, delivery service, operator, establishment, or provider
in any zoning district, and no person shall otherwise establish such
businesses or operations in any zoning district.
(d) Commercial
use. The establishment or operation of any business of commercial
marijuana activity is prohibited. No use permit, variance, building
permit, or any other entitlement or permit, whether administrative
or discretionary, shall be approved or issued for the establishment
or operation of any such business or operation. Such prohibited businesses
or operations may include, but are not limited to:
(1) The transportation, delivery, storage, distribution, or sale of marijuana,
marijuana products, or marijuana accessories;
(2) The cultivation of marijuana;
(3) The manufacturing or testing of marijuana, marijuana products, or
marijuana accessories; or
(4) Any other business licensed by the State or other government entity
under Division 10 of the California
Business and Professions Code,
as it may be amended from time to time.
(e) Violations. No person, whether as principal, agent, employee or otherwise, shall violate, cause the violation of, or otherwise fail to comply with any of the requirements of this section. Every act prohibited or declared unlawful, and every failure to perform an act made mandatory by this section, shall be a misdemeanor or an infraction, at the discretion of the City Attorney or the District Attorney. In addition to the penalties provided in this section, any condition caused or permitted to exist in violation of any of the provisions of this section is declared a public nuisance and may be abated as provided in Chapter 2, of Title
1 of this Municipal Code and/or under State law.
(Ord. No. 1028, § 2, 2016; Ord. No. 1038, § 2, 2016)
(a) Purpose
and intent. Special locational regulations and operational standards
of adult-oriented businesses are necessary to ensure that the secondary
adverse effects caused by the operational characteristics will not
contribute to the blighting or downgrading of the surrounding neighborhoods,
nor the concentration or clustering of such businesses in any area.
(b) Adult-oriented
business. Adult-oriented businesses shall consist of the following
types of uses as defined in Appendix “A” of this Land
Use Code:
(3) Adult mini-motion picture theater, adult motion picture arcade, adult
motion picture theater;
(4) Adult cabaret, nightclub theater or other establishment which features
live performances where such performers are distinguished or characterized
by an emphasis on specified sexual activities or specified anatomical
parts;
(5) Encounter center or rap study as defined in Appendix “A”
of this Land Use Code; or
(c) Establishment.
Adult-oriented businesses may be established as a principal permitted
use in those districts so identified under Article 3 Base District
Regulations/Standards of this chapter. Said establishment of use shall
be subject to the following locational and design standards:
(1) The adult-oriented business shall not be located within 300 feet
of any residential zone or use unless the proposed location of the
adult-oriented business is physically separated from the residential
zone or residential use by a freeway or storm drainage channels for
Trabuco and San Juan Creeks.
(2) The adult-oriented business shall not be located within 300 feet
of any lot upon which there is properly located a public park, school
(public or private) or religious institution, unless the proposed
location is physically separated from the public park, school or religious
institution by a freeway or storm drainage channels for Trabuco and
San Juan Creeks.
(3) The adult-oriented business shall not be located within 1,000 feet
of any other adult-oriented business.
(4) The adult-oriented business shall provide one parking space per occupant as based upon the maximum occupancy as determined by the building official. Said off-street parking area and the premises entries shall be illuminated from dusk to closing hours of operation with a lighting system consistent with the design provision of Section
9-3.529, Lighting standards, which provides an average maintained horizontal illumination of one footcandle of light on the parking surface and all walkways.
(5) The adult-oriented business shall be located completely within a
permanent building affixed with a foundation to the ground.
(6) The exterior of the building including windows and entrances shall
be designed to prohibit the observation of any materials or activities
depicting, describing or relating to any specified sexual activities
or specified anatomical parts from any location outside the establishment’s
building. This provision shall preclude any display, decoration, sign
(excepting the name of the facility), show window or other opening.
(7) The adult-oriented business premises shall provide sufficient sound-absorbing
insulation so that noise generated inside the premises is not audible
anywhere on any adjacent property or public right-of-way or within
any other building or other separate unit within the same building
or other buildings located on the same property.
(8) All interior areas of the premises within which patrons are permitted
(except restrooms) shall be open to an unobstructed view with the
naked eye, and without the aid of any cameras, mirrors or other devices
by the management at all times.
(9) An interior floor plan shall designate all areas of the establishment
that patrons or visitors are permitted, along with areas that are
to be restricted to employees’ use only.
(10) Separate restroom facilities shall be provided for patrons/visitors
and employees. These separate facilities shall include separate restrooms
for male and female patrons and separate restroom facilities for male
and female employees. The restrooms shall be free from any sexually
oriented material. Restrooms shall not contain television monitors
or other motion picture or video projection, recording or reproduction
equipment.
(11) All areas of the adult-oriented business shall be illuminated at
the following minimum footcandle levels:
Adult-Oriented Business
|
Minimum Footcandles
|
---|
Bookstores and other retail establishments
|
20
|
Theaters and cabarets
|
5 (except during performances, at which times lighting shall
be at least 1.25 footcandles)
|
Adult arcades
|
10
|
Motels/hotels
|
20 (in all public areas)
|
Modeling/rap studios
|
20
|
(12) All live performance areas shall be upon a stage at least 18 inches
above the level of the floor which shall be separated by a distance
of at least 10 feet from the nearest area designated for patrons and
visitors. This 10 foot separation will be restricted to employees
only while the stage is occupied by a performer.
(13) Separate dressing facilities shall be provided and exclusively dedicated
for the use of performers.
(14) Access for performers between the stage and the dressing rooms shall
be completely separated from the patrons.
(15) The business shall provide an entrance/exit for performers and employees
which is completely separate from the entrance/exit used by patrons.
(16) Fixed rail(s) at least 30 inches in height shall be maintained establishing
the separations between performers and patrons required by this subsection.
(d) Operational
standards. Adult-oriented businesses and adult-oriented business performers
shall comply with the following operational standards. Failure to
comply with these operational standards may be cause for suspension
or revocation of the adult-oriented business permit and/or the adult-oriented
business performer permit.
(1) No performer, either before, during or after performances, shall
have physical contact with any patron and no patron shall have physical
contact with any performer either before, during or after performances
by such performer. This section shall only apply to any physical contact
on the premises, including the parking lot of the adult-oriented business.
(2) No patron shall directly pay or give any gratuity to any performer.
(3) No owner or other person with managerial control over the adult-oriented
business (as that term is defined by the Municipal Code) shall permit
any person on the premises of the adult-oriented business to engage
in a live showing of the human male or female genitals, pubic area
or natal cleft with less than a fully opaque coverage, and/or the
female breast with less than a fully opaque coverage over any part
of the nipple or areola and/or covered male genitals in a discernible
turgid state. This provision may not be complied with by applying
an opaque covering simulating the appearance of the specified anatomical
part required to be covered.
(4) Adult-oriented businesses shall employ security guards in order to
maintain the public peace and safety based upon the following standards:
(A) Adult-oriented businesses featuring live entertainment shall provide
at least one security guard at all times while the business is open.
If the occupant limit of the premises is greater than 35 persons,
an additional security guard shall be on duty. One additional security
guard shall be added for each additional increase in occupancy of
35 persons.
(B) Security guards for other adult-oriented businesses shall be required
at a ratio of one guard for every 100 person occupancy limit.
(C) Security guard(s) shall be charged with preventing violations of
law and enforcing compliance by patrons of the requirements of these
regulations. Security guards shall be uniformed in such a manner so
as to be readily identifiable as a security guard by the public and
shall be duly licensed as a security guard as required by applicable
provisions of State law. No security guard required pursuant to this
subsection shall act as a door person, ticket seller, ticket taker,
admittance person, or sole occupant of the manager’s station
while acting as a security guard.
(5) Adult-oriented businesses shall be open for business only between
the hours of 8:00 a.m. and midnight on any particular day.
(6) All indoor areas of the adult-oriented business within which patrons
are permitted, except restrooms, shall be open to an unobstructed
view with the naked eye without the aid of any cameras, mirrors or
other devices from a manager’s station located in the public
portion of the establishment by the management at all times.
(7) The building entrance to an adult-oriented business shall be clearly
and legibly posted with a notice indicating that persons under 18
years of age are precluded from entering the premises. Said notice
shall be constructed and posted to the satisfaction of the Planning
Director or designated representative. No person under the age of
18 years shall be permitted within the premises at any time.
(8) No patron is permitted access to any area of the premises which has
been designated as an area in which patrons are not to be permitted.
(9) Adult-oriented businesses that have individual viewing areas shall
comply with the following:
(A) The view area shall remain unobstructed by any doors, walls, merchandise,
display racks, or other merchandise and shall be visible at all times
by management as specified by subsection (d)(6), above.
(B) No individual viewing area may be occupied by more than one person
at a time.
(C) The walls or partitions between individual viewing areas or booths
shall be maintained in good repair at all times, with no holes or
other openings in any wall or partition of any individual viewing
area such as to allow physical contact through a partition between
the occupant of any such individual viewing area and a person on the
outside. All individual viewing areas shall be separated from other
individual viewing areas by a five foot buffer.
(D) Customers, patrons, or visitors shall not be allowed to stand idly
by the vicinity of any such individual viewing area or from remaining
in the common area of such business, other than the restrooms, who
are not actively engaged in shopping for or reviewing the products
available on display for purchaser viewing. Signs prohibiting loitering
shall be posted in prominent places in and near the video booths.
(E) The floors, seats, walls and other interior portions of all individual
viewing areas shall be maintained clean and free from waste and bodily
secretions.
(10) Every permittee of an adult-oriented business which provides live
entertainment depicting specified anatomical parts or involving specified
sexual activities, must maintain a register of all persons so performing
on the premises and their permit numbers. Such register shall be available
for inspection during regular business hours by any sheriff’s
deputy or health officer retained as an employee by the City.
(11) Every adult-oriented business shall display at all times during business hours the permit issued pursuant to the provisions of Title
5, Chapter
27 of the Municipal Code for such adult-oriented business in a conspicuous place so that the same may be readily seen by all persons entering the adult-oriented business.
(12) Each adult-oriented business performer required to have a permit
shall have such card available for inspection at all times during
which such person is on the premises of the adult-oriented business.
(13) It is unlawful for any permittee, operator, or other person in charge
of any adult-oriented business to employ, or provide service for which
it requires such permit, to any person who is not at least 18 years
of age.
(14) It is unlawful for any adult-oriented business permittee, adult-oriented
business operator or other person in charge of any adult-oriented
business to permit to enter, or remain within the adult-oriented business,
any person who is not at least 18 years of age.
(15) It shall be unlawful for any adult-oriented business owner, adult-oriented
business operator; manager, or adult-oriented business permittee in
charge of or in control of an adult-oriented business which provides
live entertainment depicting specified anatomical parts or involving
specified sexual activities to allow any person to perform such entertainment
who is not in possession of a valid, unrevoked adult-oriented business
performer permit.
(16) An applicant or permittee shall permit representatives of the Sheriff’s
Department, Orange County Environmental Health Department, Orange
County Fire Authority, Department of Planning Services, or other City
departments or agencies to inspect the premises of an adult-oriented
business for the purpose of insuring compliance with the law and the
development and performance standards applicable to adult-oriented
businesses, at any time it is occupied or opened for business. A person
who operates an adult-oriented business or his or her agent or employee
is in violation of the provisions of this section if he or she refuses
to permit such lawful inspection of the premises at any time it is
occupied or open for business.
(17) The provisions of the section regulating adult-oriented businesses
are not intended to be exclusive and compliance therewith shall not
excuse noncompliance with any other regulations pertaining to the
operation of businesses as adopted by the City Council.
(Ord. No. 869, § 2; Ord. No. 1042, § 17, 2017)
(a) Purpose
and intent. The purpose and intent of the affordable housing requirements
in this section are to achieve the following:
(1) To create affordable housing requirements to facilitate the development
of residential housing opportunities for low and very low income senior/households
within the City;
(2) To comply with state law to provide 25% density bonuses for the creation
of affordable housing projects which guarantee accessibility of housing
for qualified low and very low income seniors and households for 10
years;
(3) To comply with state law to provide density bonuses and an additional
incentive for the creation of affordable housing projects which guarantee
long-term (30 years) accessibility of housing for qualified low and
very low income seniors and households;
(4) To establish development criteria to ensure that the design of affordable
senior and household housing projects are consistent with the City’s
General Plan Community Design Element and Architectural Guidelines.
(b) Affordable
housing policies. City policies aimed at achieving the purpose and
intent of this section are as follows:
(1) Development restrictions. Development should be designed to be compatible
with adjacent uses and to promote high quality affordable housing
projects within all zone districts.
(2) Materials and design. Materials and design shall be of high quality
and architectural design and should be consistent with other City
design standards.
(3) Affordable housing in-lieu fees. In-lieu fees shall be collected pursuant to Section
9-5.103, Housing inlieu fee, to facilitate the development of affordable housing opportunities.
(c) Density
bonus description.
(1) The Density Bonus program is hereby created to permit affordable
senior/household residential units subject to City Council approval
of a density bonus permit in the following districts:
(A) Hillside Residential (HR), Single-Family-10,000 (RS-10,000), Single-Family-7,000
(RS-7,000), and Single-Family-4,000 (RS-4,000);
(B) Residential Garden-7,000 (RG-7,000) and Residential Garden-4,000
(RG-4,000);
(C) Multiple-Family (RM) and Very High Density (VHD);
(E) General Commercial (GC) and Office Commercial (OC);
(F) Specific Plan/Precise Plan (SP/PP); and
(d) Density
bonus program.
(1) Purpose and Intent. The purpose of this section is to implement the
provisions of
Government Code Section 65915 and the City’s Housing
Element regarding the provision of density bonuses and other regulatory
incentives for affordable and senior housing projects.
(2) Applicability. The provisions of this section shall apply to projects qualifying for density bonuses provided for by
Government Code Section 65915, in accordance with Section
9-3.505(d)(3)9-3.505(d)(3).
(3) Standards.
(A) City obligation to provide density bonuses and incentives. When an
applicant seeks a density bonus for a housing development within or
for the donation of land for housing within the City, the City shall
provide the applicant with incentives or concessions for the production
of housing units and child care facilities as prescribed in this Section.
(B) Development entitled to bonuses and incentives. The City shall grant
one density bonus, the amount of which shall be as specified in subdivision
C.6, and incentives or concessions, as described in subdivision C.4,
when an applicant for a housing development seeks and agrees to construct
a housing development, excluding any units permitted by the density
bonus awarded pursuant to this section, that will contain at least
any one of the following:
(i)
Ten percent of the total units of a housing development for
lower income households, as defined in Section 50079.5 of the California
Health and Safety Code.
(ii)
Five percent of the total units of a housing development for
very low income households, as defined in Section 50105 of the California
Health and Safety Code.
(iii)
A senior citizen housing development, as defined in Sections 51.3 and 51.12 of the California
Civil Code and reprinted in Section
9-3.505(d)(6)(g) below, or mobile home park that limits residency based on age requirements for housing for older persons pursuant to Section 798.76 or 799.5 of the California
Civil Code.
(iv)
Ten percent of the total dwelling units in a common interest
development as defined in Section 1351 of the California
Civil Code
for persons and families of moderate income, as defined in Section
50093 of the California
Health and Safety Code, provided that all
units in the development are offered to the public for purchase.
(C) For purposes of calculating the amount of the density bonus pursuant to Section
9-3.505(d)(3)9-3.505(d)(3) the applicant who requests a density bonus pursuant to this section shall elect whether the bonus shall be awarded on the basis of subparagraph (i), (ii), (iii), or (iv) of Section
9-3.505(d)(3)(B)9-3.505(d)(3)(B) above.
(D) For the purposes of this section, “total units” or “total
dwelling units” do not include units added by a density bonus
awarded pursuant to this section.
(E) An applicant shall agree to, and the City shall ensure, continued
affordability of all low- and very low income units that qualified
the applicant for the award of the density bonus for 30 years or a
longer period of time if required by the construction or mortgage
financing assistance program, mortgage insurance program, or rental
subsidy program. Rents for the lower income density bonus units shall
be set at an affordable rent as defined in Section 50053 of the California
Health and Safety Code. Owner-occupied units shall be available at
an affordable housing cost as defined in Section 50052.5 of the California
Health and Safety Code.
(F) The initial occupant of the moderate-income units that are directly
related to the receipt of the density bonus in the common interest
development, as defined in Section 1351 of the California
Civil Code,
shall be persons and families of moderate income, as defined in Section
50093 of the California
Health and Safety Code, and the units shall
be offered at an affordable housing cost, as that cost is defined
in Section 50052.5 of the California
Health and Safety Code. The City
shall enforce an equity sharing agreement, unless it is in conflict
with the requirements of another public funding source or law. The
following apply to the equity sharing agreement:
(i)
Upon resale, the seller of the unit shall retain the value of any improvements, the down payment, and the seller’s proportionate share of appreciation. The City shall recapture any initial subsidy, as defined in Section
9-3.505(d)(3)(F)(ii), and its proportionate share of appreciation, as defined in Section
9-3.505(d)(3)(F)(iii), which amount shall be used within five years for any of the purposes described in subdivision (e) of Section 33334.2 of the California Health and Safely Code that promote home ownership.
(ii)
For purposes of this subdivision, the City’s initial subsidy
shall be equal to the fair market value of the home at the time of
initial sale minus the initial sale price to the moderate-income household,
plus the amount of any down payment assistance or mortgage assistance.
If upon resale the market value is lower than the initial market value,
then the value at the time of the resale shall be used as the initial
market value.
(iii)
For purposes of this subdivision, the City’s proportionate
share of appreciation shall be equal to the ratio of the City’s
initial subsidy to the fair market value of the home at the time of
initial sale.
(G) Regulatory Incentives and Concessions. An applicant for a density
bonus pursuant to 9-3.505(d)(3)(B) may submit to the City a proposal
for the specific incentives or concessions that the applicant requests
pursuant to this Section, and may request a meeting with the City.
If the City approves the Project, the City shall grant the concession
incentive requested by the applicant unless the City makes a written
finding, based upon substantial evidence, of any of the following:
(ii)
The concession or incentive would have a specific adverse impact
upon the public health and safety or upon the physical environment
or on any real property that is listed in the California Register
of Historical Resources and for which there is no feasible method
to satisfactorily mitigate or avoid the specific adverse impact without
rendering the development unaffordable to low- and moderate-income
households. As used in this paragraph, a “specific, adverse
impact” means a significant, quantifiable, direct, and unavoidable
impact, based on objective, identified written public health or safety
standards, policies, or conditions as they existed on the date the
application was deemed complete. Inconsistency with the zoning ordinance
or general plan land use designation shall not constitute a specific,
adverse impact upon the public health or safety.
(iii)
The concession or incentive would be contrary to state or federal
law.
(H) For the purposes of this Section, a concession or incentive means
any of the following:
(i)
A reduction in site development standards or a modification
of zoning code requirements or architectural design requirements that
exceed the minimum building standards approved by the California Building
Standards Commission as provided in Part 2.5 (commencing with Section
18901) of Division 13 of the California
Health and Safety Code, including,
but not limited to, a reduction in setback and square footage requirements
and in the ratio of vehicular parking spaces that would otherwise
be required that results in identifiable, financially sufficient,
and actual cost reductions.
(ii)
Approval of mixed use zoning in conjunction with the housing
project if commercial, office, industrial, or other land uses will
reduce the cost of the housing development and if the commercial,
office, industrial, or other land uses are compatible with the housing
project and the existing or planned development in the area where
the proposed housing project will be located.
(iii)
Other regulatory incentives or concessions proposed by the developer
or the City that result in identifiable, financially sufficient, and
actual cost reductions.
(I) The applicant shall receive the following number of incentives or
concessions:
(i)
One incentive or concession for projects that include at least
10 percent of the total units for lower income households, at least
5 percent for very low income households, or at least 10 percent for
persons and families of moderate income in a common interest development.
(ii)
Two incentives or concessions for projects that include at least
20 percent of the total units for lower income households, at least
10 percent for very low income households, or at least 20 percent
for persons and families of moderate income in a common interest development.
(iii)
Three incentives or concessions for projects that include at
least 30 percent of the total units for lower income households, at
least 15 percent for very low income households, or at least 30 percent
for persons and families of moderate income in a common interest development.
(J) The granting of a concession or incentive shall not be interpreted,
in and of itself, to require a general plan amendment, local coastal
plan amendment, zoning change, or other discretionary approval.
(K) This Section
9-3.505(d)(3)(G)9-3.505(d)(3)(G) does not limit or require the provision of direct financial incentives for the housing development, including the provision of publicly owned land, by the City, or the waiver of fees or dedication requirements.
(L) The City shall not apply any development standard that will have the effect of physically precluding the construction of a development meeting the criteria of Section
9-3.505(d)(3)(B)9-3.505(d)(3)(B) at the densities or with the concessions or incentives permitted by this Section. An applicant may submit to the City a proposal for the waiver or reduction of development standards that will have the effect of physically precluding the construction of a development meeting the criteria of Section
9-3.505(d)(3)(B)9-3.505(d)(3)(B) at the densities or with the concessions or incentives permitted under this Section, and may request a meeting with the City. Nothing in this subdivision shall be interpreted to require the City to waive or reduce development standards if the waiver or reduction would have a specific adverse impact, as defined in subparagraph Section
9-3.505(d)(3)(G)(ii) above upon health, safety, or the physical environment, and for which there is no feasible method to satisfactorily mitigate or avoid the specific adverse impact. In addition, nothing in this Section shall be interpreted to require the City to waive or reduce development standards that would have an adverse impact on any real property that is listed in the California Register of Historical Resources or to grant any waiver or reduction that would be contrary to state or federal law.
(M) A proposal for the waiver or reduction of development standards pursuant to this subdivision shall neither reduce nor increase the number of incentives or concessions to which the applicant is entitled pursuant to Section
9-3.505(d)(3)(G)9-3.505(d)(3)(G).
(4) Calculation of Density Bonus. The amount of density bonus to which the applicant is entitled shall vary according to the amount by which, the percentage of affordable housing units exceeds the percentage established in subdivision Section
9-3.505(d)(3)(B)The applicant may elect to accept a lesser percentage of density bonus.
(A) For housing developments meeting the criteria of Section
9-3.505(d)(3)(B)(i), the density bonus shall be calculated as follows:
Percentage Low-Income Units
|
Percentage Density Bonus
|
---|
10
|
20
|
11
|
21.5
|
12
|
23
|
13
|
24.5
|
14
|
26
|
15
|
27.5
|
17
|
30.5
|
18
|
32
|
19
|
33.5
|
20
|
35
|
(B) For housing developments meeting the criteria of Section
9-3.505(d)(3)(B)(ii), the density bonus shall be calculated as follows:
Percentage Very Low Income Units
|
Percentage Density Bonus
|
---|
5
|
20
|
6
|
22.5
|
7
|
25
|
8
|
27.5
|
9
|
30
|
10
|
32.5
|
11
|
35
|
(C) For housing developments meeting the criteria of Section
9-3.505(d)(3)(B)(iii), the density bonus shall be 20 percent of the number of senior housing units.
(D) For housing developments meeting the criteria of Section
9-3.505(d)(3)(B)(iv)the density bonus shall be calculated as follows:
Percentage Moderate-Income Units
|
Percentage Density Bonus
|
---|
10
|
5
|
11
|
6
|
12
|
7
|
13
|
8
|
14
|
9
|
15
|
10
|
16
|
11
|
17
|
12
|
18
|
13
|
19
|
14
|
20
|
15
|
21
|
16
|
22
|
17
|
23
|
18
|
24
|
19
|
25
|
20
|
26
|
21
|
27
|
22
|
28
|
23
|
29
|
24
|
30
|
25
|
31
|
26
|
32
|
27
|
33
|
28
|
34
|
29
|
35
|
30
|
36
|
31
|
37
|
32
|
38
|
33
|
39
|
34
|
40
|
35
|
(E) All density calculations resulting in fractional units shall be rounded
up to the next whole number. The granting of a density bonus shall
not be interpreted, in and of itself, to require a general plan amendment,
local coastal plan amendment, zoning change, or other discretionary
approval.
(F) For the purpose of calculating a density bonus, the residential units
shall be on contiguous sites that are the subject of one development
application, but do not have to be based upon individual subdivision
maps or parcels. The density bonus shall be permitted in geographic
areas of the housing development other than the areas where the units
for the lower income households are located.
(5) Density Bonus for Donation of Land to City.
(A) When an applicant for a tentative subdivision map, parcel map, or
other residential development approval donates land to the City in
accordance with this subdivision, the applicant shall be entitled
to a 15-percent increase above the otherwise maximum allowable residential
density for the entire development, as follows:
Percentage Very Low Income
|
Percentage Density Bonus
|
---|
10
|
15
|
11
|
16
|
12
|
17
|
13
|
18
|
14
|
19
|
15
|
20
|
16
|
21
|
17
|
22
|
18
|
23
|
19
|
24
|
20
|
25
|
21
|
26
|
22
|
27
|
23
|
28
|
24
|
29
|
25
|
30
|
26
|
31
|
27
|
32
|
28
|
33
|
29
|
34
|
30
|
35
|
(B) This increase shall be in addition to any increase in density mandated by Section
9-3.505(d)(3)(B)9-3.505(d)(3)(B), up to a maximum combined mandated density increase of 35 percent if an applicant seeks an increase pursuant to both this Section and Section
9-3.505(d)(3)(B)(i) All density calculations resulting in fractional units shall be rounded up to the next whole number. Nothing in this Section shall be construed to enlarge or diminish the City’s authority to require a developer to donate land as a condition of development. An applicant shall be eligible for the increased density bonus described in this Section if all of the following conditions are met:
(i)
The applicant donates and transfers the land no later than the
date of approval of the final subdivision map, parcel map, or residential
development application;
(ii)
The developable acreage and zoning classification of the land
being transferred are sufficient to permit construction of units affordable
to very low income households in an amount not less than 10 percent
of the number of residential units of the proposed development;
(iii)
The transferred land is at least one acre in size or of sufficient
size to permit development of at least 40 units, has the appropriate
general plan designation, is appropriately zoned with appropriate
development standards for development at a density of at least 30
units per acre, and is or will be served by adequate public facilities
and infrastructure;
(iv)
The transferred land shall have all of the permits and approvals,
other than building permits, necessary for the development of the
very low income housing units on the transferred land, not later than
the date of approval of the final subdivision map, parcel map, or
residential development application, except that the City may subject
the proposed development to subsequent design review to the extent
authorized by subdivision (i) of California
Government Code Section
65583.2 if the design has not been reviewed by the City prior to the
time of transfer;
(v)
The transferred land and the affordable units shall be subject to a deed restriction ensuring continued affordability of the units consistent with Section
9-3.505(d)(3)(E)9-3.505(d)(3)(E) and Section
9-3.505(d)(3)(F)9-3.505(d)(3)(F), which shall be recorded on the property at the time of the transfer;
(vi)
The land is transferred to the City or to a City-approved housing
developer. The City may require the applicant to identify and transfer
the land to the approved housing developer;
(vii)
The transferred land shall be within the boundary of the proposed
development or, if the City agrees, within one-quarter mile of the
boundary of the proposed development; and
(viii)
A proposed source of funding for the very low income units shall
be identified not later than the date of approval of the final subdivision
map, parcel map, or residential development application.
(6) Density Bonus for Provision of Child Care Facilities in Qualifying
Housing Development.
(A) When an applicant proposes to construct a housing development that conforms to the requirements of subdivision Section
9-3.505(d)(3)(B)9-3.505(d)(3)(B) and includes a child care facility that will be located on the premises of, as part of, or adjacent to, the project, the City shall grant either of the following:
(i)
An additional density bonus that is an amount of square feet
of residential space that is equal to or greater than the amount of
square feet in the child care facility; or
(ii)
An additional concession or incentive that contributes significantly
to the economic feasibility of the construction of the child care
facility.
(B) The City shall require, as a condition of approving the housing development
that the following occur:
(i)
The child care facility shall remain in operation for a period
of time that is as long as or longer than the period of time during
which the density bonus units are required to remain affordable pursuant
to subsection (d)(3)(B); and
(ii)
Of the children who attend the child care facility, the children
of very low income households, lower income households, or families
of moderate income shall equal a percentage that is equal to or greater
than the percentage of dwelling units that are required for very low
income households, lower income households, or families of moderate
income pursuant to subsection (d)(3)(B).
(C) Notwithstanding any requirement of this subdivision, the City shall
not be required to provide a density bonus or concession for a child
care facility if it finds, based upon substantial evidence, that the
community has adequate child care facilities.
(7) Definitions. For purposes of this section, the following definitions
shall apply:
"Child care facility"
means a child day care facility other than a family day care
home, including, but not limited to, infant centers, preschools, extended
day care facilities, and school age child care centers,
"Density bonus"
means a density increase over the otherwise maximum allowable
residential density as of the date of application by the applicant
to the City.
"Development standard"
includes a site or construction condition, including, but
not limited to, a height limitation, a setback requirement, a floor
area ratio, an onsite open-space requirement, or a parking ratio that
applies to a residential development pursuant to any ordinance, general
plan element, specific plan, or other City condition, law, policy,
resolution, or regulation.
"Housing development"
means a development project for five or more residential
units. For the purposes of this section, “housing development”
also includes a subdivision or common interest development, as defined
in Section 1351 of the California
Civil Code, approved by the City,
and consists of residential units or unimproved residential lots and
either a project to substantially rehabilitate and convert an existing
commercial building to residential use or the substantial rehabilitation
of an existing multifamily dwelling, as defined in subdivision (d)
of Section 65863.4, where the result of the rehabilitation would be
a net increase in available residential units.
"Maximum allowable residential density"
means the density allowed under the City’s zoning ordinance
and the Land Use Element of the City’s General Plan, or, if
a range of density is permitted, the maximum allowable density for
the specific zoning range and land use designation in the General
Plan applicable to the project. Where the density allowed under the
zoning ordinance is inconsistent with the density allowed under the
Land Use Element of the General Plan, the General Plan density shall
prevail.
"Senior citizen"
means a person 62 years of age or older, or 55 years of age
or older in a senior citizen housing development.
"Senior citizen housing development"
means a residential development developed, substantially
rehabilitated, or substantially renovated for, senior citizens that
has at least 35 dwelling units.
(8) Parking incentives.
(A) The City shall not require the parking ratio, inclusive of handicapped
and guest parking, for a housing development meeting the criteria
of subsection (d)(3)(B) to exceed the following ratios:
(i)
Zero to one bedroom: one on-site parking space.
(ii)
Two to three bedrooms: two on-site parking spaces.
(iii)
Four and more bedrooms: two and one-half (2.5) parking spaces.
(B) If the total number of parking spaces required for a housing development
is other than a whole number, the number shall be rounded up to the
next whole number. For purposes of this subdivision, a development
may provide “on-site parking” through tandem parking or
uncovered parking, but not through on-street parking.
(C) This subdivision shall apply to a housing development that meets
the requirements of subsection (d)(3)(B) but only at the request of
the applicant. An applicant may request parking incentives or concessions
beyond those provided in this subdivision pursuant to subsection (d)(3)(G).
(e) Application
review process. All applications shall be reviewed in accordance with
the provisions of Title 9 of the Municipal Code. The City Council,
upon recommendation by the Planning Commission, shall make a positive
finding for each of the following categories before approving an application:
(1) General Plan consistency. A finding that the project application
is consistent with the General Plan Land Use Element if the intensity
of development is in compliance with the design standards as outlined
in Table 3-17.
Findings of inconsistency with other elements shall be restricted
to specific areas of demonstrated public health and safety hazards
to future residents of the proposed development.
(2) Municipal Code consistency. A finding that the project application
is consistent with design criteria herein as well as meeting all other
provisions of this Title 9.
(3) Potential adverse impacts on adjacent properties. A finding that
the project does not have an adverse impact upon the surrounding properties
that cannot be reduced or minimized by a design change or condition
regulating the project’s operation.
(4) CC&R. A finding that the CC&R have included the provisions
and terms of affordability as drafted in the affordability agreement
for the project.
(Ord. No. 869, § 2; Ord. No. 1007, § 3, 2014; Ord. No. 1082, § 18, 2021)
(a) Purpose
and intent. This section provides standards for the development of
communication systems and their support components in San Juan Capistrano.
The standards are intended to balance rights and privileges granted
under federal statutes with the need to ensure a quality community
aesthetic. To maintain the aesthetic quality of San Juan Capistrano,
co-location of cellular, pcs, or other wireless antennas is encouraged
by the City.
(b) Antenna regulations (excluding amateur radio antennas). This subsection addresses the regulation of all antennas except for amateur radio antennas, which are addressed in subsection
(c) of this section.
(1) Video and radio antennas.
(A) Allowable video and radio antennas. The following antenna are allowed
in all districts subject to subsection (b)(1)(C) Development standards
of this section and subsection (b)(3) Design standards of this section:
(i)
Common skeletal radio and television antennas, excluding amateur
radio, used to receive UHF, VHS, AM and FM which do not extend higher
than 12 feet above the roofline of the main building.
(ii)
Dish antennas that are one meter or less in diameter and do
not extend higher than 12 feet above the roofline of the main building.
(iii)
Antennas designed to receive video programming services via
MMDS (wireless cable) of one meter or less in diameter or diagonal
measurement which do not extend higher than 12 feet above the roofline
of the main building.
(B) Conditional uses. Antennas described in subdivision (b)(1)(A) of this subsection exceedin
g 12 feet in height above the roofline of the main building are subject to Conditional Use Permit review pursuant to Section
9-3.317 Conditional Use Permit. A finding that the additional height is necessary to receive an adequate signal and that the public safety will not be negatively affected is required for approval of the Conditional Use Permit. Antennas with an approved Conditional Use Permit are subject to subsection (b)(1)(C) Development standards of this section and subsection (b)(3) Design standards of this section.
(C) Development standards. Table 3-18 identifies the developments standards
applicable to all video and radio antennas located in the City.
Table 3-18
Video and Radio Antenna Development Standards (Excluding Amateur
Radio Antenna)
|
---|
Development Standards
|
Zone
|
---|
Residential
|
Commercial
|
Industrial/All Other Zones
|
---|
Restriction on Location
|
No antenna or its supporting structure shall be located in the
area between the front property line and the main structure or building.
|
Permitted Location
|
Rear or side yard, except street side.
|
Rear or side yard, except street side.
|
Rear or side yard, except street side.
|
Distance from Property Line (minimum)
|
Side yard setback for district and at least 5 feet from the
back property line.
|
Maximum Permitted Height
|
12 feet higher than the roofline. (a)
|
Maximum Number of Antennas per Lot
|
2 (including telecommunication and amateur radio antennas)
|
Roof-mounted Antennas Permitted?
|
Only when required for adequate signal reception.
|
Yes, if mounted on flat portion of roof with parapets or other
screening that matches structure architecture.
|
Yes, if mounted on flat portion of roof with parapets or other
screening that matches structure architecture.
|
Note:
|
---|
(a)
|
Unless a Conditional Use Permit is approved. A variance is not
required if the allowable antenna height exceeds the maximum height
allowed in the base district.
|
(2) Telecommunication antennas and facilities.
(A) Conditional uses. All telecommunications antennas and facilities, including cellular, pcs, and other wireless telecommunication services, are a compatible use for all districts, subject to Conditional Use Permit review and approval, as specified in Section
9-2.317 Conditional Use Permit. Telecommunications antennas and facilities will only be conditionally allowed in residential districts when the applicant can prove that the facility is required for adequate signal reception. All telecommunications antennas and facilities are subject to subsection (b)(2)(B) Development standards, of this section and subsection (b)(3) Design standards, of this section.
(B) Development Standards. Table 3-19 identifies the developments standards
applicable to all telecommunication antennas and facilities located
in the City.
Table 3-19
Telecommunication Antennas and Facilities Development Standards
|
---|
Development Standards
|
Residential
|
Commercial
|
Industrial/All Other Zones
|
---|
Location In District
|
Only allowed when required for adequate signal reception.
|
Minimum set back of 300 feet from any residential zone.
|
Minimum set back of 300 feet from any residential zone.
|
Restriction on Location
|
No telecommunications antenna or its supporting structure shall
be located in the area between the front property line and the main
structure or building.
|
Permitted Location on Property
|
Rear or side yard, except street side.
|
Rear or side yard, except street side
|
Rear or side yard.
|
Distance from Property Line (minimum)
|
Side yard setback for district and at least 5 feet from the
back property line.
|
Side yard setback for district and at least 5 feet from the
back property line.
|
Side yard setback for district and at least 5 feet from the
back property line.
|
(3) Design Standards.
(A) Design Standards. All antennas, excluding amateur radio antennas,
including guy wires, supporting structures, and accessory equipment,
shall be located and designed to minimize their visual impact as viewed
from surrounding properties and public streets. The following minimum
design standards shall apply:
(i)
Material used. All antennas and supporting structures or components
shall be of nonreflective, glare-reducing materials. Colors and materials
for antennas and their components shall be chosen to minimize visibility
and to match or blend with the primary background.
(ii)
Screening: All telecommunications antennas and facilities, including
cellular, pcs, and other wireless communications antennas, shall be
designed to blend with the surrounding environment and to be as unobtrusive
as possible. Screening shall be provided in the form of fencing, landscaping,
structures, or parapets integral to the building, as shown in Figure
3-2. Such screening and maintenance shall be provided to the satisfaction
of the Planning Director.
(iii)
Multiple-use facilities. Antennas may be integrated into existing
or newly developed facilities and structures that are functional for
other purposes, such as ballfield lights, flag poles, and clock towers.
All multiple-use facilities shall be designed to camouflage the antennas,
as shown in Figure 3-1.
Figure 3-1 Multiple-Use Facilities Antenna
|
(iv)
Building-mounted antennas. Building-mounted antennas shall be
integrated into the architecture of the building or structure, or
be designed to be visually integrated with the host structure, as
shown in Figure 3-2.
Figure 3-2 Building-Mounted Antennas
|
(B) Performance Standards. The following regulations shall apply to the
establishment, installation, and operation of all antennas, excluding
amateur radio antennas, in all districts:
(i)
Telecommunications facilities shall be located no closer to
existing or other approved telecommunication facilities than the minimum
distance necessary to provide adequate service.
(ii)
Antennas shall use the smallest and least visually intrusive
antennas and components that meet the requirements of the facility.
(iii)
No advertising materials shall be allowed on any antenna.
(iv)
Underground electrical wiring. All electrical wiring associated
with any antenna shall be buried underground or otherwise hidden in
a manner acceptable to the Planning Director.
(v)
Projection. No portion of an antenna array shall extend beyond
the property lines or into any front yard area. Guy wires may be attached
to the building, but shall not be anchored within any front yard area.
(vi)
Adequate grounding. Every antenna must be adequately grounded
with a ground wire for protection against a direct strike of lighting
in a manner acceptable to the Building Official.
(vii)
Maintenance. All screening elements including building and landscape
elements shall be maintained in a safe and structurally sound condition
consistent with approved plans.
(c) Amateur
radio antenna regulations.
(1) The following regulations shall apply to amateur radio antennas.
These regulations shall not preclude enforcement by homeowner associations
or private parties of Covenants, Conditions and Restrictions (CC&R),
Declaration of Restrictions, or any other private contracts or agreements
between parties. Amateur radio antenna permit applications shall be
approved administratively by the Planning Director provided the antennas
meet the criteria and development standards contained in this section.
(2) Amateur radio antenna development standards. Amateur radio antennas,
structures, and masts that comply with the development standards specified
in this section are permitted, subject to issuance of an antenna permit
from the Planning Department and any other applicable City permits
(i.e. building permit, etc.).
The development standards criteria regulating height, setbacks,
location, and maximum number of antennas are set forth in Table 3-20.
Other additional requirements include:
(A) License requirement. An applicant for an amateur radio antenna shall
possess a valid amateur radio license issued by the FCC. A copy of
the amateur radio license shall be required upon submittal of an antenna
permit application to the City.
(B) City permit requirement. Prior to installation or modification of
an amateur radio antenna, an applicant shall obtain:
(i)
Approval of a permit for the antenna from the Department of
Planning Services;
(ii)
A City building permit, if required by the Building Official,
and shall comply with all applicable regulations imposed by the Building
and Engineering Department.
(3) Administrative approval of antenna permit. The Planning Director shall prescribe the type and form of information required to process an administrative amateur radio antenna permit. The administrative permit shall be processed according to Section
9-2.303 Administrative Approvals.
(4) Emergency services. Upon permission by the amateur radio operator,
the City will include the individual’s name, address, and contact
numbers on an emergency resource volunteer list for inclusion in the
City’s emergency plan.
(5) Antenna maintenance. All property owners must maintain their antennas
to the minimum levels of maintenance care as set forth below:
(A) Finish. The antenna finish shall be maintained in such a manner that
its appearance is unobtrusive and blends with the neighborhood in
which it is located. Any conditions relating to antenna finish imposed
by the City shall be maintained consistent with the condition of permit
approval.
(B) Screening. All landscaping required by the City, to provide screening
shall be maintained in a healthy condition free of dead, decayed,
overgrown, or discarded plant material. The type and location of landscape
material shall be maintained consistent with the permit approval.
(C) Mechanical/structural. All mechanical, structural, and moving parts
of the antenna support structure and/or antennas (including wires,
projections, and array elements) shall be maintained in good working
order and in a safe appearance.
(d) Nonconforming antennas. All nonconforming antennas lawfully constructed and erected prior to the effective date of the ordinance codified in this section are subject to Section
9-3.533 Nonconforming Uses, Lots, and Structures.
(e) Abandonment.
(1) All approvals for antenna facilities shall be in effect only while
the facilities are being operated on a continual basis. When the use
is replaced or discontinued for a period of 180 days, the approval
shall lapse, and the operator or property owner shall be required
to remove the facility and all associated equipment, and to restore
the property to its original or otherwise acceptable condition, subject
to the approval of the Planning Director.
(2) For all antenna facilities requiring a Conditional Use Permit, a faithful performance bond to ensure the removal of abandoned facilities shall be posted prior to the issuance of building permits in accordance with Section
9-5.101 Fees, Deposits, and Bonds.
(f) Compatibility
of regulations. Notwithstanding the regulations contained in this
section, the provisions of this Code shall comply with the regulations
of the Federal Communications Commission, as may be amended, that
apply to antennas.
(Ord. No. 869, § 2)
(a) Purpose
and intent. The City finds and determines that the purpose and intent
of this section is to:
(1) Preserve and maintain structures within the City of historic, architectural,
and cultural significance and allow for the adaptive reuse for economic
benefit in such structures including bed and breakfast establishments;
(2) Promote and enhance the City’s economic health, in particular
the tourism industry, by providing for the development of alternative
visitor accommodations;
(3) Assure that the development of bed and breakfast establishments is
accomplished in an appropriate manner and is compatible with existing
development, in particular single-family residential neighborhoods;
(4) Assure that bed and breakfast establishments are operated and maintained
in such a manner so as to be conducive to protecting the health, safety,
and general welfare of City residents and visitors to the community.
(b) Land
use regulations.
(1) Bed and breakfast establishments may only be developed within a structure
which has been listed on the “Inventory of Cultural and Historic
Landmarks,” or designated as a State Historic Landmark or as
a National Historic Landmark. In such cases, conditional use permits
will be subject to review and recommendation by the Cultural Heritage
Commission.
(2) The development of any bed and breakfast establishment shall be subject to approval of a conditional use permit by the Planning Commission as provided by Section
9-2.317 Conditional Use Permit. Such uses shall be required to demonstrate compliance with all provisions contained within this section as well as other applicable sections of the title.
(3) Site development and architectural alterations. No building alterations/additions shall be permitted which detract from the architectural significance of the structure. All exterior building alterations and site development shall be subject to development review as provided under Section
9-2.313 Architectural Control Review. Furthermore, exterior building alterations shall be consistent with the criteria established by the Secretary of the Interior’s “Standards for Rehabilitation.”
(c) Development
standards. Bed and breakfast establishments shall comply with the
following standards:
(1) Off-street parking. Off-street parking shall be provided at the rate of two spaces for the resident manager and one space for each guest room. The design and location of entrances and off-street parking shall be consistent with the provisions of Section
9-3.535 Parking. Guest parking shall be situated to the rear or sides of the principal structure.
(2) Signs. Bed and breakfast establishments shall be limited to one externally-illuminated
sign not exceeding eight square feet in area and will be reviewed
as part of the development review process. The materials and design
of signs shall be compatible with the architectural style of the principal
structure. Signs shall not be situated within the required setbacks
of the district in which the establishment is located.
(3) Number of rooms. The maximum allowable number of rooms will be determined
by the Planning Commission as part of the conditional use permit process.
(4) Significant site features. The Planning Commission, as a condition
of approval, may require the preservation and maintenance of significant
features including landscaping or historic, architectural, or cultural
features of the structure or property.
(d) Operational
standards.
(1) Board accommodations. Guest rooms shall not be provided with kitchens
nor similar food preparation facilities. Establishments may provide
complete boarding for guests only. However, if the zone district in
which the establishment is located allows restaurant uses, such uses
may be permitted in conjunction with the bed and breakfast use.
(2) Guest term. Guests may be permitted to stay within a single establishment
not more than 14 continuous days during any given 30 day period.
(3) Resident manager. The manager of the bed and breakfast establishment
shall reside within the bed and breakfast structure and the primary
use of the structure shall be residential. The manager may be the
property owner or person retained by the property owner for the specific
purpose of managing the bed and breakfast, establishment.
(4) Time share facilities. Time share facilities shall be prohibited
within bed and breakfast establishments.
(5) Weddings. Weddings, wedding receptions, and similar activities shall only be permitted subject to the approval of a conditional use permit by the Planning Commission, pursuant to Section
9-2.317 Conditional Use Permit.
(e) Public
health requirements.
(1) Health permit. Bed and breakfast establishments and restaurants in
conjunction with such establishments shall be required to comply with
the Orange County Health Department provisions and secure any necessary
permits prior to the conditional use permit becoming effective.
(2) Fire and life safety. Guest rooms shall be provided with a smoke
detector, hand-held fire extinguisher, and evacuation plan subject
to the review of the Orange County Fire Authority. The City may require
the installation of a sprinkler system or other appropriate safety
measures on the recommendation of the Orange County Fire Authority.
(Ord. No. 869, § 2)
(a) Purpose. The State Legislature found in
Food and Agricultural Code Section 29000 that a healthy and vibrant apiary industry is important to the economy and welfare of the people of the State of California and the protection of the industry is in the interest of the people of the State.
Food and Agricultural Code Section 29000 et seq., as well as California Code of Regulation Title
3 Food and Agriculture, Article 3, establish regulation for apiaries that are enforced by the Director of the State Department of Agriculture and California Department of Pesticide Regulation. This chapter establishes regulations intended to implement and supplement State regulations and ensures that bee keepers maintain apiaries in a responsible manner as to protect the health, safety, and welfare of the citizens of the City of San Juan Capistrano.
(b) General
provisions.
(1) Noncommercial honey beekeeping shall be allowed as a permitted use
on properties within the City’s Agriculture (A), Planned Community
(PC) and Specific Plan/Precise Plan (SP/PP) zoning districts.
(2) Noncommercial honey beekeeping shall be allowed as a permitted accessory
use on residential properties within the City’s Residential/Agriculture
(RA) zoning district.
(3) Noncommercial honey beekeeping shall be conditionally allowed on
residential properties located within the City’s Hillside Residential
(HR), Single-Family (RSE) 40,000 and Single-Family (RSE) 20,000 zoning
districts.
(4) Noncommercial beekeeping must be in conjunction with the residential
use of a lot, where the lot size is greater than 15,000 gross square
feet.
(5) All honey beekeeping shall be in compliance with the code standards
below, unless modified by the Planning Commission through the Conditional
Use Permit process.
(c) Definitions.
The following words and terms shall have the meaning ascribed in this
section unless the context of their usage clearly indicated another
meaning:
"Apiary"
means the assembly of one or more managed colonies of honey
bees at a single location.
"Beekeeper"
means a person who own, operates, maintains, possesses or
otherwise controls an apiary and/or the owner of the property upon
which an apiary is situated.
"Colony" or “hive”
means an aggregate of honey bees consisting principally of
workers, but having, when perfect, one queen and at times many drones,
including brood, combs, honey and the receptacle inhabited by the
bees.
"Flyover barrier"
is a solid wall, fence, or dense vegetation or combination
thereof that provides an obstruction through which honey bees cannot
readily fly.
"Bee sensitive property"
is a property where people such as the elderly, small children,
individuals with medical conditions or confined animals inhabit or
frequent that are more at risk if honey bee stinging incidents were
to occur. These properties include, but are not limited to, properties
that contain schools, playgrounds, picnic areas, outdoor sports facilities,
daycare centers, senior care facilities, medical facilities, kennels
and horse-boarding facilities. Property owners or residents may petition
their property to be determined a bee sensitive site based on documented
medical conditions.
"Undesirable bee behavior"
is any behavior exhibited by bees from a managed hive, colony
or apiary that may result in harm to others. Undesirable bee behavior
includes, but is not limited to, characteristics of Africanized honey
bees where minimal or no provocation results in over-defensiveness,
aggressiveness, repeated swarming, unpredictability, reactiveness,
and agitation by the bees.
(d) Code
standards.
(1) All honey bee colonies shall be kept in Langstroth-type hives with
removable frames, which shall be kept in sound and usable condition.
(2) It is unlawful to keep more than 10 colonies or hives on any lot
within the City.
(3) Apiaries shall not be located within a front yard, a street side
yard or within any required rear or side yard setback.
(4) Apiaries shall be located a minimum of 100 feet from any adjacent
residential dwelling unit and a minimum of 150 feet from any “bee
sensitive property.”
(5) If a colony is situated within 25 feet of a property line, the bee
keeper shall establish and maintain a “flyover barrier”
of at least six feet in height consisting of a solid wall, fence,
dense vegetation or combination between the colony and the property
line.
(6) Beekeepers shall post signage on gates into the rear yard where hives
are kept which states that beekeeping is practiced on site and identifies
the species of bees, the number of colonies, and the beekeeper’s
name and telephone number.
(7) No marketing or advertising is allowed.
(8) Beekeepers shall maintain an adequate and accessible supply of fresh
water available to the bees at all times. Beekeepers shall not allow
the water to become stagnant or a mosquito breeding site.
(9) No beekeeper shall own or operate an apiary that exhibits undesirable
bee behavior, contains apiary pests, or is an abandoned apiary.
(e) Enforcement.
Upon receipt of information that any colony situated within the City
is not being kept in compliance with these regulations, the Director
shall initiate an investigation. If the Director finds that one or
more violations have occurred, a written notice of violation and administrative
citations shall be issued to the beekeeper. If the beekeeper refuses
to take corrective action, the Director may order the bees destroyed
or removed from the City.
(Ord. No. 1076, § 11,
2020)
Caretaker residences may be developed as permitted in specific
district per this chapter for the exclusive use of personnel employed
for the maintenance and security of the principal use, subject to
the following provisions:
(a) Outside
the Floodplain Management District.
(1) Permanent caretaker residences located outside the Floodplain Management
District are subject to the following requirements:
(A) Must be listed as a permitted use in the applicable district.
(B) Must meet all yard setback requirements of the applicable district.
(b) Within the Floodplain Management District. All caretakers residences situated within the Floodplain Management District shall comply with the provisions of Section
9-3.405 Floodplain Management (FM) District as well as the provisions established by this section.
(c) Temporary caretaker residences. Temporary caretaker residences are subject to Section
9-3.553 Temporary Uses and Structures.
(Ord. No. 869, § 2)
(a) Purpose. The keeping of chickens in the City supports a local, sustainable
food system by providing an affordable, nutritious source of protein
through fresh eggs.
(b) General provisions.
(1) Noncommercial chicken keeping shall be allowed in all zoning districts
where animal grazing, breeding, boarding, raising and training is
a permitted use.
(2) Noncommercial chicken keeping shall be allowed in the City’s
Residential/Agriculture (RA) district as a permitted accessory use.
(3) Noncommercial chicken keeping shall be allowed in the City’s
Hillside Residential (HR), Single-Family (RSE) 40,000 and Single-Family
(RSE) 20,000 districts as a permitted use.
(4) In residential districts, noncommercial chicken keeping must be in
conjunction with the residential use of a lot.
(5) Noncommercial chicken keeping is limited to lots greater than 15,000
gross square feet in size.
(6) All noncommercial chicken keeping shall be in compliance with the
code standards below.
(c) Definitions. The following words and terms shall have the meaning
ascribed in this section unless the context of their usage clearly
indicated another meaning:
"Chicken"
means the common domestic fowl (Gallus gallus) that is used
for meat and laying eggs, which includes both the male and female
members of the species.
"Hen"
means a female chicken.
"Chicken coop"
means a constructed or prefabricated structure where chickens
are kept safe and secure that includes nest boxes for egg-laying and
perches on which the chickens can sleep.
"Chicken run"
means an enclosed area that is either attached or detached
from a chicken coop in which chickens are allowed to roam freely.
(d) Code standards.
(1) No roosters and no more than six hens may be kept on any property
located in the City’s Hillside Residential (HR), Single-Family
(RSE) 40,000 and Single-Family (RSE) 20,000 districts.
(2) Chicks shall not be counted toward the maximum allowed number of
chickens until they have reached the age of four months.
(3) A chicken coop shall be provided for any chickens kept on a property.
The required chicken coop shall not exceed five feet in height, shall
not be located within any code-required building setback, shall be
located a minimum of 100 feet from any adjoining residential buildings
and shall not be visible from any adjoining public or private streets.
(4) A chicken run shall be provided for any chickens kept on a property.
The required chicken run shall not exceed 500 square feet in area,
shall be located a minimum of 25 feet from any adjoining residential
buildings and shall not be visible from any adjoining public or private
streets. Chickens shall not be permitted to run at large outside of
the chicken run on the lot or off the lot.
(5) The chicken coop and chicken run shall be properly maintained so
as to prevent offensive odors and the presence of pests and predators.
(6) Chickens and/or conditions under which chickens are kept shall not
create a public nuisance and shall protect the public health and safety.
(7) Chickens shall not be subject to neglect, cruelty or abuse.
(8) Chicks or eggs produced by the chickens may not be sold commercially.
(9) The slaughtering of chickens is prohibited on residential properties.
(10) No marketing or advertising is allowed.
(e) Enforcement. Upon receipt of information that any chicken keeping
within the City is not being kept in compliance with these regulations,
the Director shall initiate an investigation. If the Director finds
that one or more violations have occurred, a written notice of violation
and administrative citations shall be issued to the property owner
and/or chicken keeper. If the property owner or chicken keeper refuses
to take corrective action, the Director may order the chickens removed
from the City.
(Ord. No. 1076, § 12,
2020)
(a) Purpose
and intent. The City finds and determines that the purpose and intent
of this section is to:
(1) Establish standards and criteria for the design of sites with drive-through
facilities, integrating operational elements, site and built form
design with a focus on assisting this use with making a positive contribution
to the surrounding context and pedestrian streetscape; and
(2) Ensure that business enterprises with drive-through facilities do
not result in adverse impacts on adjacent properties, surrounding
neighborhoods or roadways by reason of customer and employee parking
demands, queued traffic interference with on-site and off-site traffic
circulation and pedestrian flow, noise, light, glare, litter, or cumulative
impact of such demands in any one area; and
(3) Allow for the typical range of activities while ensuring public safety
and mitigating associated impacts; and
(4) Ensure that existing and proposed drive-through facilities are consistent
with the goals and policies of the General Plan.
(b) Applicability.
(1) The regulations of this section shall apply to all Drive-through
facilities, as defined in Appendix A (Definitions). The regulations
shall apply to new developments, the addition of drive-through facilities
to existing developments, and the relocation or substantial remodel
of an existing drive-through facility. A substantial remodel to drive-through
facilities consists of any on-site building or property alterations,
improvements, and additions requiring a building, grading or demolition
permit which have a construction value of 51% of the current year
assessed improvement value.
(c) Land
use regulations.
(1) All drive-through facilities as identified by this section shall
be limited to development in the following specific commercial zoning
districts:
(A) Neighborhood Commercial (NC)
(D) Commercial Manufacturing (CM)
(2) All drive-through facilities shall require approval of a discretionary
use permit approved by the City Council.
(3) Discretionary use permits for establishments with drive-through facilities
shall be granted only after applicable criteria adopted by the City
have been applied to each application, to the satisfaction of the
City Council.
(d) Traffic
impact study.
(1) A detailed traffic impact analysis shall be submitted by the City
in accordance with San Juan Capistrano Administrative Policy 310 (AP310)
and shall include the following information:
(A) Nature of the product or service being offered.
(B) Number of menu items being offered.
(C) Method by which the order is processed.
(D) Estimated time required for each transaction.
(E) Estimated arrival rate of customers.
(G) All existing and proposed points of ingress and egress, circulation
and maneuvering areas, off-street parking and loading areas.
(H) Separately tabulate the number of required off-street parking, and
proposed loading and stacking lane length and width in a conspicuous
place on the plan for reference, including drive aisle turning radii
width.
(I) Existing traffic conditions—Average daily and peak hour volumes,
average and peak speeds, sight distances, accident data for the previous
three years, and levels of service (LOS) of intersections and streets
affected by the proposed development. Generally, such data shall be
presented for all streets and intersections adjacent to or within
1,000 lineal feet of the property boundaries, and shall be no more
than 12 months old at the date of application, unless another date
is specifically approved.
(J) Projected impacts of the proposed development shall include: Projected
peak hour and daily traffic generated by the development on roads
and streets in the vicinity of the development; sight lines at the
intersections of the proposed access connection and adjacent streets;
existing and proposed traffic controls in the vicinity of the proposed
development; and the projected post development traffic volumes and
level of service of intersections and streets likely to be affected
by the proposed development.
(K) If a significant impact is identified, proposed mitigation shall
include: A plan (with supporting text) to minimize traffic and safety
impacts through such means as physical design and layout concepts,;
and an interior traffic and pedestrian circulation plan designed to
minimize conflicts and safety problems.
(L) The proposed mitigation plan shall result in 100% of stacking lane
traffic off the streets 100% of the time.
(e) Development
standards.
(1) Architecture and site design.
(A) Franchise or “branded” architecture is strongly discouraged.
Architectural details of new buildings and additions, including carports
and covered drive-through windows and lanes shall be harmonious with
the City’s adopted Architectural Design Guidelines and shall
preserve and enhance the character of the surrounding neighborhood
area.
(2) Curb cuts.
(A) Drive-through facilities on single lots shall be encouraged to minimize
the number of curb cuts to arterial streets to one.
(B) Drive-through facilities within larger commercial centers are encouraged
to coordinate with existing curb cuts that result in good site and
traffic operations design, to improve pedestrian safety on the major
street sidewalk.
(C) The maximum driveway width shall be 35 feet at the intersection of a public sidewalk (per Section
9-4.511).
(3) Menu/order boards.
(A) All drive-through menu boards/order board signs are subject to Section
9-3.543 of the City’s Municipal Code, and to “Chapter 8: Signs” of the City’s Architectural Design Guidelines.
(B) All menu/order boards shall be screened from the public right-of-way.
(4) Speaker boxes.
(A) A speaker box located within or independent of a menu board/order board, shall comply with noise standards as described in Section
9-3.531 of the Municipal Code.
(5) Off-street parking.
(A) Off-street parking shall be considered based on the traffic impact
analysis in accordance with San Juan Capistrano Administrative Policy
310 (AP310).
(B) Parking shall be provided by the drive-through facility and shall
be calculated at the rate of one space for every four patrons, based
on restaurant capacity, in addition to a calculation of one space
per drive-through facility employee per shift.
(C) Parking is encouraged to be located at the rear of the building out
of view of the public right-of-way.
(6) Landscaping.
(A) Landscaping shall be consistent with the Community Design Element
described in the General Plan.
(B) The use of mature trees is encouraged to provide an immediate impact
when used in buffering adjacent uses and throughout paved areas and
along pedestrian pathways.
(C) Landscaping shall be used to screen operational elements of the development,
such as stacking lanes, driveways, parking, and mechanical equipment.
(D) Landscaping shall allow for visibility for pedestrians and cross-traffic.
(E) All setbacks adjacent to public streets shall be landscaped.
(7) Screening.
(A) Screening shall be consistent with Section 2, “Parking Lot
Landscaping” as described in “E. Landscaping Guidelines”
under “Chapter 4: Design Guidelines” of the City’s
Architectural Design Guidelines.
(B) Garbage dumpsters external to the building shall be completely concealed
by a wall or enclosed with the same materials as the building.
(C) Solid masonry/block walls shall be comprised of a finished earth
grade consistent with the City’s streetscape and architectural
standards.
(D) Exterior utilities not located underground or integrated as an enclosed
portion of the building, shall be screened from public view, yet maintain
visibility for pedestrians and cross-traffic, in accordance with the
City’s Design Guidelines.
(E) Garbage dumpsters external to the building shall be completely concealed
by a wall or enclosed with the same materials as the building.
(f) Operational
standards.
(1) Lighting.
(A) Lighting shall comply with Municipal Code Section
9-3.529
(B) Lighting shall be energy efficient, and shielded, nonblinking and
nonflashing.
(C) Lighting shall not be of high intensity or brightness.
(D) Lighting shall be appropriate in scale, intensity and height.
(2) Trash.
(A) Applicants for a discretionary use permit shall submit a litter cleanup
plan and a waste management plan.
(Ord. No. 971, § 5, 2010)
(a) Unlawful
nuisances. No person may willfully make or maintain, or cause to be
made or maintained, any unusual and unnecessary dust which causes
discomfort or annoyance to any person of normal sensitivities. Standards
which may be considered in determining whether a violation of this
subsection exists may include, but not be limited to the following
factors:
(1) The intensity of the dust;
(2) The origin and composition of the dust;
(3) The proximity to residential areas;
(4) The duration of the dust, whether continuous or intermittent;
(5) Whether the dust is produced by commercial or noncommercial activities;
and
(6) The presence of other contributing factors.
(b) General
requirements. Any person engaged in the construction, repair, remodeling,
gliding, excavating, or landscaping of any real property, as a minimum
precaution and as a preventative measure, shall be required to do
the following:
(1) The site, and the areas traversed or used by vehicles, including
trucks and other equipment and machinery, shall be sprayed and watered
sufficiently to suppress dust penetration at all times.
(2) All such vehicles and equipment shall travel along established and
properly watered roadways at all practicable times.
(3) All vehicles hauling dirt or other particulate material shall be
sprayed prior to their leaving the construction or grading site.
(4) All operations which tend to create or cause dust shall be suspended
when the wind velocity is sufficient to cause dust by its own force
and intensity.
(5) The maximum speed of all trucks and other vehicles within the site
shall not exceed 15 miles per hour.
(6) The area or site shall be sufficiently secured to prevent the intrusion
of unauthorized vehicles at all times.
(7) All vehicles handling dirt to or from a construction site shall be
required to have their wheels scrubbed prior to leaving the project
site to remove dirt from wheels.
(8) All development projects that are importing/exporting dirt shall
be required to maintain all streets in a dirt free condition.
(9) All development projects shall comply with National Pollutant Discharge
Elimination System and Best Management Practices as appropriate.
(c) Applicability.
The provisions of this section shall apply to all land use activities,
except that it shall not apply to agricultural activities provided
that the combined disturbed surface area within one continuous property
line and not separated by a paved public road is 10 acres or less,
nor apply to other exceptions as allowed by the South Coast Air Quality
Management District Rule 403.
(d) Violations. Any person violating any provision of this section shall be subject to the penalties set forth in Section
9-1.201, Violations and Penalties. In addition, the operation or maintenance of any device, instrument, vehicle, equipment, or machinery in violation of any provision of this section, which operation or maintenance causes discomfort or annoyance to persons of normal sensitivities or which endangers the comfort, repose, health, or peace of residents in the area, shall be deemed and declared to be a public nuisance and may be subject to abatement summarily by a restraining order or an injunction issued by a court of competent jurisdiction. Furthermore, the expense of such abatement, by resolution of the City Council, may be declared to be a lien against the property on which such nuisance is maintained, and such lien shall be made a personal obligation of the property owner.
(Ord. No. 869, § 2)
(a) Purpose
and Intent. The purpose of this section is to establish provisions
and procedures that will ensure that the City will continue to realize
the benefits of the equestrian community; support the equestrian lifestyle;
protect the natural environment; provide watershed protection; and
maintain the aesthetics and community character. The provisions of
this ordinance are enacted to:
(1) Provide appropriate design standards and criteria for keeping and
protection of equine on private property;
(2) Create, enhance, and protect the equestrian and rural atmosphere
by integrating open space areas and multi-use trails into equestrian
oriented development;
(3) Achieve visually pleasing and compatible relationships between buildings
and accessory structures, multi-use trails, open space areas, and
the natural environment by providing appropriate buffers between equestrian
and nonequestrian uses;
(4) Comply with requirements set forth in City, State and Federal law;
(5) Protect the public, health, safety, and general welfare.
(b) Applicability.
The regulations in this section shall apply to all commercial stables
and noncommercial stables located within the City. All stables shall
be required to adhere to all development and operational standards
as set forth in this section.
(c) Commercial
Stables.
(1) For the purposes of this section, “commercial stables”
shall mean any place where horses or other equine are kept, housed,
boarded, lodged, fed, hired, trained, sold, rented, or bred for monetary
compensation.
(2) For the purposes of this section, “multi-use” trails
shall mean trails that are used for equine, hiking, and bicycles.
(3) Setbacks. The setback requirements set forth in Table 3-21 shall
pertain to all equestrian related structures, including, but not limited
to, paddocks, corrals, arenas, barns, box stalls, and fly-tight manure
bins, except pastures, grazing areas, and access roads. For the purposes
of this section “Setback” is defined in Appendix A, Figure
13.
Table 3-21
Commercial Stable Setbacks
|
---|
Location
|
Minimum Setback*
|
---|
Front Yard
|
50 feet*
|
Side Yard
|
25 feet* (May be reduced to five feet if the interior side yard
is adjacent to another commercial stable)
|
Rear Yard
|
Five feet*
|
*
|
All structures shall maintain a minimum of 100 feet from any
property which is used, zoned, or shown on the General Plan for residential
use. No paddock, box stall, or corral shall be located within 100
feet of any school, hospital or similar institution as measured from
the property line.
|
(4) General Development Standards. The establishment of a commercial equestrian stable, as defined by this section and as identified in specific zoning districts, shall require approval of a Conditional Use Permit, except that minor increases in existing stable density may be approved administratively in accordance with subsection
9-3.515(c)(3)(A)(ii) of this section. The requirement for a Conditional Use Permit is necessary in order to consider the following issues before such a use could be established: (1) ability of the site to accommodate the use; (2) compatibility with areas adjacent to the keeping of equines; (3) determination on the number of horses that the site and its specific location can accommodate; and (4) compatibility of its design with the surrounding land uses. Commercial equestrian stables shall comply with the following general development standards:
(A) Maximum Equine Density.
(i)
The maximum number of equines allowed at a commercial equestrian
stable shall be as follows. For the purposes of this section, “usable
acre” is defined as that portion of the total site which is
relatively flat (not exceeding 10% slope) and which does not encroach
into the 100-year flood area as defined by the Federal Emergency Management
Agency (FEMA):
a.
The maximum density shall not exceed 10 equines per usable acre
where the stable does not have the ability to access a General Plan
designated equestrian/hiking trail.
b.
The maximum density shall not exceed 28 equines per usable acre
where the stable has the ability to access a General Plan designated
equestrian/hiking trail. For the purposes of this section, “access”
shall mean that said equestrian stable is located adjacent to an equestrian
easement such as a feeder trail that serves a General Plan designated
equestrian/hiking trail or trail(s) that are located in the vicinity.
(ii)
Minor Density Increases. The Community Development Director
shall be authorized to approve a minor increase in equine density
not to exceed 10% at an existing stable in accordance with this subsection.
a.
The Community Development Director
may approve a minor increase in equine density if the Community Development
Director finds that:
1.
The proposed density increase would not increase the existing
number of equines at the subject site by more than 10%;
2.
The subject site is lawfully operating in accordance with a previously approved Conditional Use Permit and the Conditional Use Permit establishes a horse density that is less than the maximum density allowed in Section
9-3.515(c)(3)(A)(i);
3.
The proposed density increase would comply with the development
standards and requirements set forth in this section;
4.
The proposed density increase would not exceed the maximum densities set forth in Section
9-3.515(c)(3)(A)(i);
5.
No prior density increase has been approved administratively
for the subject site. If a density increase has been previously approved
for the subject site then any further requests for density increases
shall require approval of a Conditional Use Permit Modification, said
modification shall be granted by the Planning Commission;
b.
The Community Development Director shall have the authority
to impose any conditions of approval deemed necessary to ensure compliance
with the standards and requirements set forth in this section;
c.
The Community Development Director shall have the authority
to inspect the property to ensure that property is in compliance with
any conditions that may be attached to the approved density increase;
d.
The Community Development Director shall have the authority
to modify or revoke such administrative approval if the Community
Development Director determines that the property is operating in
violation of any code requirement or condition of approval. Such modification
or revocation may be appealed to the Planning Commission;
(B) Maximum Building Height. The maximum building heights for equestrian
related structures are as follows:
Box Stalls: 25 feet;
Hay Storage structures: 35 feet;
Covered Arenas: 35 feet;
Stand Alone Office structures: 20 feet.
Equestrian-related structure with second floor ancillary uses:
35 feet.
Accessory structures (e.g., windmills, water tanks, etc.): 25
feet. The maximum building height for all equestrian related structures
shall be subject to final discretionary approval by the Planning Commission.
(C) Landscaping, Landscape Buffers, and Irrigation. The landscaping and
irrigation system shall be subject to review during the development
review process and shall require the following:
(i)
Commercial stables located adjacent to residentially zoned land
or public streets shall provide a fifteen-foot landscaped buffer area.
Said area shall include trees, shrubs and groundcover.
(ii)
A minimum five-foot buffer area with perimeter trees, shrubs,
and groundcover shall be provided adjacent to all property lines.
(iii)
An approved water conservation irrigation system shall be provided
to serve all landscape areas.
(D) Signs. All signs shall conform to the requirements of Section
9-3.543
(E) Lighting. All security lighting shall be such that it is directed onto the site. All lighting shall conform to the requirements of Section
9-3.529
(F) Access Roads. All access roads shall be finished with asphalt, aggregate
base, decomposed granite or equivalent material as approved by the
City Engineer. The extent of finished roads and the stable’s
circulation system shall be determined during the development review
process.
(G) Building Area. A maximum of 30% of the usable acres may be devoted
to buildings, covered areas, feed storage structures, impervious surface
parking areas, barns, caretaker residence, covered paddocks (roofed
areas only), offices and other covered structures. Uses which are
not to be considered in calculating building coverage are those support
uses which are open in character, including, but not limited to, open
arenas, open paddocks, pastures, hot walkers, wash racks, picnic areas,
pervious concrete/surfaces, etc. “Usable Acre” is that
defined by subsection (a)(3)(A)(i) of this section.
(H) Development procedures. The procedures for development shall be as
set forth in Article 3 Development Review Procedures of Chapter 2
of this title.
(I) Equestrian Shows and Exhibits. For the purposes of this section, equestrian shows and exhibits shall mean equine related events that are juried, provide instruction or demonstration to exhibitors and where participants will attend and perform. Said shows and exhibitions shall be permitted only at approved commercial stables, unless otherwise permitted by the City Council. Equestrian Shows and Exhibits shall require review and approval by the Community Development Director for major events. Major events shall be larger, sanctioned events which draw participants and attendees from out of the area and that create impacts to traffic, parking, noise, lighting or public safety. The Community Development Director shall have the authority to prescribe the type and form of information required for the Administrative Approval application. Applications to conduct an equine show or exhibit shall be submitted at least 14 business days prior to the scheduled event to the Community Development Department for either approval or denial pursuant to Section
9-2.303 Administrative Approvals.
(J) Minor events shall be exempt from this section. For the purposes
of this section, “Minor events” shall mean any event that
does not invite the general public and that takes place and is isolated
within the facility property boundary. However, said events shall
adhere to all other Municipal Code regulations and standards.
(K) Exterior sides which are to enclose structures shall be finished
with wood, stucco, masonry, or other material of similar texture and
durability.
(L) The roof material of structures shall be slate, tile, asphalt shingle,
colored corrugated metal or standing seam, or other material of similar
appearance, texture, substance, and durability as approved by the
Community Development Director.
(M) Fencing. Where equines are kept within paddocks and stables, fences
shall maintain a height of at least five feet and shall be of such
construction as to preclude the escape of equines. Said fencing shall
be constructed with wood, masonry, metal bar construction, heavy-gauge
metal wire or polyvinyl (that meets industry standards) or other appropriate
material as approved by the Community Development Director.
(N) Public Toilets. A minimum of one public bathroom for each sex shall
be provided. Portable outdoor bathroom facilities shall be permitted
for areas located within a FEMA-designated flood zone and may allow
use by both men and women. All other facilities shall be of permanent
construction.
(O) Maintenance. All stables shall be maintained in such a manner as
to insure the health and safety of all equines and the structural
integrity of all buildings, corrals, paddocks, barns and fences.
(P) Emergency Plan. All stables shall maintain an Equestrian Emergency
Plan. An Equestrian Emergency Plan shall be submitted to the City
Manager or designee, for approval once every four years. The Plan
shall include, but not be limited to, an emergency action checklist
that identifies the organization for emergency response and actions
to be taken during an emergency, and the identity of all staff, facilities,
number (quantity) of stalls, major equipment and supplies available
for emergency use, relocation sites and emergency contact information.
The City Manager or Designee may provide a template for a Plan that
meets the requirements hereunder.
(Q) Stable Management. The management of commercial stables shall meet
the requirements of the Orange County Environmental Health Department
to ensure that environmental impacts are kept at a minimum and shall
maintain a valid Animal Control permit issued by the Health Department
at all times.
(R) Employee Housing. In order to provide for the health and safety of equines and structures, caretaker residences may be established on the premises. Such residences shall meet the requirements set forth in Section
9-3.511 Caretaker Residences.
(S) All stables shall comply with all provisions and regulations of Municipal
Code Chapter 14 Water Regulations and with the City’s Equestrian—Related
Water Quality Best Management Practices Manual.
(d) Noncommercial
Stables. Noncommercial residential stables and equestrian facilities.
Equines may be maintained within residential districts where permitted,
subject to the provisions of this section. All such uses shall be
restricted to a private noncommercial activity.
(1) For the purposes of this section, noncommercial stables shall mean
any place where equines are kept for the use and enjoyment of the
occupants of the premises, or a noncommercial facility for the use
of a private homeowner association.
(2) Setbacks. The following setback requirements shall pertain to all
structures which relate to the keeping of equines, and exercise or
grazing areas. Such facilities shall be subject to the following provisions:
From property line to paddocks/stall on same lot:
Front yard: Twenty feet.
Side and rear yard: Fifteen feet.
From property line to pasture/exercise area on same lot:
Front yard: Twenty feet.
Side and rear yard: Ten feet.
From pasture/exercise area to setback line for residences on
adjacent lot:
Front yard: Thirty-five feet.
Side and rear yard: Thirty-five feet.
From pasture/exercise area and paddocks/stall to residence on
same lot:
Front yard: Zero feet.
Side and rear yard: Zero feet.
From paddocks/stall to setback line from residence on adjacent
lot:
Front yard: Fifty feet.
Side and rear yard: Fifty feet.
(3) General Development Standards.
(A) Equines may be kept within the Residential/Agriculture (RA), Hillside
Residential (HR), Single-Family-40,000 (RSE-40,000), Single-Family-20,000
(RSE-20,000), Single-Family-10,000 (RS-10,000), Single-Family-7,000
(RS-7,000), Residential Garden-7,000 (RG-7,000), Single-Family 4,000
(RS-4,000), Residential Garden-4,000 (RG-4,000), and Planned Community
(PC) Districts where common equestrian facilities are designed into
the development and equestrian trails are established adjacent to
all equestrian facilities or where access can be reasonably achieved
as determined by the Community Development Director. Developments
with common equestrian stables or corrals shall conform to the development
standards set forth in subsection (c) of this section for commercial
stables.
(B) Equines may be kept on individual lots within the Agri-Business (A),
Residential/Agriculture (RA), Hillside Residential (HR), Single-Family-40,000
(RSE-40,000), and Single-Family-20,000 (RSE-20,000) Districts provided
the following standards are met:
(i)
Number of horses/lot size. One equine per 10,000 square feet
of overall lot size.
(ii)
Minimum lot area for equestrian use. 2,500 square feet for the
first horse, of which 500 square feet must be flat (slope no greater
than 10%). For each additional horse beyond one, an additional 500
square feet of flat land shall be provided.
(iii)
Number of equines that require a conditional use permit.
a.
If the property is two acres or less, four equines may be kept
without needing a conditional use permit.
b.
If the property is between two and five acres, six equines may
be kept without needing a conditional use permit.
c.
If the property is more than five acres, 10 equines may be kept
without needing a conditional use permit.
For the purposes of this section, a mare and a foal (up to eight
months of age kept together) shall count as one horse.
|
(C) The roof material of equestrian-oriented accessory structures such
as barns, and stables shall be slate, tile, asphalt shingle, colored
corrugated metal or standing seam, or other material of similar appearance,
texture, substance, and durability as approved by the Community Development
Director.
(D) Perimeter Fencing. Perimeter fences shall maintain a height of at
least five feet and shall be of such construction as to preclude the
escape of equines. Said fencing shall be constructed with wood, masonry,
metal bar construction, polyvinyl (that meets industry standards)
or other appropriate screen material as approved by the Community
Development Director.
(e)
Nonconformities.
The nonconformities section shall apply only to Commercial Stables.
Nonconforming equestrian uses and/or structures shall be subject to
the following:
(A) Except as provided in this section, all existing buildings, structures,
fences, enclosures and uses of land, including the number of equines
allowed by this section, which do not conform to the provisions of
this section, but were existing as legal conforming uses or structures
on February 4, 2008, shall be considered legal nonconforming uses
and/or structures for purposes of this section.
(B) The owner of property with equestrian uses or structures that have
been rendered nonconforming by the provisions of this section shall
file a written, nonconformity statement with the Community Development
Director in order to establish a record of and the right to continue
the nonconforming uses or structures.
(C) The property owner desiring to establish the legal, nonconformity
of equestrian uses or structures shall file a written nonconformity
statement with the Community Development Director no later than four
months after the adoption of this chapter. Failure to do so will render
the nonconforming use as unlawful and will require discontinuance
of the use and removal of all equestrian uses and structures no later
than November 1, 2009.
(i) A written nonconformity statement shall include:
a. The ownership of the lot or parcel;
b. If the nonconformity involves the keeping of more than the maximum
allowable equines on a vacant or developed lot or parcel, or on any
combination of contiguous lots or parcels which are owned or under
the control of the same individual(s), a statement identifying the
owner of each animal kept on the subject property;
c. Permission from the owner for a City representative to enter upon
said lot or parcel to verify, inspect, and photograph the nonconforming
condition; and
d. Any additional information, as required by the Community Development
Director.
(ii) Upon submittal of the written nonconformity statement to the Community
Development Director, the Director or his or her representative shall
verify the nonconforming condition through a site visit to the property.
Upon verification of the nonconforming condition, the Community Development
Director shall keep on file a record of the nonconforming condition.
a. Code Enforcement Compliance. If an existing site condition is deemed
illegal by the City or is in a current state of Code Enforcement,
said property owner shall gain compliance prior to the City approving
and recording a nonconforming statement.
(iii)
Except as provided below, the acceptance and verification of
a written nonconformity statement by the Director shall permit the
nonconforming condition to continue as follows:
a. The boarding of equines on a lot or parcel or on any combination of contiguous lots or parcels which are owned or under the control of the same individual(s), shall be permitted to continue pursuant to Section
9-3.533 of this Code.
b. Nonconforming conditions may continue until abandoned by a change
of use or cessation of the equestrian use for longer than a six-month
period.
(iv) The Director shall cause each nonconformity statement which is issued
to be recorded with the county recorder. The recorded document shall
clearly describe the uses and/or structures that are allowed to continue
on the property.
(v) If no written nonconformity statement has been submitted to the Community
Development Director pursuant to this Section, or if the property
owner does not allow the Community Development Director or his/her
representative to verify the nonconforming condition, it shall be
presumed that the nonconforming condition was illegal at the time
of adoption of the ordinance establishing these regulations.
(D) Certificate of Compliance. Commercial stables that have provided
documentation proving compliance with applicable Municipal codes shall
be issued a Certificate of Compliance. To assist the City in making
the determination of compliance the required documents may include
facility entitlements, record drawings/maps of the facility, building
permits, and similar records of land use approval.
(Ord. No. 869, § 2, as
amended by § 3 Exh. B, Ord. 937, Ord. No. 958, § 2 (Exh. A), 5-19-2009)
(a) General.
Fences, walls, and hedges may be erected within required yard setbacks
in all districts subject to the requirements of this section.
For the purposes of this section, the words “fence”
and “wall” shall have the same meaning, and any reference
to fences shall include walls as well. In addition, all height restrictions
applying to fences and walls shall apply equally to hedges planted
within required yards forming a barrier serving the same visual purpose
as a fence or wall.
(b) All
districts. “Fences” and walls for the following uses shall
be subject to the location, height and design standards so stipulated
by the referenced section of the Code:
(1) Fences to be located within corner lots shall be in compliance with the visibility provisions of Section
9-3.559 Visibility at Intersections/Driveways.
(2) Fences adjacent to a driveway shall be in compliance with the visibility provisions of Section
9-3.559 Visibility at Intersections/Driveways.
(3) All swimming pools, whirlpools and spas shall be enclosed by a minimum five-foot-high (5) fence designed and located in accordance with the provisions of Title
8. Chapter 6.
(4) Storage of outside materials shall be subject to the location and design regulations of Section
9-3.549 Storage and Display.
(5) Tennis court fencing shall be in compliance with the setback and height requirements of Section
9-3.501 Accessory Uses and Structures.
(6) All fences and walls shall be finished on both sides. If adjacent
property owner refuses permission, provision shall be waived.
(c) Residential
districts. The following requirements shall apply to fences in all
residential districts:
(1) Fences erected within required side or rear yards shall not exceed a height of six feet. However; when the rear property line of a corner lot abuts the side property line of an adjoining lot (i.e., a “key lot” situation), fences on the exterior (street) side of a corner lot shall not exceed a height of three feet if placed within five feet of the street right-of-way line adjoining the side yard of a said corner lot. Further, fences within a required side yard on the exterior side of a corner lot shall conform to the requirements of Section
9-3.559 Visibility at Intersections/Driveways.
(2) Solid fences shall not exceed a height of three feet in any required
front yard. However, the Planning Director, upon an application, may
approve fences in front yards up to five feet in height if all of
the following requirements are met:
(A) The portion of the fence above three feet is of open vertical bar
construction (for example, wrought iron) with a minimum spacing of
three inches between vertical elements; and
(B) The City Engineer confirms that the proposed fence allows adequate
sight distance for vehicles using driveways and/or street intersections.
(d) Agricultural districts. Fences may be erected in the Agri-Business (A) District up to a height of six feet within all required yards provided such fences conform to the requirements of Section
9-3.559 Visibility at Intersections/Driveways.
(e) Other
districts. Fence height and design in all districts other than residential
and agricultural shall be approved by the Planning Director if not
a part of a development application being processed in accordance
with Article 3 Development Review Procedures of Chapter 2 of this
title. Fences being considered as part of a development application
shall be approved by the Planning Commission.
(f) Fence/retaining
wall combinations (all districts). If a fence is a vertical extension
of a retaining wall, and the combined retaining wall and fence height
is greater than six feet within a side or rear yard that abut a street
or trail easement, or greater than three feet within a front yard
(measured from the base of the retaining wall), the base of the fence
shall be stepped back from the top of the retaining wall a minimum
of two feet. This provision is subject to review and approval by the
Planning-Director.
(g) Measurement
of fence height. The height of fences and walls not enclosing a pool
shall be measured from the finish grade on the inside of the fence,
as shown in Figure 3-3. The height of a fence or wall enclosing a
pool shall be measured from the finished grade, three feet from the
outside of the fence or wall. For fences and walls that are located
on a natural or manufactured slope, the fence may be staggered in
height where the minimum height is not less than five feet. Plans
for such fences and wall shall be subject to the approval of the Planning
Director.
Figure 3-3 Fence Height Calculation
|
(h) Exceptions to standards. Subject to the administrative approval of the Planning Director pursuant to Section
9-2.303 Administrative Approvals:
(1) A combination fence structure may exceed six feet when the portion
of fence over six feet is open construction.
(2) The combined height of a retaining wall with fence may exceed six
feet to a maximum of 10 feet.
(i) Building
permits. Building permits shall be required prior to the erection
of fences in accordance with the requirements of the Uniform Building
Code and Title 8
(Ord. No. 869, § 2)
(a) Purpose
and intent. Special regulations are necessary to insure public safety
and reduce fire damage to structures located in areas subject to risk
from wildland fires. The primary purpose is to require fuel modification
that reduces the level of risk from wildland fires by removal of native
flammable vegetation and replacement with drought-tolerant, fire-resistant
plants that reduce radiant and convective heat. This planting program
will provide fire-suppression forces a safe area in which to take
an action to protect life and property.
(b) Applicability.
Any development application that will require the issuance of a Building
Permit for a primary structure(s) where property is immediately adjacent
to mature flammable vegetation, shall be subject to the requirement
that a modification program approval be obtained from the Orange County
Fire Authority prior to Building Permit issuance. For purposes of
this section, a “primary structure” shall mean a principal
permitted structure designated by the applicable zoning district;
it shall not pertain to minor accessory structures such as patios,
fences, etc.
(c) Review
process.
(1) Submittal. A fuel modification plan shall be submitted to the City
concurrently with an application for a Building Permit or other development
application (i.e., tentative subdivision map, growth management, or
comparable mobilehome park, etc.). Prior to issuance of any permits,
a fuel modification plan and program must be approved by the Fire
Marshal and either the Planning Commission or Zoning Administrator
if said development application is to be processed as part of one
of the procedures identified in Article 3 Development Review Procedures
of Chapter 2 of this title. The plan will show special treatment of
the area to achieve an acceptable level of risk regarding: exposure
of structures to flammable vegetation: and method(s) of removal, mechanical
or hand labor and continuous maintenance.
The vegetation fuel modification shall include the following
information:
(A) Delineation. The minimum width of the vegetation fuel modification
area may range between fifty and one hundred (50-100) feet. This may
require evaluation by a fire department representative prior to preparation
of the plan. For preliminary plan approval, general dimensions will
be adequate. For precise plans, exact delineation showing undulated
borders, etc., must be submitted.
(B) Wet zone. The first 50 feet of vegetation fuel modification must
consist of irrigated landscaping. The plan must delineate that portion
of the fuel modification area which will be permanently irrigated.
Fuel modification can be as simple as a wet zone (greenbelt) extending
into flammable light annual vegetation. These wet zones may range
between fifty and one hundred (50-100) feet in width measured on a
map from the back of a lot or from a point within the lot where deed
restrictions and/or provisions of the Municipal Code prohibit the
location of flammable structures.
(C) Plant list. A plant list must be submitted containing both the botanical
and common name of all plant materials that are to be used. In the
wet zone areas, plants must be fire resistant, nonevasive, and preferably
drought-tolerant. Plant materials that are to be used outside of the
wet zone areas must be fire resistant.
(D) Thinning zones. Thinning or removal of heavy perennial brush for
distances of 100 feet or more will be required. Replanting of low-volume,
fire-resistant, drought-tolerant plants may be required for erosion
and slope control. Large shrubby plants shall be thinned out and cleared
of all dead wood. Spacing between the plant material should be limited
to no closer than 15 feet on center.
(E) Off-site area. In areas where the minimum width cannot be achieved
within lot or tract boundaries, off-site permission may be required
to obtain the minimum width. Documentation of permission for off-site
fuel modification and maintenance must be attached to preliminary
plans.
(F) Maintenance. Provisions for continuous maintenance must be provided,
i.e., through homeowner associations, property owners, or other entities.
Maintenance includes the removal of undesirable flammable vegetation,
irrigation, etc., needed to maintain the fuel modified area in a fire
safe condition as required by the Orange County Fire Authority. Written
evidence indicating responsibility for maintenance must be submitted
with the preliminary fuel modification plan.
(G) Method(s) for maintenance. How native vegetation will be removed or thinned is to be identified. The method of removal can be critical in various view-sensitive areas, geologically-hazardous areas, and in woodland areas. Mechanical removal is acceptable in some areas. In other areas, hand removal or thinning will be required. Wood areas will require hand thinning and some vegetation may need to be selectively removed. Trees can usually remain if not dense. If trees are proposed to be removed, a proper tree removal permit application shall be processed in accordance with Section
9-2.349 Tree Removal Permit.
(H) Planting adjacent to structures in fire risk areas. Planting adjacent
to structures on private property which is in close proximity to native
vegetation is considered part of the Vegetation Fuel Modification
Program and will be subject to review and monitoring in accordance
with subsection (d) Enforcement of this section. The following guidelines
shall be observed when planting near fire risk areas:
(i)
Limit use of plants which are known to be especially flammable.
(ii)
Limit planting in large unbroken masses, especially trees and
large shrubs. Groups should be two or three maximum, mature foliage
of any group should be separated horizontally by at least 30 feet.
(iii)
Limit use of plants which develop large volumes of foliage and
branches.
(iv)
Limit use of plants which have dry or deciduous foliage during
part of the year.
(v)
Limit use of plants which develop deciduous or shaggy bark.
(vi)
Limit use of plants which develop dry or dead undergrowth.
(vii)
Limit massing of vegetation adjacent to structures, especially
under eaves, overhangs, decks, etc.
(viii)
Limit massing of shrubs at bases of trees or larger shrubs.
(ix)
Conduct yearly maintenance to reduce fuel volumes, eliminate
weeds, remove dead vegetation, etc.
(x)
Provide reliable automatic irrigation systems to maintain vegetation
in healthy, turgid state.
(2) Permit application. An application to the Engineering and Building
Services Department for either a grading or building permit for projects
subject to the provisions of this section shall include submission
of a preliminary fuel modification plan as described under subsection
(1) above. After preliminary plan review, a precise fuel modification
plan incorporating plan check corrections must be submitted and approved
prior to issuance of permits.
(3) Release of Use and Occupancy permits. The approved fuel modification
plan shall be installed prior to final inspection. Use and Occupancy
permits shall be issued only upon final inspection and acceptance
by the City.
(d) Enforcement. In the event that the fuel modification program is not properly maintained resulting in the accumulation of weeds or rubbish constituting a hazard, enforcement action will be taken pursuant to the weed abatement provisions of Municipal Code Sections
6-7.01 et seq.
(Ord. No. 869, § 2)
(a) Purpose
and intent. The purpose of this section is to establish uniform procedures
and standards for controlling the location, design, maintenance and
safety of hazardous waste facilities. The Land Use Code has been amended
to include the provisions herein to implement general policies regarding
hazardous waste management facilities pursuant to State law and the
Orange County Hazardous Waste Management Plan. The purpose and intent
of this section is to meet the “Fair Share Facility Siting”
policy of the Orange County Hazardous Waste Management Plan. However,
the City shall have absolutely no obligation to approve any conditional
use permit which proposes to process a volume of hazardous waste which
exceeds that generated by land uses within the City.
(b) Applicability.
The specific requirements of this section are applicable to the siting
and development of all hazardous waste treatment, storage, transfer
and disposal facilities. All such facilities shall require applicable
State licensing to develop and operate.
(c) Procedure. All hazardous waste facilities shall be subject to approval of a conditional use permit and the state mandated standards established by this section, or as required by future updates to State code. In addition to the procedure stated in Section
9-2.317 Conditional Use Permit, the following procedures shall govern the processing of a conditional use permit application for all hazardous waste facilities:
(1) At least 90 days before filing an application with the City for a
hazardous waste facility conditional use permit, the applicant shall
file, with the Office of Permit Assistance (OPA) in the State’s
Office of Planning and Research and with the City, a Notice of Intent
to make such an application. The Notice of Intent shall specify the
location to which the Notice of Intent is applicable and shall contain
a complete description of the nature, function and scope of the project.
The OPA shall immediately notify the affected State agencies of the
Notice of Intent. The City shall publish the Notice of Intent in a
newspaper of general circulation in the area affected by the proposed
project, shall post notices in the location where the project is proposed,
and shall notify, by a direct mailing, the owners of contiguous property,
as shown in the latest equalized assessment. (Requirement of Section
25199.7 (a) of the California
Health & Safety Code.)
(2) Within 90 days after a Notice of Intent is filed with the Office
of Permit Assistance, the OPA shall convene a public meeting within
the City to inform the public on the nature, function, and scope of
the proposed project and the procedures that are required for approving
the project application. OPA shall advise the City of the date, time,
and location of the meeting. (Requirement of Section 25199.7(c) of
the California
Health and Safety Code.)
(3) Within 10 calendar days after the City has determined that a conditional
use permit application for a hazardous waste facility is complete,
staff shall solicit services from qualified consultants pursuant to
the City’s professional consultant selection requirements. The
purpose of the consultant shall be to provide technical assistance
to the staff and Local Assessment Committee (LAC). Following selection
of the consultant, the applicant shall deposit necessary fees with
the City to cover all costs associated with the approved scope of
work.
(4) Within 30 days of acceptance of a conditional use permit as complete,
the City Council shall appoint the seven member LAC pursuant to the
provisions of subsection (f). (Requirement of Section 25199.7(d) of
the California
Health & Safety Code.)
(5) The City shall notify the OPA within 10 days after an application
for a conditional use permit for a hazardous waste facility project
is accepted as complete by the City. Within 60 days after receiving
such notice, the OPA shall convene a meeting of the lead and responsible
agencies for the project, the applicant, and the interested public,
for the purpose of determining the issues which concern the public
agencies and the public. (Requirement of Section 25199.7(e) of the
California
Health & Safety Code.)
(6) Following the meeting specified in subsection (c)(5) of this section,
the applicant, City staff and the LAC shall meet and confer on the
proposed hazardous waste facility project proposal for the purpose
of establishing the terms and conditions under which the project may
be acceptable to the community. (Requirement of Section 25199.7(f)
of the California
Health & Safety Code.)
(7) At the request of the applicant, the Planning Department shall, within
60 calendar days after the City has determined that a conditional
use permit application for a hazardous waste facility is complete,
issue an initial written determination on whether the project is consistent
with both the City General Plan and Zoning Ordinance in effect at
the time the application was received, and the Orange County Hazardous
Waste Management Plan. (Requirement of Section 25199.5(a) of the California
Health & Safety Code.)
(8) An applicant may appeal the City’s final approving body action
on a conditional use permit for a hazardous waste facility project
to the Governor or the Governor’s designee. (Requirement of
Section 25199.9 of the California
Health & Safety Code.)
(d) Application
submission requirements. In addition to the standard submission requirements
for a conditional use permit, applications for an off-site hazardous
waste facility must be accompanied by the following:
(1) A preliminary geotechnical study of the property and surrounding
area including the location and characteristic of any aquifers, regardless
of the potability of those aquifers.
(2) Identification of all wastewater, treated and untreated, generated
by the proposed facility and the method and place of final discharge.
(3) Identification of the amounts (pounds) and types of hazardous wastes
to be treated at the proposed facility; the sources of these wastes;
the ultimate disposition of the wastes; and the anticipated life of
the facility. Information shall be based on an actual survey of the
industries to be served and, thereby, be representative of the wastes
that will be processed at the facility.
(4) An emergency operations plan containing emergency procedures pursuant
to subsection (j)(2) of this section.
(5) Other information as required by the Planning Director to demonstrate
compliance with the subsections (h) Project criteria, and subsection
(i) Facility siting standards of this section.
(6) A Health and Safety Assessment prepared by a qualified preparer is
required to provide technical and environmental evaluation of the
proposed facility, site, and surrounding area. A Health and Safety
Assessment will provide the information and analysis needed to demonstrate
compliance of the proposed facility with the siting criteria. The
scope of the assessment will vary according to the size, type, and
proposed location of the facility. The Health and Safety Assessment
shall evaluate, at minimum the area within 2,000 feet of the site,
which is designated a sensitive area, and shall evaluate the potential
impact on sensitive populations. Sensitive populations include residential,
employment, and immobile populations such as schools, hospitals, convalescent
homes, and other similar facilities within the area of potential impact.
The Health and Safety Assessment must consider the qualities and the
physical and chemical characteristics of the specific types of the
waste that would be handled, the facility design features and planned
operations practices. The need and distance for any buffering of the
facility from residential areas or other sensitive land uses will
be identified. The Assessment must include a hydrologic evaluation,
and must assess risks due to physical hazards such as flooding and
earthquakes and potential water or air pollution. The Assessment will
detail credible potential accidents, including the distance over which
effects would carry, a variety of options for reducing risks, and
procedures for dealing with the effects. The Assessment will identify
the capabilities (including equipment and trained personnel) and response
times of existing emergency services with regard to accidents at the
facility, and will provide an emergency evacuation plan. If existing
emergency services are deemed inadequate, the City may require the
developer to supplement those services with on-site trained personnel
and equipment.
(e) Environmental
review. All hazardous waste facility projects shall be subject to
environmental analysis according to City environmental review guidelines
and pursuant to the California Environmental Quality Act. Preliminary
environmental review shall include analysis with particular emphasis
on geology and soils, hazards and hazardous material, hydrology and
water quality, air quality, aesthetics, and noise impacts.
(f) Local
Assessment Committee. The City Council shall appoint a seven member
local assessment committee (LAC) to administer the provisions of this
Code as specified herein.
(1) The LAC shall include three representatives of the community at large,
two representatives of environmental or public interest groups, and
two representatives of affected businesses or industries. Members
of the LAC shall have no financial interest, as defined by Section
87103 of the California
Government Code, in the hazardous waste facility
project under review. The responsibilities of the LAC shall include:
(A) Advise the City of the terms and conditions under which a proposed
hazardous waste facility would meet the requirements of this section
of the Code. The LAC shall determine, in consultation with the applicant,
the following (Requirement of Section 25199.7(d)(2) of the California
Health & Safety Code.):
(i)
Measures which should be undertaken in connection with the operation
of the proposed hazardous waste facility project to protect the public
health, safety, and welfare.
(ii)
Special benefits or remuneration the applicant will provide
the City as compensation for the local costs associated with the operation
of the proposed hazardous waste facility.
(B) In meetings with the applicant, generally represent the interests
of City residents and business as well as those of adjoining communities.
(Requirement of Section 25199.7(d)(2)(B) of the California Health
& Safety Code.)
(C) Expend the technical assistance services made available under subsection
(c)(3) of this section. (Requirement of Section 25199.7(d)(2)(C) of
the California
Health & Safety Code.)
(D) Adopt administrative rules and procedures which are necessary to
perform duties outlined herein. (Requirement of Section 25199.7(d)(2)(D)
of the California
Health & Safety Code.)
(E) Advise the City of the terms, provisions, and conditions for project
approval which have been agreed upon by the LAC and the applicant,
or which the LAC deems appropriate. The City decision-making body
may rely upon the advice and recommendations of the LAC. (Requirement
of Section 25199.7(d)(2)(E) of the California Health & Safety
Code.)
(F) After final administrative action has been taken by the State and
local agencies on the conditional use permit application, the LAC
shall automatically cease to exist. (Requirement of Section 25199.7(d)(4)
of the California
Health & Safety Code.)
(2) The City shall provide the LAC with necessary staff resources to
assist in fulfilling its responsibilities. (Requirement of Section
25199.7(d)(3) of the California Health& Safety Code.)
(3) If the LAC and applicant cannot resolve differences through the public
meeting process, the City may request the assistance of OPA to reach
resolution pursuant to Section 25199.4 of the California Health &
Safety Code. (Requirement of Section 25199.7(h) of the California
Health & Safety Code.)
(g) Public
hearings. Public hearings on “Hazardous Waste Facility”
conditional use permits shall be conducted pursuant to Section 9-2.335
Public Hearing Procedures.
(h) Project
criteria. Prior to approving a conditional use permit for a hazardous
waste facility, the Planning Commission must find the following criteria
have been met. The Planning Commission’s findings must be contained
in the approving resolution:
(1) The project will be consistent with the General Plan including in
particular, the policies of the Land Use, Circulation, and Safety
Elements.
(2) The project will not be detrimental to the health, safety or general
welfare of the community.
(3) The project site is or will be adequately served by roads and other
public or private service facilities.
(4) The project will be consistent with the Regional Fair Share Facility
Needs Assessment and siting policies established in the Orange County
Hazardous Waste Management Plan. The City may impose conditions of
approval limiting the capacity of facilities to that level commensurate
with the amount of hazardous waste generated by activities and businesses
within the City’s limits.
(5) The project will comply with the Facility Siting Standards established
by subsection (i) of this section.
(i) Facility
siting standards. The following siting criteria have been established
for the design of hazardous waste facilities and by the City in evaluating
proposed sites and facility projects:
(1) Public health.
(A) Health and Safety Assessment. All facilities shall be sited so as
not to create significant risks or cause adverse impacts to the health
and safety of populations in surrounding public and private areas,
as determined by a Health and Safety Assessment. Potentially significant
health or safety risks must be eliminated or mitigated to the satisfaction
of the local permitting agency and the California Department of Health
Services.
(B) Distance from populations. Treatment, recycling and collection facilities
shall comply with local minimum zoning code setbacks, unless a greater
buffer distance from other uses is deemed necessary by the Health
and Safety Assessment. Residuals repositories shall provide a minimum
buffer distance of 2,000 feet from residences and other sensitive
land uses. The size of the buffer zone may be increased based on the
required Health and Safety Assessment.
(2) Structural stability.
(A) Floodplain. All facilities must be situated outside the limits of
the 100-year floodplain (FHA).
(B) Earthquakes. All new facilities must have a minimum 200 foot setback
from any known Holocene faults, unless otherwise allowed by California
Code of Regulations, Title 23, Division 3, Subchapter 15, Section
2531(b).
(C) Unstable Soils: All facilities are prohibited from locating in areas
of potential rapid geologic change, unless the facility and its containment
structures have engineered design features to assure structural stability.
This includes areas with unstable soils, steep slopes, and areas subject
to liquefaction, subsidence or other severe geologic constraints.
(3) Water quality.
(A) Containment and groundwater monitoring. All facilities shall be fully
enclosed by containment structures of impermeable materials which
would contain any unauthorized release of hazardous material. Facilities
shall be equipped with leak detection and spill control and recovery
capability. Groundwater monitoring wells must be located around each
facility to determine background zone and groundwater quality, and
to detect leaks and spills from the facility.
(B) Water quality. Facilities shall locate so that domestic water supply
wells cannot be adversely affected from unauthorized releases of contaminants.
Facilities shall not locate within well head protection zones as identified
by EPA guidelines or municipal water supply agencies and local water
districts. Facilities shall not impact the quality of surface waters
(lakes, rivers, streams, creeks, etc.) or ground water resources which
have been identified for beneficial uses by the Regional Water Quality
Control Board Basin Plan.
Treatment, recycling and collection facilities should locate
outside of principal recharge areas to regional aquifers as defined
in local or State plans. Facilities may locate in the following areas
only with increased engineered design features such as horizontal
and vertical containment and monitoring systems to ensure protection:
(a) major aquifer recharge areas, (b) areas of permeable strata and
soils, and (c) areas where the existing groundwater has beneficial
uses as described in the Basin Plan. Facilities with subsurface storage
or treatment must be sited, designed and operated to ensure that hazardous
materials will be above the tension-saturated zone.
Residuals repositories are prohibited from locating in principal
recharge areas to regional aquifers as defined in local or State plans.
Repositories are prohibited in areas of high permeability per the
requirements of the State Water Quality Control Board and California
Code of Regulations, Title 23, Division 3, Subchapter 15, Section
2531(b). Repositories may locate only where the uppermost water-bearing
zone or aquifer is presently mineralized (by natural or man-induced
conditions) to the extent that it is not considered for beneficial
use by the basin to ensure that hazardous materials will always be
above the tension-saturated zone.
(C) Wastewater. All facilities generating wastewaters must locate in
areas with adequate industrial sewer capacity. The quality of wastewater
must meet all federal, State and local sewer agency discharge requirements
and the facility must obtain a valid industrial wastewater discharge
permit.
(4) Air quality. All facilities are prohibited in Class I areas as identified
by the Clean Air Act, and within wilderness, National Parks, memorial
areas and similarly dedicated areas. Facilities may be sited in other
nonattainment and PSD (Prevention of Significant Deterioration) areas
only if they meet the requirements of the South Coast Air Quality
Management District (SCAQMD).
(5) Environmentally sensitive areas.
(A) Wetlands. All facilities are prohibited from locating in wetlands
such as saltwater, fresh water and brackish marshes, swamps and bogs,
as defined in local, regional and State plans and policies.
(B) Animal and plant habitats. All facilities are prohibited from locating
within critical or significant habitat areas of animal and plant species
(including threatened or endangered species), as defined in local,
regional or State plans and policies.
(C) Recreational, cultural and aesthetic resources. Collection facilities
may locate in protected, recreational, cultural or aesthetic resource
areas, as defined by local, regional, State or national plans or policies,
only if necessary to handle hazardous wastes generated by workers,
or visitors in these areas.
Treatment and Recycling Facilities and Residuals Repositories
are prohibited from locating in protected recreational, cultural and
aesthetic resource areas, as defined by local, regional, State or
national plans or policies.
(6) Transport of hazardous waste.
(A) Proximity to waste generation areas. All facilities should locate
as close as possible to sources of hazardous waste generation (generally
industrial areas) to minimize the risks of transportation.
(B) Proximity and access to major routes. Facilities shall locate to
minimize distance from major transportation routes. Facilities must
have good access by roads designed to accommodate heavy vehicles.
Travel routes from facilities to major transportation routes shall
not pass through residential neighborhoods.
(7) General plan consistency. All facilities must be situated within
areas designated “4.0, Industrial Park” and “4.1,
Quasi-industrial” by the General Plan Land Use Element. Facilities
must also be consistent with the Orange County Hazardous Waste Management
Plan.
(j) Special
development requirements. The City may impose conditions on the granting
of a conditional use permit for a hazardous waste facility in order
to achieve the purposes of this section and the General Plan and to
protect the health, safety and general welfare of the community.
(1) Safety and security.
(A) The operator shall provide a 24-hour surveillance system (e.g., television
monitoring or surveillance by guards or facility personnel) which
continuously monitors and controls entry onto the facility.
(B) A visual and security barrier shall be constructed which completely
surrounds the facility.
(C) All gates or other entrances into the facility shall be provided
with signs which State “Danger - Hazardous Waste Area - Unauthorized
Personnel Keep Out.” Signs shall be posted at each entrance
to the facility, and at other locations deemed necessary. The signs
shall be written in English and Spanish.
(2) Emergency operations plan.
(A) The hazardous waste facility is required to have an emergency operations
plan designed to minimize hazards to human health and the environment
from fires, explosions, or unplanned release of hazardous waste to
air, soil, or surface water. The plan shall be implemented immediately
whenever a fire, explosion, or unplanned release occurs.
(B) The emergency operations plan shall include:
(i)
The responsibilities of employees in response to a fire, explosion
or unplanned release of hazardous waste.
(ii)
Role/responsibility local emergency response officials (subject
to their approval).
(iii)
The names, addresses and telephone numbers (office and home)
of all persons qualified to act as emergency coordinator. (If more
than one name is listed, the order in which they may assume authority
shall be given, with one person designated as primary coordinator.)
The emergency coordinator shall be available to respond to an emergency
and shall have the responsibility for coordinating all emergency response
measures.
(iv)
A listing of all emergency equipment at the facility, including
its location and an outline of its capabilities.
(v)
An evacuation plan for employees where evacuation may be necessary,
including signals used to begin evacuation, primary evacuation routes
and alternate routes.
(C)
Emergency coordinator responsibilities
shall be identified in the emergency operations plan to include, at
minimum, the following:
(i)
In event of an emergency (imminent or natural), the emergency
coordinator shall immediately activate facility alarms to notify employees
and shall contact appropriate State or local emergency response agencies.
(ii)
In the event of a fire, explosion, or release of any hazardous
material, the emergency coordinator shall immediately identify the
character, exact source, amount and real extent of any released materials.
Concurrently, the emergency coordinator shall assess possible hazards
both direct and indirect, to human health or the environment that
may result from the emergency.
(iii)
If the emergency coordinator determines that the facility has
had a release, fire or explosion which could threaten human health
and the environment outside the facility, the emergency coordinator
shall notify officials and also notify the State Office of Emergency
Services by phone providing the following information:
(a)
Name and telephone of person reporting.
(b)
Name and address of facility.
(c)
Time and type of incident.
(d)
Type and quantity of material(s) involved.
(e)
Extent of injuries if any.
(f)
Potential hazard outside facility.
(iv)
During the emergency, the emergency coordinator shall take all
reasonable measures to ensure that fires, explosions, and releases
do not occur or spread, including such measures as:
(b)
Collecting and containing released waste.
(c)
Removing or isolating containers.
(v)
In the event the facility is closed, the emergency coordinator
shall monitor the site.
(vi)
Following an emergency, the emergency coordinator shall provide
for treating, storing or disposing of recovered waste, contaminated
soil or surface water, or any other material resulting from a release,
fire or explosion.
(D) Owner/operator responsibilities shall be identified in the emergency
operations plan to include, at minimum, the following:
(i)
Notify the State Department of Health Services and appropriate
State and local authorities that the above requirements have been
met before operations are resumed in the affected area.
(ii)
Record the time, date and details of any incident which required
implementing the emergency operations plan.
(iii)
Within 15 days of resuming operations following an emergency
incident, submit a written report on the incident to the State Department
of Health Services including all information required by the Department.
(iv)
The emergency operations plan shall be reviewed annually and
amended as necessary.
(3) Public agency monitoring.
(A) Upon reasonable notice, the City or their designated representative
may enter a parcel on which a conditional use permit for a hazardous
waste facility has been granted for the purpose of monitoring the
operation of the facility.
(B) The operator of a hazardous waste facility shall report quarterly
to the City, the amount, type and disposition of all wastes processed
by the facility. Included in the report will be copies of all manifests
showing the delivery and types of hazardous waste materials.
(C) All structures shall remain accessible for inspection purposes.
(4) Closure plan. The applicant for a hazardous waste management facility
shall submit a closure plan and cost estimate for closure. The plan
shall identify steps necessary to completely close the facility at
any point during its intended operating life and to completely close
the facility at the end of its intended operating life. The closure
plan shall include at least:
(A) A description of how and when the facility will be finally closed.
The description shall identify the maximum extent of the operation
which will be open during the life of the facility.
(B) An estimate of the maximum inventory of wastes in storage and in
treatment at any time during the life of the facility.
(C) A description of the steps needed to decontaminate facility equipment
during closure.
(D) An estimate of the expected year of closure and a schedule for final
closure. The schedule shall include at a minimum, the initial time
required to close the facility and the time required for intervening
closure activities which will allow tracking of the progress of closure.
(E) The plan shall indicate financial arrangements (irrevocable trust
or other form of security arrangement) for the purpose of providing
funds for the closure of the site and long-term post-closure monitoring
maintenance.
(5) Financial Responsibility. The owner/operator shall show proof of
liability insurance as follows:
(A) The types, amounts, periods of coverage, and provisions from periodic
review as to adequacy of coverage shall be specified in the conditions
of approval. Required insurance shall include, but not be limited
to: general liability insurance, automotive liability insurance, environmental
impairment liability insurance, and architect’s and engineer’s
professional errors and omissions insurance. All such insurance shall
name the City as an additional insured and shall be maintained for
the life of the site and such additional periods as shall be specified
in the conditions of approval. Certificates of Insurance must be submitted
to the City annually.
(B) Applicant shall provide surety in an amount and form to be determined
by the City for the purpose of assuring adequate closure of the site.
An irrevocable trust will be established to provide funds for closure
of the site and its long-term post closure and monitoring and maintenance.
Funds for this trust would be provided by the owner/operator of the
facility quarterly based on quantity and types of hazardous wastes
received and processed or percentage of gross income. The terms of
the trust would be agreed upon by the project owner/operator and the
City. The terms will be reviewed annually to determine the adequacy
of the amount of trust funds with respect to the anticipated closure
monitoring and maintenance costs.
(C) The owner/operator shall defend, indemnify and hold harmless the
City, its officers, agents, servants, and employees from all claims,
actions or liabilities arising out of the issuance of this permit,
operations at the facility and transportation of wastes to and from
the facility.
(6) Effect of the conditional use permit. A conditional use permit for
a hazardous waste facility shall be granted for only those substances
and quantities identified in the conditions of approval. No additional
types of wastes or increases in the quantity of approved wastes shall
be allowed beyond those specified in the approved permit, unless a
separate application is trade which shall satisfy the same procedures
and contents as those required in the initial application.
(Ord. No. 869, § 2)
(a) Intent
and purpose. The purpose of this section is to provide for the conduct
of home businesses in such a manner as to be compatible with and not
disrupt residential neighborhoods. In order to minimize potential
interference with the intended residential use of the property, businesses
conducted as home businesses will be reviewed on an individual basis
to ensure compatibility with and avoid any impact on the residential
quality of life and property values within the zone. Any use which
has the significant potential to impact that quality of life or change
the character of the area shall not be permitted, and any use which
does not conduct its operation within these regulations shall be subject
to revocation.
(b) Permit
required. No person ‘shall conduct any home business use without
first securing a home business permit.
A home business use is permitted as an accessory use to a residential use provided it is conducted in compliance with the regulations set forth in this section and that a permit has been obtained and remains in effect in accordance with this section, and that a business license required under Title
3 of the Municipal Code has been obtained.
(c) Specific
regulations governing home business uses. No person shall conduct
any home business use in violation of any of the following regulations:
(1) There shall be no signs or devices identifying or advertising the
home business use.
(2) Sales activity of merchandise shall not be distributed at the residence.
(3) There shall be no storage of equipment, material, or display outside
of any fully-enclosed structures, except that maintained on a vehicle
permitted by this section.
(4) Nothing associated with the home business use shall alter the residential
character of the subject property or nearby residential properties.
(5) There shall be no activity which involves business related meetings
or gathering of any kind such as may generate increased pedestrian
or vehicular traffic, parking congestion, noise or disturbances beyond
that which is normal to residential uses.
(6) There shall be no use of any mechanical equipment, appliance, or
motor outside of an enclosed building or which generates noise detectable
from outside the building in which it is located.
(7) Only one home business permit will be issued per residential property.
Several individual business licenses for separate activities may be
issued, provided each licensed use complies with all other restrictions
of this section.
(8) There shall be no employee workers other than resident family members
conducting business at the residence, except for one employee providing
service support to the business, including but not limited to, services
such as accounting and clerical.
(9) There shall be no dispatching of persons or equipment originating
from the subject property.
(10) Not more than one commercial vehicle identifying the business use
conducted as a home business and used or maintained in connection
with the home business for the transportation of persons for hire,
compensation, or profit or designed, used, or maintained primarily
for the transportation of property, except as provided by state law,
may be parked overnight outside of an enclosed garage at the residence.
No vehicle with a gross weight of six thousand pounds or greater or
exceeding the following size dimensions: a wheelbase of 168 inches,
height not to exceed nine feet, and an overall width of seven feet,
including side view mirrors and an overall length with accessory trailer
of 25 feet shall be parked overnight at the residence.
(11) Home business activities shall not involve the use of more than one
room, or 400 square feet of a dwelling, whichever is more restrictive,
and no garage space shall be used for the conduct of any home business.
This provision requires that two car garage spaces be maintained and
readily available.
(d) Application for and issuance of permits for home business uses. No person shall conduct a home business use without having first obtained a home business permit from the Department of Planning Services pursuant to Section
9-2.303 Administrative Approvals. Applications for such permit shall be filed by the applicant with the Department on such forms as may be provided by the City and shall be accompanied by such filing fee as may be set by resolution of the City Council. The application shall provide such information and documentation as the Planning Director shall determine to be appropriate.
The Planning Director shall issue the home business permit if
it is determined that the home business use will be conducted in accordance
with this section and will not adversely affect the residential character
of the subject property or nearby residential properties: otherwise,
the application shall be denied. The permit, if granted, shall specifically
identify the occupant as permittee and describe the nature of the
home business use thereby allowed. Home business permits shall not
be transferable by the designated permittee to any other person. Permittees
may be subject to periodic inspections to verify compliance with this
section and the approved home business permit. Authorization shall
be acknowledged by the business applicant upon submission of a Home
Business application.
(e) Home
business uses in private communities. A home business permit shall
not be granted to any person living in any community administered
by a homeowner association and legally constituted CC&R, enforced
by an elected board of directors, unless the said board of directors
has taken formal action on the application. Any such applicant shall
disclose on his application form whether said action has been obtained
from the board of directors. Written proof of said action shall be
submitted with the application.
(f) Prohibited
uses. The following uses are prohibited:
(1) The repair, manufacture, processing or alteration of goods, materials
or objects, with the exception of dressmaking, tailoring, and the
manufacturing of arts and crafts items intended for off-premises sale
where no equipment or process is used which creates an adverse impact
on the neighborhood.
(2) Any use involving food handling, processing or packing which creates
an adverse impact on the neighborhood.
(3) Harboring, training or raising dogs, cats, bees, horses or other
animals for commercial purposes.
(4) Automobile and/or body and fender or boat repairing.
(g) Revocation
of home business permit. The Zoning Administrator may revoke a home
business permit after notice and an opportunity to be heard by the
permittee upon his or her determination that the home business is
being conducted contrary to the regulations set forth in this section
or in a manner which adversely affects the residential character of
the subject property or nearby residential properties, or the health,
welfare or safety of neighboring residents.
(h) Termination of home business uses as nonconforming uses. Nonconforming home business uses shall be removed pursuant to Section
9-3.533 Nonconforming Uses, Lots, and Structures.
(Ord. No. 869, § 2)
(a) Purpose
and intent. The purpose and intent of this section is to establish
development standards that encourage the construction and operation
of upscale, high quality and appropriate hotels that will benefit
the City by providing convenient and attractive downtown lodging for
visitors to the historic downtown, Mission San Juan Capistrano, and
the Los Rios Historic District, contributing to the energy and economic
vitality of the City’s downtown, and strengthening the City’s
economic base and fiscal circumstances in order to support the provision
of public services to the City’s residents and businesses.
(b) Conditional
use permit required. No person shall develop, establish, operate or
conduct any hotel use without first securing approval of a conditional
use permit.
(c) Development
and operational standards. No person shall develop, establish, operate
or conduct any hotel use in violation of any of the following regulations:
(1) Buildings shall not exceed a maximum of three stories and a habitable
area height of 45 feet from finished grade; however, roof elements
and architectural projections may be permitted to a maximum height
of 55 feet from finished grade.
(2) Floor area ratio (FAR) shall not exceed maximum 0.65:1 for all buildings
on the subject property.
(3) Floor area ratio (FAR) for first floor to second and third floors
shall be determined by the Planning Commission as part of the Conditional
Use Permit process.
(4) Parking and loading facilities shall comply with requirements set forth in Section
9-3.535 “Parking.”
(5) There shall be no permanent storage or display of equipment, material,
or supplies outside of a fully enclosed structure.
(6) Noise levels shall comply with the regulations set forth in Section
9-3.531 “Noise Standards” and all other applicable Municipal Code provisions.
(7) Lighting shall comply with the regulations set forth in Section
9-3.529 “Lighting Standards.”
(8) Landscaping shall be provided in parking lot areas subject to Planning
Commission approval.
(9) Setbacks shall be consistent with the base zone district standards
for one- and two-story structures. The Planning Commission shall determine
the required setbacks for three-story structures as part of the conditional
use permit process.
(Ord. No. 973 § 1, 2010)
(a) Commercial
kennels. Kennels operated as a commercial activity may be permitted
or subject to a conditional use permit in designated district.
(b) Noncommercial
kennels. Noncommercial kennels where no commercial activity is conducted
(no sale of dogs) may be established in the Residential/Agriculture
(RA) District as an accessory use and in the Hillside Residential
(HR), Single-Family-40,000 (RSE-40,000) and Single-Family-20,000 (RSE-20,000)
Districts subject to approval of a conditional use permit.
(c) Other
provisions. The Planning Director may allow up to six adult dogs provided
the following findings and conditions are met:
(1) All adult dogs had been registered (licensed) to the applicant by
Orange County Animal Control for at least one year (prior 12 months)
prior to the application for an exception, or residents that recently
moved into the City had written proof that the number of dogs had
been previously registered to the applicant by the applicable governing
agency prior to residency in the City.
(2) Upon notification of nearby property owners of the exception request
and a finding that the subject dogs have not created a nuisance, as
defined in Chapter 2, Article 4 of this title, such as excessive barking
or non-containment within a secured area of the property. Said notification
to be provided a minimum of 10 days prior to issuance of exception.
(3) No substantial complaint histories have been previously reported
by nearby property owners.
(4) The applicant for an exception executes an agreement that additional
and/or replacement dogs will not be allowed upon the death or relocation
of permitted dogs such that the total number of dogs will not exceed
three.
(5) Appeals of the Planning Director decision shall be reviewed by an
impartial hearing officer appointed by the City Manager. The decision
of the hearing officer shall be final.
(Ord. No. 869 § 2; Ord. No. 937 § 2)
(a) Purpose
and intent. The intent of these provisions is to balance the goals
of the General Plan to maintain a small-village, rural atmosphere,
with the need to provide for the safe movement of vehicles and people
in all districts. To meet this intent, recommended lighting levels
are to be defined at minimum levels to protect the public safety and
at the same time enhance the appeal of buildings and landscaping to
protect the desired atmosphere of the community. Standards contained
in this section are based on the recommended standards of the Illuminating
Engineering Society (IES).
(b) Commercial,
industrial, and public institutional districts. All properties located
within a commercial (TC, OC, NC, and GC) district, industrial (CM
and IP) district, public institutional (P&I) district, Solid Waste
Facility (SWF) district, Farm Market (FM) District, Recreation Commercial
(RC) District, and nonresidential portions of special districts including
Planned Community (PC) and Specific Plan/Precise Plan (SP/PP) districts
shall be subject to the exterior lighting regulations set forth.
(1) Parking lot lighting. Parking lot lighting is vital for traffic safety;
for protection against assault, theft and vandalism; for convenience
and comfort to the user. Parking lot lighting design standards of
Tables 3-22 and 3-23 have been established to provide for the safe
movement of both vehicles and pedestrians.
(A) General parking and pedestrian areas. Unless determined by the Planning
Director, as stated in paragraph (B) of this subsection, parking lot
lighting within nonresidential districts shall meet the General Parking
and Pedestrian Areas lighting standards contained in Table 3-22. Maximum
allowable lighting level shall be determined by applying the uniformity
ratio (maximum to minimum) contained in Table 3-22 to the minimum
illuminance required by Table 3-22.
(B) Enhanced security areas. If the Planning Director determines that
personal security or vandalism is a likely problem for a proposed
project, he or she may require that the Enhanced Security Areas parking
lot lighting standards contained in Table 3-22 be met. Maximum allowable
lighting level shall be determined by applying the uniformity ratio
(maximum to minimum) contained in Table 3-22 to the minimum illuminance
required by Table 3-22.
Table 3-22
Maintained Horizontal Illuminance for Parking Lots
|
---|
Open Parking Facilities
|
---|
|
General Parking & Pedestrian Areas
|
Enhanced Security Areas
|
---|
|
Minimum Horizontal Illuminance (lux)*
|
Uniformity Ratio (Maximum to Minimum)**
|
Minimum Vertical Illuminance***
|
Minimum Horizontal Illuminance (lux)*
|
Uniformity Ratio (Maximum to Minimum)**
|
Minimum Vertical Illuminance***
|
---|
Maintained Illuminance Values
|
2 lux/0.2 fc
|
20:1
|
1 lux/0.1 fc
|
5 lux/0.5 fc
|
15:1
|
2.5 lux/0.25 fc
|
Covered Parking Facilities
|
|
Day
|
Night
|
Areas
|
Minimum Horizontal*
|
Max/Min Horizontal Uniformity Ratio**
|
Minimum Vertical***
|
Minimum Horizontal*
|
Max/Min Horizontal Uniformity Ratio**
|
Minimum Vertical***
|
Open Parking Facilities
|
General parking and pedestrian areas
|
10 lux/1.0 fc
|
10:1
|
5 lux/0.5 fc
|
10 lux/1.0 fc
|
10:1
|
5 lux/0.5 fc
|
Ramps and corners
|
20 lux/2.0 fc
|
10:1
|
10 lux/1.0 fc
|
20 lux/1.0 fc
|
10:1
|
5 lux/0.5 fc
|
Entrance areas
|
500 lux/50 fc
|
|
250 lux/25 fc
|
10 lux/1.0 fc
|
10:1
|
5 lux/0.5 fc
|
Stairways
|
20 lux/2.0 fc
|
|
10 lux/1.0 fc
|
20 lux/2.0 fc
|
|
10 lux/1.0 fc
|
fc = footcandle
|
*
|
Measured on the parking surface, without any shadowing effect
from parked vehicles or trees/columns at the points of measurement.
|
**
|
The highest horizontal illuminance point divided by the lowest
horizontal illuminance point or area should not be greater than the
values shown.
|
***
|
Measured at 5 feet above parking surface at the point of lowest
horizontal illuminance, excluding facing outward along boundary.
|
(C) Parking lot lighting design standards. The lighting design standards
depicted in Table 3-23 shall apply to parking lots.
Table 3-23
Parking Lot Lighting Design Standards
|
---|
Feature
|
Standard
|
---|
Fixture Height
|
Pole mounted fixtures shall not exceed 20 feet in height as
measured from finish grade to the bottom of the light fixture.
Concrete pedestals shall not exceed 24 inches and shall be included
in the overall height.
Building mounted fixtures shall be located below the roof eave
and not exceed the height of the pole mounted fixture (20 feet) whichever
is lower.
|
Light Source
|
Metal halide, high pressure sodium, and similar sources shall
be permitted. Halogen and mercury vapor sources shall be prohibited.
|
Fixture Type
|
Within the Town Center (TC) and Town Center Edge Districts,
contemporary styled fixtures shall be prohibited. Freestanding light
fixtures must comply with the City-established list of pre-approved
fixture styles using a horizontal light that does not project below
the cut-off lenses. For building mounted fixtures, the Planning Director
shall insure that the proposed fixture type will be in scale with
the building elevation on which it is to be installed. The Planning
Director may refer this latter determination to the Planning Commission.
|
Spacing of Fixtures
|
The distance separating lights shall be determined by the type
of light fixture and the requirement to satisfy the intensity provisions
for “Fixture Height” above.
|
Shielding
|
Shielding shall be required so that light measured 5 feet outside
the property boundary shall not exceed 0.1 footcandle. Exterior lighting
fixtures that will be visible from adjacent residential areas shall
be oriented such that the light source is not visible from said adjacent
property.
|
(2) Pedestrian walkway lighting. The minimum standards in Table 3-24
shall be satisfied to insure the safe movement of pedestrians within
a commercial, industrial or public project (excluding public facilities
where the site is closed during nondaylight hours). In areas where
special pedestrian security is desired, the property owner should
consider the specific recommendation for such activity areas noted
in Table 3-25 for lighting illuminance. Maximum allowable lighting
level shall be determined by applying the uniformity ratio (average
to minimum/maximum) contained in Table 3-25 to the average illuminance
required by Table 3-25.
Table 3-24
Pedestrian Ways Design Standards
|
---|
Feature
|
Standard
|
---|
Illuminance
|
Minimum lighting shall meet the requirements as set forth in
this table. Furthermore said light shall be directed in such a manner
that any changes in elevation of the walkway (i.e. steps or curbs)
shall be illuminated such that said features are clearly discernable
(without shadow).
|
Fixture Type
|
Pedestrian walkway light fixtures can be a combination of freestanding
pole, bollard, in-place step or building mounted fixtures. For building
mounted fixtures, the Planning Director shall insure that the proposed
fixture type will be in scale with the building elevation on which
it is to be installed. The Planning Director may refer this latter
determination to the Planning Commission.
|
Fixture Heights
|
Light fixtures shall not exceed the following height provisions:
Freestanding pole - Not greater than 14 feet as measured from
finish grade to the bottom of the light fixture.
Building-mounted - Shall be located below the roof eave or 14
feet whichever is less.
Bollard - Said fixture type shall not exceed a height of 42
inches as measured from finish grade to the top of the fixture.
|
Table 3-25
Average Maintained Illuminance Levels for Pedestrian Ways
|
---|
Walkway and Bikeway Classification
|
Minimum Average Horizontal Levels (Eavg)
|
Average Vertical Levels for Special Pedestrian Security (Eavg)
|
---|
Sidewalks (adjacent to roadways) and on-street bikeways
|
Commercial areas
|
10 lux/0.9 fc
|
22 lux/2 fc
|
Intermediate areas
|
6 lux/0.6 fc
|
11 lux/1 fc
|
Residential areas
|
2 lux/0.2 fc
|
5 lux/0.5 fc
|
Walkways (not adjacent to roadways) and off-road bikeways
|
Walkways, bikeways, and stairways
|
5 lux/0.5 fc
|
5 lux/0.5 fc
|
Pedestrian tunnels
|
43 lux/4 fc
|
54 lux/5 fc
|
*
|
Crosswalks traversing roadways in the middle of long block and
at street intersections should be provided with additional illumination.
|
Notes:
|
1.
|
The average vertical levels for special pedestrian security
is for pedestrian identification at a distance. Values at 6 feet above
the walkway.
|
2.
|
The average to minimum/maximum uniformity ratio in non-special
pedestrian security areas shall not exceed 4:1.
|
3.
|
The average to minimum/maximum uniformity ratio in special pedestrian
security areas shall not exceed 5:1.
|
(3) Architectural and landscape lighting. The use of architectural or
landscape lighting to highlight the unique features of a building
and/or surrounding landscape treatment may be considered during the
development review process. In order to consider whether such lighting
should be approved, the following procedures and criteria have been
prepared to assist in the consideration of such applications:
(A) Architectural and landscape lighting. The consideration and approval
of said type lighting shall be reviewed and approved by the Planning
Commission. The Planning Commission in considering such architectural
and landscape highlighting shall determine whether the lighting satisfies
the criteria in subsections (i) and (ii) and the general guidelines
noted in subsections (iii) and (iv).
(i)
The lighting will illuminate an architectural feature or landscape
feature that is unique to the particular project due to the use of
materials, colors, or design characteristics that relate to similar
historic features that are found within the City; and
(ii)
The architectural lighting proposal will enhance the design
of a project and is not solely used as an attraction getting device.
(iii)
Location of fixtures. Highlighting fixtures may be located either
on the building; on adjacent ground, and on ornamental standards.
These fixtures are to be arranged such that they are not generally
visible to the public.
(iv)
Shielding for glare. Highlighting fixtures should be located
and designed in such a manner that the actual lamp and reflector are
shielded or louvered so that it is not seen from a normal public viewing
area. Shielding or louvering is especially important in areas where
there is considerable vehicle and pedestrian traffic that direct glare
be avoided.
(B)
Exposed string lighting regulations.
Exposed string lighting is permitted subject to the following provisions:
(i)
Exposed string lighting shall be defined as low wattage lights
with individual bulb receptacle connected by electrical wires that
are exposed to the outside surface of a plant or building feature,
more specifically said lights shall be defined as a commercially available
maximum 2.8 watt system, designed for exterior installation and use.
Lights which are blinking or chasing are not permitted.
(ii)
Temporary exposed seasonal string lighting shall be permitted
during the period between the third Saturday of November and New Year’s
Day. Said lighting fixtures are to be removed by January 8th of each
year.
(iii)
Permanently exposed string lights are permitted in the General
Commercial (GC), Tourist Commercial (TC), Farm Market (FM), and the
Neighborhood Commercial (NC) Districts subject to the approval by
the Planning Director provided that all of the following criteria
are satisfied:
(a)
Exposed permanent string lights shall be exclusively a white
light with a clear bulb and are limited to the lighting of living
landscape features (trees) if used in combination with other highlighting
or pedestrian lighting fixtures within the immediate area.
(b)
Exposed string lights shall be limited to designated outside
dining or display areas and main pedestrian entry to a project site.
(c)
Said lighting fixtures shall require an electrical permit for
installation and shall be secured to the landscape feature with bands
that will not puncture the skin of the plant.
(d)
Applications for such lighting shall. be limited to one per
project and shall not involve an area greater than 5% of the building
square footage of a center nor more than 15% for a freestanding commercial
building not part of a commercial center or plaza.
(e)
Approval of applications shall be made by the Planning Director
upon satisfactory compliance with the limitations and design parameters
above. Said approval shall be conditioned to include compliance with
minimum property maintenance standards of Title 8 Property Maintenance
Standards. Failure to properly maintain the lights shall be subject
to removal of said fixtures.
(iv)
Applications for exposed string lights that are not consistent
with the provisions of subsection (iii) above shall be subject to
the review and approval of the Planning Commission.
(4) Exterior display lighting. Display lighting for use defined and permitted in accordance with Section
9-3.549 Storage and Display shall meet the standards contained in Table 3-26.
(5) Security lighting. Security lighting shall be provided and shall
include all pedestrian lighting, signs (if used as security illumination),
not more than 0.1 of the parking lot lights (these lights shall be
equipped with a photocell for dusk to dawn illumination), and required
lights over all building entries. Exterior lighting including parking
lots shall be reduced in intensity between 10:00 p.m., or one-half
hour after close of business, whichever is later, and 6:00 a.m.
Table 3-26
Exterior Display Lighting Design Standards
|
---|
Feature
|
Standard
|
---|
Illuminance
|
The lighting of the display area will optimize the dispersion
of light for a smooth transition throughout the display area. The
amount of display area light projected onto the ground surface shall
not exceed a 50-footcandle average (initial light intensity) with
an average to minimum ratio of not less than 5 to 1 (5:1). This shall
be the initial reading and not the maintained level of lighting.
|
Fixture Height
|
The height of exterior light fixtures shall be as follows:
• Building-mounted fixtures shall be located below the
roof eave.
• Pole-mounted shall not exceed 14 feet as measured from
finish grade to the top of the light fixture. Concrete pedestals used
to protect the light pole shall not exceed 24 inches in height and
shall be included in the overall height calculation.
• Roof mounted display lights are prohibited.
|
(c) Outdoor
recreational lighting. Outdoor lighting associated with a permitted
recreational use, shall be subject to the approval of a conditional
use permit by the City. All outdoor recreational lighting shall be
designed to comply with the standards contained in Table 3-27.
Table 3-27
Outdoor Recreation Lighting Design Standards
|
---|
Feature
|
Standard
|
---|
Illuminance
|
The average and/or maximum light illuminance, measured in footcandles,
shall not exceed the recommended average or maximum guideline established
for the proposed recreational use by the Illuminating Engineering
Society. The City may, as part of the conditional use permit process,
restrict lighting to a level less than the Illuminating Engineering
Society recommended guideline.
|
Pole Height
|
The maximum height of outdoor lighting for courts (basketball,
volleyball, handball, horseshoe, etc.) shall not exceed 25 feet as
measured from finished grade. The maximum height of outdoor lighting
for athletic fields (baseball, softball, football, soccer, etc.) shall
be determined by the Planning Commission during consideration of the
Conditional Use Permit.
|
Lighting Source
|
Lighting source shall be limited to metal halide.
|
Shielding
|
Lighting shall be directed to areas within the property line
to minimize glare in surrounding areas. Spillover and glare shall
be minimized by using fixture cutoffs and optically controlled luminaries
on all lighting fixtures.
|
(1) Submission requirements. Application submission requirements shall
be the same as those listed under subsection (e)(1), below.
(2) Tennis court light standards. Specific standards regarding tennis courts are found under Section
9-3.501 Accessory Uses and Structures.
(d) Residential
districts. All properties zoned for residential use shall be subject
to the exterior lighting standards in Table 3-28. Standards apply
to security lighting and decorative lighting:
Table 3-28
Residential Lighting Design Standards
|
---|
Feature
|
Standard
|
---|
Illuminance
|
The amount of light projected onto any surface shall not exceed
5 footcandles.
|
Fixture Height
|
Building-mounted lights shall be installed below the eave line
and no higher than 14 feet unless used to illuminate a second story
entry eave, balcony, or outside stairway or door where in such case
it shall be no higher than 8 feet above the floor elevation of the
second story. Pole or wall-mounted fixtures shall be limited to 8
feet in height above finished grade.
|
Spacing of Fixtures
|
The distance separating lights shall be a minimum of 35 feet.
An exception to this provision is for decorative lights located at
the entrance to the main driveway to the residence where said lights
are to be located on opposite sides of the edge of the driveway surface
and low level pedestrian walkway lights (18 inches) not more than
5 footcandles in intensity (except low-wattage light sources that
do not require an electrical permit).
|
Location of Fixtures
|
Lighting shall only be installed adjacent to buildings, walkways,
driveways, or activity areas (swimming pools, spas, outdoor dining
areas, equestrian barns, and other similar uses) and focal landscape
areas located in close proximity to the residence or activity area.
|
Light Source
|
The use of high pressure sodium and metal halide are permitted
light sources.
|
Shielding
|
Where the light source is visible from outside the property
boundaries, such lighting shall not exceed 1 footcandle as measured
at the property line common with an adjacent private property.
|
(e) Administrative
procedures. The following administrative procedures shall be used
in considering applications for exterior lighting permits:
(1) Plan submission requirements. Applications for exterior lighting
shall be in a form approved by the Planning Director.
(2) All commercial, industrial, public institutional, and residential districts (subsection (b) and (d), above. All such permit actions are to be reviewed and determined to be in compliance with the applicable provisions of this section. Said permit approval is a ministerial action by the Planning Director pursuant to Section
9-2.303 Administrative Approvals.
(3) Outdoor recreational lighting (subsection (c), above). All such uses are subject to review and approval of a conditional use permit by the Planning Commission. Procedures for consideration of a conditional use permit shall be per Section
9-2.315 Conditional Use Permit.
(4) Exceptions. Exceptions to the above standards shall be considered
by the Planning Commission after conducting a duly noticed and advertised
public hearing. Exceptions shall only be granted by the Planning Commission
if the following findings are made:
(A) The exception is consistent with the intent and purpose of these
standards and it will not adversely impact immediately adjacent properties;
and
(B) The exception is necessary to provide minimum lighting levels to
provide for the safety of the public.
(Ord. No. 869, § 2; Ord. No. 1082, § 9, 2021)
(a) Noise
level measurements. Any noise level measurement made pursuant to the
provisions of this Code shall be performed using a sound level meter.
For the purposes of this section, “sound level meter”
shall mean an instrument meeting the American National Standard Institute’s
Standard 51.4-1971 for Type 1 or Type 2 sound level meters or an instrument
with associated recording and analyzing equipment which will provide
equivalent data.
(b) Minimum
exterior noise standards.
(1) The following noise standards in Table 3-29 and 3-30 shall be used
as the base of measurement for determining noise violations affecting
uses within the residential, public and institutional and commercial
districts. The General Plan contains noise compatibility standards
for use when planning and making development decisions.
Table 3-29
Exterior Noise Standards for Residential and Public and Institutional
Districts
|
---|
Noise Level
|
Time Period
|
---|
65 dB(A)
|
7:00 a.m. to 7:00 p.m.
|
55 dB(A)
|
7:00 p.m. to 10:00 p.m.
|
45 dB(A)
|
10:00 p.m. to 7:00 a.m.
|
Table 3-30
Exterior Noise Standards for Commercial Districts
|
---|
Noise Level
|
Time Period
|
---|
65 dB(A)
|
At any time during the day
|
Each of the noise levels set forth in this subsection
shall be reduced by five dB(A) for impacts of simple tone noises or
noises consisting of speech or music.
(2) No person at any location within the City, including the industrial
and open space districts, shall create any noise, or permit the creation
of any noise, which causes the noise level within a residential, public
and institutional or commercial district to exceed the standards included
in Tables 3-29 and 3-30 by the amount and for the period of time identified
in Table 3-31.
Table 3-31
Maximum Noise Levels Not to be Exceeded
|
---|
Maximum Noise Level Not to be Exceeded During Period of Time
|
Period of Time
|
---|
Exterior noise standard plus 20 dB(A)
|
Any period of time
|
Exterior noise standard plus 15 dB(A)
|
Cumulative period of more than 1 minute in any hour
|
Exterior noise standard plus 10 dB(A)
|
Cumulative period of more than 5 minutes
|
Exterior noise standard plus 5 dB(A)
|
Cumulative period of more than 15 minutes in any hour
|
Exterior noise standard
|
Cumulative period of more than 30 minutes in any hour
|
(3) The location selected for measuring exterior noise levels shall be
at a point within the affected property.
(c) Interior
noise standards.
(1) No person at any location, including the industrial and open space
districts, within the City shall create any noise, or permit the creation
of any noise, on property owned, leased, occupied, or otherwise controlled
by such person, which noise causes the noise level, when measured
within a dwelling unit on any residential property during the period
from 10:00 p.m. to 7:00 a.m., to exceed:
(A) The noise standard plus 10 dB(A) for any period of time; or
(B) The noise standard plus five dB(A) for a cumulative period of more
than one minute in any hour; or
(C) The noise standard for a cumulative period of more than five minutes
in any hour.
(2) The method of noise level measurement for interior noise shall be
made with the windows and doors closed with the measurements made
at a point at least four feet from the wall, ceiling, or floor nearest
the noise source in the affected residential unit.
(d) Special
provisions. The following activities shall be exempted from the provisions
of this section:
(1) School bands, school athletic, and school entertainment events;
(2) Carnivals, festivals, parades, arts and crafts exhibits, public dances, skating, and entertainment events provided such events are conducted pursuant to a permit issued by the Planning Director pursuant to the provisions of Section
9-3.553 Temporary Uses and Structures;
(3) Any mechanical device, apparatus, or equipment used, related to,
or connected with emergency machinery, vehicles, or work;
(4) Noise sources associated with construction, repairs, remodeling,
or the grading of any real property, except that such activities shall
not be exempt from the provisions of this section if conducted from
6:00 p.m. to 7:00 a.m. on Monday through Friday, or from 4:30 p.m.
to 8:30 a.m. on Saturday, or at any time on Sunday or a national holiday;
(5) Any mechanical device, apparatus, or equipment utilized for the protection
or salvage of agricultural crops during periods of potential or actual
frost damage or other adverse weather conditions;
(6) Mobile noise sources associated with agricultural operations, except
that such operations shall not be exempt from the provisions of this
section if conducted from 8:00 p.m. to 7:00 a.m. on Monday through
Saturday or at any time on Sunday or a Federal holiday;
(7) Mobile noise sources associated with agricultural pest control through
pesticide applications provided such applications are made in accordance
with restricted material permits issued by, or regulations enforced
by, the County Agriculture Commissioner;
(8) Noise sources associated with the maintenance of real property used
for residential purposes provided such activities take place from
7:00 a.m. to 8:00 p.m. on any day except Sunday or from 9:00 a.m.
to 8:00 p.m. on Sunday, for example, mowing lawns and carpentry repairs;
and
(9) Any activity for which regulation is preempted by State or Federal
laws.
(e) Nuisances.
Noise shall be considered a nuisance pursuant to Article 4 of Chapter
2 of this title.
(Ord. No. 869, § 2)
(a) Purpose and intent. Within the districts established by Section
9-3.101 Districts Established, where there exist lots, structures, or uses of land and structures which were lawful before November 17, 1975, but which are prohibited or restricted by Chapter 3 of this title, this section provides for the regulation of such nonconformities by specifying the circumstances and conditions under which they may continue to exist.
(b) Continuation
of nonconformities. Except as otherwise permitted by the provisions
of Chapters 1 through 5 of this title, nonconformities may be continuously
maintained provided there is no alteration or addition to any structure,
nor any enlargement of area, space, or volume occupied by such nonconformity.
(c) Time
periods affecting nonconformities. Unless otherwise specifically set
forth, all time periods affecting nonconformities shall begin on November
15, 2002, or on the effective date of an amendment to the provisions
of Chapters 1 through 5 of this title or change in the Official Zoning
Map if such amendment or change causes a nonconformity.
(d) Repairs
and maintenance.
(1) Ordinary repairs and maintenance work. Ordinary repairs and maintenance
work may be made to a nonconformity, subject to the following provisions:
(A) Maintenance work shall not include structural alterations, except
those required by law or those required to make the structure and
use conform to the standards and use regulations of the district in
which such structure and use are located.
(B) Ordinary repairs and the repair or replacement of nonbearing walls,
fixtures, wiring, and plumbing may be made to an extent not exceeding
the latest assessed valuation of the structure. In no case, however,
shall the cubic content of the structure as it existed when it became
subject to nonconformity be increased.
(2) Repairs to damages. In the event such damage or destruction exceeds
twice the assessed valuation of such structure, that structure shall
not be reconstructed except in conformity with all use and area regulations
for new structures in the district in which such structure is located.
(3) Strengthening and restoring. Nothing set forth in this section shall
be deemed to prevent the strengthening or restoration to a safe condition
of any structure or its support structure, or part thereof, declared
to be unsafe by any officer of the City charged with protecting the
public safety upon the order of such officer.
(e) Enlargement.
A nonconformity shall not be enlarged in volume or extended or relocated
beyond the area it occupies, unless its enlargement, extension, or
relocation is:
(1) Made to conform to the regulations of the district in which it is
located; and
(2) Conforms to the following provisions:
(A) Any exception permitting the enlargement, extension, or relocation
shall not be construed to extend the termination date, if any, of
the subject nonconformity.
(B) Where parking and loading requirements are the cause for nonconformity, the use shall not be intensified, nor associated structure enlarged or altered to create additional dwelling units, guest rooms, seating capacity, or floor area, unless additional parking and loading requirements are supplied and maintained to meet the parking requirements, subject to the provisions of Section
9-3.535 Parking.
(f) Change
of nonconforming uses to other uses. A nonconforming use shall not
be changed to another use, except to a use permitted in the district
where it is located.
(g) Nonconforming
lots and the construction of single-family dwellings. In any district
in which single-family dwellings are permitted, a single family dwelling
and the customary accessory structures may be erected on any lot which
is only nonconforming with respect to the lot area and lot width standards.
However, such lot shall be in separate ownership and not of continuous
frontage with other lots in the same ownership.
(h) Nonconforming
lots in single ownership. If two or more unimproved lots with continuous
frontage in single ownership are of record on September 17, 1975,
and if all or part of such lots do not meet the requirements established
for lot width and area, the lands involved shall be considered to
be an undivided parcel for the purposes of Chapters 3 and 4 of this
title. No portion of such a parcel shall be used or sold in a manner
which diminishes compliance with the lot width and area requirements
set forth in Chapters 3 and 4 of this title.
(i) Nonconforming uses in the Specific Plan/Precise Plan (SP/PP) District. Minor modifications to nonconforming uses in areas designated Specific Plan/Precise Plan (SP/PP) and subject to a Specific or Precise Plan may be approved subject to the requirements of Section
9-3.317 Specific Plan/Precise Plan (SP/PP) District.
(j) Nonconforming amateur radio antennas. All amateur radio antennas lawfully constructed and erected prior to the effective date of the ordinance codified in Section
9-3.507 Antennas are considered legal nonconforming and are not subject to the development standards included in Section
9-3.507 Antennas provided that a record of its size, location, height and any other information deemed necessary by the Planning Director is on file with the Department of Planning Services. In order to secure any right under Section
9-3.507 Antennas, the amateur radio antenna owner shall submit this record to the Department of Planning Services on a form or application supplied by the Department of Planning Services. The amateur radio antenna owner is responsible for providing the necessary information to the City for inclusion in the record of nonconforming antennas.
(k) Nonconforming
home business uses.
(1) Removal within 60 days. Any existing home business use in existence prior to November 15, 2002 which is nonconforming to the regulations of Section
9-3.523 Home Business are hereby deemed to be a public nuisance and shall be removed by the occupant within an amortization period of 60 days from enactment of the ordinance codified in this section.
(2) Extensions. The Planning Director may grant an exception to the above-stated
maximum period of time for removing the home business use by granting
an additional permit of time for removal however, the extension of
time shall not be greater than the time necessary to amortize documented
expenditures directly associated with the home business use under
applicable criteria of the Internal Revenue Code. The permittee shall
have the burden of presenting creditable information to support the
request.
(l) Structures
and plans previously approved.
(1) Any structure which was approved prior to November 15, 2002, but
which does not conform to any or all of the provisions of Chapters
1 through 5 of this title, may be completed and used in accordance
with the provisions of Chapters 1 through 5 of this title, or any
amendment thereto, provided:
(A) The construction or proposed use of such structure is not in violation
of any other law on November 15, 2002;
(B) Such structure is completed in accordance with the plans and specifications
previously approved as to City requirements; and
(C) The building permits for the structure were obtained on or before
November 15, 2002, and, once issued, the building permit did not become
void.
(2) Approved tentative maps shall remain effective until November 15,
2002, or until such time as the map shall normally expire. If a tentative
map approved prior to November 15, 2002, is considered for an extension,
such extension may be granted upon a finding by the Planning Commission
that the tentative map is in substantial compliance with the provisions
of Chapters 3 and 4 of this title.
(m) Removal
of nonconforming uses or structures. The City may adopt abatement
programs for nonconforming uses and structures that are found to cause
a public nuisance. The abatement program shall identify an amortization
period and process for the removal of nonconforming use or structure.
(n) Violations.
Any of the following violations shall immediately terminate the right
to operate a nonconformity:
(1) Changing a nonconforming use to another use not permitted in the
district or allowed pursuant to the provisions of subsection (f) of
this section;
(2) Increasing or enlarging the area, space, or volume occupied by or
devoted to such nonconforming use; or
(3) Increasing the number of personnel employed or volume of business
performed so that such increase constitutes an intensification of
the nonconforming use.
(o) Notwithstanding
anything to the contrary set forth in this section, the Development
Services Director may, in his or her sole and absolute discretion,
approve minor modifications to nonconforming uses and structures in
the TC and TCE Districts.
(Ord. No. 1082, § 10,
2021)
(a) Purpose
and intent. The provisions of this section are established to provide
for the off-street parking of motor vehicles which are attracted by
uses on the premises. The parking facilities required by this section
for motor vehicle parking and maneuvering are assumed to be the minimum
need for such facilities created by each particular land use. It is
intended that the provisions of this section will:
(1) Result in properly designed parking areas of adequate capacity which
will reduce traffic congestion, promote increased business, and enhance
public safety;
(2) Where appropriate, insulate surrounding uses from the adverse impacts
of parking facilities; and
(3) Prescribe the minimum off-street parking and loading requirements
for the various structures and uses irrespective of the districts
in which they occur.
(b) General
requirements.
(1) Certificates of use and occupancy. A certificate of use and occupancy
for any structure or premises shall be issued only after all the required
parking and loading facilities have been completed in conformance
with the provisions of this section.
(2) Changes in uses. When the use of any structure or premises is changed
to a different use having a higher parking requirement, additional
parking shall be provided to meet the new requirements prior to the
issuance of a new certificate of use and occupancy. When the use of
any premises is enlarged or expanded, additional parking to meet the
requirements of this section shall be provided for the enlarged or
expanded portion only.
(3) Existing required facilities. Off-street parking and loading facilities
in existence on September 17, 1975, or authorized by an approved development
plan, shall not be reduced below the requirements for an equivalent
new structure or use. All such facilities shall be continued for as
long as the structure or use served is continued or until equivalent
facilities are substituted in conformance with the provisions of this
section.
(4) Facilities not required. Any off-street parking or loading facility
which is permitted but not required by this section shall comply with
all the provisions of this section governing the location, design,
improvement, and operation of such facilities.
(5) Location of facilities. All permitted or required accessory parking
and loading facilities shall be provided on the same site as the structure
or use served, except where specifically permitted to be located off
the site by the provisions of subsection (c) of this section.
(6) Use of facilities for storage. The storage of merchandise, motor
vehicles for sale, recreational vehicles, trucks, or wrecked or junked
vehicles or the repair of vehicles in areas designed for off-street
parking shall be prohibited.
(7) Requirements for unspecified uses. Parking requirements for structures
and uses not set forth in subsection (g) of this section shall be
determined by the Planning Director, and such determinations shall
be based on the requirements for the most comparable structure or
use specified.
(c) Parking
facilities—Joint use/shared parking.
(1) Authorized. Parking facilities may be provided jointly subject to the satisfaction of the requirements of this section and approval by the Planning Commission pursuant to Section
9-2.317 Conditional Use Permit.
(2) Joint usage where there is an overall deficiency in the number of
spaces provided. Parking facilities for adjoining uses whose peak
hours of operation are substantially different may be provided jointly.
Such joint usage shall be subject to:
(A) The granting of a conditional use permit by the City in each case;
and
(B) The satisfaction of the following conditions:
(i)
Absence of conflicts. Sufficient evidence shall be submitted
demonstrating that no substantial conflict in the principal hours
or periods of peak demands of the structures or uses for which the
joint use is proposed will exist.
(ii)
Amount of credit. The number of parking spaces which may be
credited against the requirements for each structure or use involved
shall not exceed the number of spaces reasonably anticipated to be
available during the differing hours of operation.
(iii)
Location. The parking facilities designated for joint use shall
be contiguous to all the structures and uses served.
(iv)
Recorded agreements. The City may require a written agreement,
approved by the City Attorney as to form and content, to be executed
by all parties concerned and filed in the office of the County Recorder.
Such agreement shall be a covenant running with the land or other
enforceable restriction and shall assure the continued availability
of the number of spaces designated for joint use at the periods of
time indicated.
(3) Joint usage where there is no overall deficiency in the number of
spaces provided. If two or more adjoining uses are under common ownership,
or if the ownership is not common and the respective owners thereof
have acquired recordable easements appurtenant for off-street parking,
such buildings or uses collectively may provide the required off-street
parking, in which case the required number of parking spaces shall
not be less than the sum of the requirements for the several individual
uses computed separately.
(4) Mixed land use developments (shared parking). Shared parking may
be considered in determining the specific number of parking spaces
that can be used to serve two or more individual land uses without
conflict or encroachment. Any program that would use a shared parking
concept may be granted by the Planning Commission if it determines
in any individual use that the following findings can be satisfied:
(A) Variations in the peak accumulations of parking vehicles as the result
of different activity patterns of mixed land use will not result in
a deficiency of parking spaces (by hour, by day, by season).
(B) Relationship among land use activities that results in people’s
attraction to two or more land uses on a single trip to the development.
In preparing information for consideration by the Planning Commission,
a methodology acceptable to the Planning Director and Director of
Public Works is to be used.
(d) Parking
facilities—Design and improvement standards.
(1) General design requirements.
(A) All spaces shall be provided adequate access by means of maneuvering
lanes. Spaces designed so that it is necessary to back directly into
a public street to enter or to leave them shall be prohibited, except
for residential garages and carports serving single-family dwellings
and duplexes.
(B) Adequate entries and exits to and from parking facilities by means
of clearly defined drives shall be provided for all vehicles. Circulation
within a parking facility shall be such that:
(i)
A vehicle using the parking facility need not enter the street
to reach another aisle within the same facility.
(ii)
All parking spaces, garages, and carports shall be accessible
and usable for the full number of parking spaces required whenever
the use or structure which they were built to serve is in operation.
(C) Continuous curbs and/or headers shall be used instead of individual
wheel stops, unless otherwise approved by the Planning Director.
(D) The illumination of a parking or loading facility shall conform to the requirements standards contained in Section
9-3.529 Lighting.
(E) The entire parking area, including the parking spaces and maneuvering
lanes required by this section, shall be paved with asphaltic, concrete
surfacing, or other acceptable material in accordance with specifications
approved by the City Engineer and Orange County Fire Authority.
(2) Specific design requirements.
(A) Markings. In all parking facilities, individual stalls shall be marked
with hairpin lines four inches to six inches wide forming an elongated
“U” between 12 inches and 24 inches wide around the centerline
of each stall, except that parking facilities serving not more than
two dwelling units on a single lot need not be marked. The space widths
set forth in this subsection shall be the overall width of the stall,
including the areas required for marking.
In all parking facilities containing 21 or more spaces, the
aisles, approach lanes, and maneuvering areas shall be clearly marked
with directional arrows and lines to expedite traffic movement. Once
a parking facility has been marked in accordance with the approved
site plan, the markings shall be permanently maintained.
(i)
Marking maintenance. Will be properly marked and maintained.
(ii)
Changes. If any changes to existing markings are approved by
the City, existing markings shall first be ground out or sand blasted
prior to remarking the parking area. Painting over existing markings
without first grinding out or sand blasting is not permitted. Remarking
of the parking area according to the approved, revised site plan will
be done in accordance with this section.
(B) Layout. Plans for the layout of off-street parking facilities shall
be in accordance with the minimum requirements set forth in Table
3-32 and Figure 3-4. For landscape islands at the end of aisles, the
length of the island shall be rounded with a maximum dimension of
15 feet from the front of the parking stall to the end of the landscape
island (as shown in Figure 3-4).
(C) Residential garages. For residential uses, single-car garages shall
be a minimum of 10 feet wide by 20 feet deep, and two car garages
shall be a minimum of 19 feet wide by 20 feet deep, provided no washer/dryer
or water heaters are located within said designated area.
Table 3-32
Minimum Parking Facility Standards
|
---|
Parking Angle (Degrees)
|
Aisle Width* (One-Way Flow)
|
Space Width All Uses
|
Space Depth** All Uses
|
---|
Parallel Parking (0°)***
|
13 feet
|
9 feet
|
24 feet
|
1-34
|
13 feet
|
9 feet
|
19 feet
|
35-44
|
15 feet
|
9 feet
|
19 feet
|
45-54
|
16 feet
|
9 feet
|
19 feet
|
55-64
|
19 feet
|
9 feet
|
19 feet
|
65-74
|
22 feet
|
9 feet
|
19 feet
|
75-90
|
25 feet
|
9 feet
|
19 feet
|
*
|
For two-way flow, the aisle widths, approach lanes, and maneuvering
areas shall be a minimum of 25 feet wide for all parking angles.
|
**
|
For parking angles greater than 59 degrees, up to 2 feet of
the space depth may be provided in overhang beyond the front curb.
|
***
|
If parallel parking spaces are paired, with at least 8 feet
of red curbing between the pairs, the space depth may be a minimum
of 20 feet.
|
Figure 3-4 Parking Facility Design Requirements
|
(e) Parking
facilities—Landscaping. Refer to Section 9-3.529(h)(1) and (2)
Landscape.
(f) Off-street
parking requirements—General.
(1) Units of measurements.
(A) Fractional remainders. When the unit of measurement determining the
number of required parking spaces results in the requirement of a
fractional space, any fraction up to, but not including, one-half
shall be disregarded, and fractions equal to, or greater than, one-half
shall require one parking space.
(B) Number of employees. When the unit of measurement determining the
number of required parking spaces is based on the number of employees,
the maximum shift or employment period during which the greatest number
of employees is present at the structure or use shall be used in the
computation.
(C) Net floor area. When the unit of measurement determining the number
of required parking spaces is based upon the net floor area, such
area shall be calculated by measuring the total floor area from within
the exterior surface of the walls of the structure but shall exclude:
(i)
Mechanical equipment spaces and shafts; and
(ii)
Elevators, common restrooms, stairways, escalators, and enclosed
or covered parking facilities, loading berths, docks, and ramps.
(D) Fixed seats. When the unit of measurement determining the number
of required parking spaces is based upon the number of fixed seats
in a structure or use, each 24 inches of pew, bench, or other seating
space shall count as one seat.
(2) Spaces required for commercial vehicles and for loading.
(A) Spaces for commercial vehicles. In addition to the parking spaces
required by subsection (g) of this section for owners, occupants,
employees, customers, and visitors of structures and uses, one parking
space shall be provided for each commercial vehicle used in conjunction
with the operation of any structure or use. The parking spaces for
such accessory vehicles shall be provided within a designated parking
space on the same lot as, or adjacent to, the structure or use to
which the vehicles are necessary.
(B) Off-street loading. Off-street loading space shall be required on
the same building site with every building; storage warehouse, auto
dealership, wholesale distributor, goods display center, department
store, market, hotel, hospital, funeral home, laundry, dry cleaning,
and other similar uses involving the receipt or distribution by vehicle
of materials or merchandise incidental to carrying on such activity.
Such space shall be sufficient to permit the standing, loading, and
unloading of vehicles to avoid undue interference with the public
use of streets and alleys and shall not be a part of the building
site area used for the off-street parking required for each particular
use.
(3) Spaces for handicapped persons. Parking spaces for handicapped persons
shall be provided in accordance with accepted State standards, and
shall be considered as part of the parking space requirements for
the given facility.
(4) In-lieu fee program. To provide for adequate off-street parking facilities
and allow for creative solutions to parking issues, the City may adopt
an in-lieu fee program to assist in the funding of off-street parking.
(g) Off-street
parking requirements—Schedule.
(1) Use. Off-street parking requirements for a project shall be based
on the land use and or zoning district.
(2) Parking Management Plan—Criteria. The numerical parking requirements
set forth in this subsection may be reduced through the granting of
an exception by the Planning Commission when a parking management
plan is developed for a project. Such parking requirements shall be
reduced only if the parking management plan incorporates provisions
encouraging the use of public transportation facilities or otherwise
aimed at reducing the growth of total vehicle miles traveled.
(3) Residential uses. The parking requirements for residential uses shall
be in addition to the spaces required for any recreation or community
center provided within a residential development. The space requirements
for recreation and community centers shall be determined pursuant
to subsection (5) of this subsection. The Planning Commission, in
conjunction with the development review procedure pursuant to Article
3 Development Review Procedures of Chapter 2 of this title, may credit
some or all of the recreation or community center spaces provided
toward the satisfaction of the visitor parking requirements for the
development if such spaces are in close proximity to residences within
the development.
For residential developments within the Multiple-Family (RM),
Affordable Family/Senior Housing (AF/SH), Mobilehome Park (MHP), and
Planned
Community (PC) Districts, there shall also be provided one recreational
vehicle space for every seven dwelling units, as well as for developments
in the Hillside Residential (HR), Single-Family (RS-10,000, RS-7,000
and RS-4,000) and Residential Garden (RG-7,000 and RG-4,000) Districts
wherein any individual lot sizes are less than 10,000 square feet
for the exclusive use of project residents.
The numerical parking requirements for residential uses are
identified in Table 3-33.
Table 3-33
Residential Parking Requirements
|
---|
Land Use Type
|
Required Off-Street Parking
|
Notes and Comments
|
---|
Apartment - Studio
|
2.0 off-street parking spaces per dwelling unit, at least 1
space per dwelling unit shall be in a garage; and 0.5 spaces per dwelling
unit visitor parking
|
|
Apartment - One bedroom units
|
2.0 off-street parking spaces per dwelling unit, at least 1
space per dwelling unit shall be in a garage; and 0.5 spaces per dwelling
unit visitor parking.
|
|
Apartment - Two bedroom units
|
2.5 off-street parking spaces per dwelling unit, at least 1
space per dwelling unit shall be in a garage; and 0.5 spaces per dwelling
unit visitor parking.
|
|
Apartment - Three or more bedroom units
|
3.0 off-street parking spaces per dwelling unit, at least 1
space per dwelling unit shall be in a garage; and 0.5 spaces per dwelling
unit visitor parking.
|
|
Senior apartments (age restricted)
|
1.0 space per unit.
|
|
Bed & breakfast (B&B)
|
2.0 spaces for the resident manager; and 1 space for each guest
room.
|
|
Boarding and lodging houses, student housing, dormitories, and
fraternity and sorority housing
|
1.0 off-street parking spaces per guest rooms and 1.0 per each
dwelling unit.
|
In dormitories, each 100 square feet of gross floor area shall
be considered equivalent to 1 guest room.
|
Mobilehome parks
|
2.0 off-street parking spaces per dwelling site, at least 1
space per dwelling to be covered, 1 space may be tandem;
0.4 spaces per dwelling site for visitor parking, plus the spaces
required for recreation centers, if any.
|
Visitor parking shall be evenly distributed throughout the park.
|
Multiple-family residences
|
2.0 off-street parking spaces per dwelling unit, at least 1
of which shall be either in a garage or covered (tandem parking prohibited);
and
0.8 spaces per dwelling unit visitor parking.
|
The visitor parking ratio shall be maintained within each subarea
of a development so that all residences are within reasonable walking
distance from the nearest visitor parking space. The design and location
of visitor parking areas shall be subject to approval by the Planning
Commission in conjunction with the development review procedure.
|
Single-family residences (Single-family detached dwellings,
two-family dwellings (duplexes), and zero lot line dwellings utilizing
a common wall)
|
2.0 off-street parking spaces per dwelling unit in a garage;
and
0.8 spaces per dwelling unit visitor parking.
|
|
(4) Business and commercial uses. The numerical parking requirements
for business and commercial uses are identified in Table 3-34. For
the purposes of this section, “shopping center” shall
mean a group of two or more commercial establishments planned and
developed, owned, and managed as a unit, with off-street parking and
loading provided on the property.
Table 3-34
Business and Commercial Uses Parking Requirements
|
---|
Land Use Type
|
Required Off-Street Parking
|
Notes and Comments
|
---|
Building materials and equipment sales and storage yards
|
1.0 off-street parking space per each 800 square feet of gross
floor area; and 1.0 per each 10,000 square feet of outdoor sales,
storage, or service area; and 1.0 per each registered motor vehicle
operated in conjunction with the use or building.
|
|
Car washes, except self-operated
|
1.0 off-street parking space per employee, plus reservoir (lineup)
parking equal to 5 times the capacity of the car wash
|
In determining capacity, each 20 linear feet of wash line shall
equal 1 car length.
|
Car washes, self-operated
|
5.0 off-street parking spaces per each 2 wash stalls
|
A wash stall shall not be counted as a parking space.
|
Coin-operated laundries
|
1.0 off-street parking space per each 3 washing machines
|
|
Commercial repair establishments, such as motor vehicle repair
garages, marine service establishments, appliance service, and similar
type uses
|
1.0 off-street parking space per each 500 square feet of gross
floor area
|
Square footage calculation shall not include areas used exclusively
for storage or loading.
|
Fast food and takeout restaurants not having drive-thru facilities
|
1.0 off-street parking space per each 50 square feet of gross
floor area, but not less than 8.0 per each such use
|
|
Food stores, grocery stores, supermarkets, and similar uses
in shopping centers or individually developed
|
1.0 off-street parking space per each 200 square feet of gross
floor area
|
Does not include convenience markets.
|
Fruit/agriculture stand
|
1.0 off-street parking space per each 500 square feet of gross
floor area
|
|
Furniture and appliance establishments
|
1.0 off-street parking space per each 500 square feet of gross
floor area, except areas used exclusively for storage or loading,
but not less than 5.0 off-street parking spaces per each such use
|
|
General retail in individually-developed establishments or within
shopping centers
|
1.0 off-street parking space per each 250 square feet of leasable
floor area
|
Includes convenience markets.
|
General wholesale establishments
|
1.0 off-street parking space per each 1,500 square feet of gross
floor area, but not less than 6.0 per each such use
|
|
Hotels/motels
|
1.0 off-street parking space per each guest unit. The planning
commission may require additional parking spaces for accessory uses
to include, and not be limited to, restaurants and banquet/ conference/
meeting facilities.
|
Parking standards may be reduced with a parking study and/or
shared parking agreement.
|
New and used vehicle sales, leasing or rental services, including
bicycle shops
|
1.0 off-street parking space per each 500 square feet of gross
floor area, except areas used exclusively for storage or loading
|
|
Restaurants, bars, brewpubs, microbreweries, distilleries, wineries,
and wine tasting rooms
|
1.0 off-street parking space per each 40 square feet of dining
or drinking area, but not less than 8.0 off-street parking spaces
per each such use
|
Dining or drinking area shall include all the floor area, except
restrooms, kitchens, sculleries, storage, and equipment areas.
|
Retail plant nurseries, garden shops, and similar uses with
outdoor sales and display areas
|
1.0 off-street parking space per each 500 square feet of display
and sales area, but not less than 5.0 per each such use
|
Calculation of square footage includes both indoor and outdoor,
excluding areas used exclusively for the storage or propagation of
plants.
|
Service stations
|
1.0 off-street parking space per each 2,500 square feet of gross
site area, but not less than 8.0 per each such use
|
|
(5) Office, service, health, and professional uses. The numerical parking
requirements for office, service, health, and professional uses are
identified in Table 3-35.
Table 3-35
Office, Service, Health, and Professional Uses Parking Requirements
|
---|
Land Use Type
|
Required Off-Street Parking
|
Notes and Comments
|
---|
Banks, savings and loan institutions, ticket agencies, and other
similar establishments utilizing window services for patrons within
individually developed establishments or office complexes
|
1.0 off-street parking space per each 200 square feet of gross
floor area
|
|
Barber shops
|
2.0 off-street parking spaces per barber chair, but not less
than 1.0 per each such use
|
|
Beauty salons
|
3.0 per beautician station, but not less than 6.0 per each such
use
|
|
Convalescent and nursing homes, assisted care facilities, senior
living facilities, children’s homes, and sanitariums
|
1.0 off-street parking space per each 3 beds
|
|
Hospitals
|
1.5 off-street parking spaces per each patient bed
|
|
General office
|
3.5 off-street parking spaces per 1,000 square feet of gross
floor area or 1.0 space per employee, whichever is greater
|
|
Medical and dental offices, centers, and clinics, but excluding
hospitals
|
1.0 off-street parking space per each 200 square feet of gross
floor area; and 1.0 per each separate medical or dental office or
laboratory
|
Calculating the gross floor area includes pharmacies and other
retail uses, but excludes corridor and lobby areas.
|
Office park that includes general office, restaurants, banks,
savings and loans and support services
|
1.0 off-street parking space per 200 square feet of gross floor
area
|
|
Research centers devoted nearly exclusively to research and
development activities; may also contain offices and some light fabrication
areas
|
1.0 off-street parking space per 300 square feet of gross floor
area
|
|
Veterinary offices and clinics and veterinary hospitals
|
1.0 off-street parking space per each 250 square feet of gross
floor area; and 1.0 per each separate medical or dental office or
laboratory
|
|
(6) Recreational uses and places of assembly. The numerical parking requirements
for recreational uses and places of assembly are identified in Table
3-36.
Table 3-36
Recreational Uses and Places of Assembly Parking Requirements
|
---|
Land Use Type
|
Required Off-Street Parking
|
Notes and Comments
|
---|
Bowling lanes, pool halls and billiard halls
|
5.0 off-street parking spaces per bowling lane and 2.0 per pool
or billiard table, plus the spaces required for additional uses on
the site
|
|
Churches, chapels, and mortuaries
|
1.0 off-street parking space per each 3 fixed seats; and 1.0
off-street parking space per every 30 square feet of seating area
where there are no fixed seats
|
|
Driving ranges
|
1.5 off-street parking spaces per tee, plus the spaces required
for additional uses on the site
|
|
Golf courses and country clubs that include clubhouses with
bars and banquet facilities
|
1.3 off-street parking spaces per gross acre
|
|
Health studios, spas, and athletic clubs
|
1.0 off-street parking space per each 150 square feet of gross
floor area
|
For the purposes of this use, swimming pools shall be counted
as a part of the gross floor area.
|
Lodges, clubs, dancing, and similar uses
|
1.0 off-street parking space per each 3 people allowed under
the maximum occupancy.
|
|
Pitch and putt and miniature golf courses
|
2.0 off-street parking spaces per hole, plus the spaces required
for additional uses on the site
|
|
Recreation centers, community centers, and noncommercial swimming
pools
|
1.0 off-street parking space per each 4 persons, based upon
the maximum capacity of all facilities capable of simultaneous use
as determined by the Planning Director; and 1.0 off-street parking
space per employee
|
|
Skating rinks, ice and roller, including arena hockey
|
1.0 off-street parking space per each 100 square feet of gross
floor area, plus the spaces required for additional uses on the site
|
|
Stables (commercial)
|
1.0 off-street parking space per each 5 horses based on the maximum number of horses capable of being boarded as determined by Section 9-3.515 Equestrian Standards
|
|
Swimming pools (commercial)
|
1.0 off-street parking space per each 200 square feet of water
area, plus the spaces required for additional uses on the site
|
|
Tennis, squash, and handball courts
|
4.0 off-street parking spaces per court or 1,000 square feet
of gross floor area, whichever is greater
|
|
Theaters, auditoriums, gymnasiums, arenas, and stadiums
|
1.0 off-street parking space per each 3 fixed seats; and 1.0
per every 30 square feet of seating area where there are no fixed
seats
|
Includes convention halls and assembly halls.
|
(7) Educational and cultural uses. The numerical parking requirements
for educational and cultural uses are identified in Table 3-37.
Table 3-37
Educational and Cultural Uses Parking Requirements
|
---|
Land Use Type
|
Required Off-Street Parking
|
Notes and Comments
|
---|
Business, professional, and trade schools
|
1.0 off-street parking space per faculty, staff member, or employee;
and 1.0 off-street parking space per each 3 students; and the additional
requirements for auditoriums and stadiums
|
|
Child care centers, day nurseries, and preschool and nursery
schools
|
1.0 off-street parking space per employee or staff member; and
1.0 off-street parking space per every 8 children allowed under the
maximum occupancy
|
|
Colleges and universities, including auditoriums and stadiums
on the site
|
1.0 off-street parking space per faculty, staff member, or employee;
and 1.0 off-street parking space per each 3 students and the additional
requirements for auditoriums and stadiums
|
|
Private elementary and junior high schools, including auditoriums
and stadiums on the site
|
1.0 off-street parking space per teacher, staff member, or employee;
and 1.0 space per 15 students for student loading/unloading and visitor
parking; and the additional requirements for auditoriums and stadiums
|
|
Libraries, museums, and public art galleries
|
1.0 off-street parking space per each 250 square feet of gross
floor area
|
|
School administration buildings
|
3.5 off-street parking spaces per each 1,000 square feet of
gross floor area
|
|
Private senior high schools, including auditoriums and stadiums
on the site
|
1.0 off-street parking space per teacher, staff member, or employee;
and 1.0 off-street parking space per each 5 students regularly enrolled;
and the additional requirements for auditoriums and stadiums
|
|
(8) Manufacturing and related uses. The numerical parking requirements
for manufacturing and related uses are identified in Table 3-38. In
addition to the requirements set forth in Table 3-38, each manufacturing
or related use shall provide one parking space per each registered
motor vehicle operated in conjunction with the use or building.
Table 3-38
Manufacturing and Related Uses Parking Requirements
|
---|
Land Use Type
|
Required Off-Street Parking
|
Notes and Comments
|
---|
Industrial parks containing a number of industrial, manufacturing,
warehouse facilities or related facilities
|
3.0 off-street parking spaces per 1,000 square feet of gross
floor area
|
|
Laboratories and research establishments
|
1.0 off-street parking space per each 300 square feet of gross
floor area, but not less than 3.0 per each 4 employees
|
|
Single tenant manufacturing and industrial establishments, including
offices and other incidental operations on the same site
|
1.0 off-street parking space per each 500 square feet of gross
floor area, but not less than 3.0 per each 4 employees
|
|
Mini-storage facilities which provide rent or leasable storage
areas of maximum 600 square feet per storage unit
|
1.0 off-street parking space per each 4,000 square feet of gross
leasable area
|
|
Public utility facilities, including electric, gas, water, telephone,
and telegraph
|
1.0 off-street parking space per each employee, but not less
than 2.0 per each such facility
|
|
facilities not having business offices on the premises
|
|
|
Vehicle storage, including recreational vehicles and boats
|
1.0 off-street parking space per each 10,000 square feet of
gross land or floor area, but not less than 2.0 parking spaces
|
|
Warehouses and storage buildings
|
1.0 off-street parking space per each 1,000 square feet of gross
floor area, but not less than 1.0 per each employee
|
|
(h) Establishment
of Shared Parking/Park Once Standards and Land Use Parking Ratios
in the Town Center (TC) District, Town Center Edge (TCE) District,
and portions of the General Commercial (GC) District and Los Rios
Specific Plan for Nonresidential Properties, Five Minute Walking Distance
Radius (i.e., approximately 1,500 linear feet of the intersection
of Camino Capistrano and Forster Street) from City-Owned Public Parking
Lots as Set Forth in Exhibit “A” to Ordinance No. 980
(hereinafter called the “Exhibit A Park Once Area”).
(1) Standards. The establishment, operation, use, expansion or occupancy
of any nonresidential business or land use in the Exhibit A Park Once
Area, shall comply with the following parking development standards:
(A) City-owned public parking lots. Parking requirements for nonresidential
uses may utilize shared parking/park once in their parking calculations
if the property for the business or use and the public parking lot
is located within the limits of the City parking regulating plan identified
in Ordinance No. 980 as set forth by Exhibit “A.” Shared
parking/park once may be approved for businesses by the Development
Services Director or designee. Properties or businesses shall utilize
all parking available on their sites in the parking calculations prior
to park once.
(B) Shared/reciprocal parking. Parking requirements for nonresidential
businesses and uses may be satisfied by entering into a shared parking
agreement if such business or use and the public off-street parking
facilities are located within the limits of the City parking regulating
plan identified in Ordinance No. 980 as set forth by Exhibit “A.”
Such agreements may be approved by the Development Services Director
or designee. Such agreements will be based on Municipal Code parking
standards and monitored by the Development Services Department.
(C) Restaurants, nightclubs, bars, brewpubs, microbreweries, distilleries,
wineries and wine tasting rooms shall provide a minimum of one parking
stall per 100 square feet of dining or drinking area (kitchens, prep
areas and storage are excluded from this area).
(i)
Outdoor dining or drinking areas parking requirements are included
as part of the indoor parking calculations. No additional parking
spaces for outdoor dining or drinking areas are required as they are
considered accessory to the principal use.
(ii)
Outdoor dining or drinking areas shall not block or impede pedestrian
access or obstruct ADA path of travel requirements.
(D) General retail shall provide a minimum of one parking stall per 400
square feet of building or tenant lease area.
(E) General office shall provide a minimum of one parking stall per 400
square feet of building area or tenant lease area.
(F) Service uses (i.e., banks, barbers, salons, spas, markets, grocery
stores, supermarkets and similar uses) shall provide a minimum of
one parking stall per 300 square feet of building area or tenant lease
area.
(G) Other uses permitted in Exhibit A Park Once Area shall provide parking consistent with Section
9-3.535 of the Title
9 Land Use Code.
(2) Definitions. For purposes of this subdivision the following are definitions
to be applied in the Exhibit A Park Once Area identified in this subdivision:
“Building Area.”
The total area in square feet of all rooms including corridors,
elevators, stairwells, shaft spaces, bathrooms, closets, and storage
areas (excluding garages and parking areas).
“City Parking Regulating Plan.”
The area in Exhibit A Park Once Area that is a five minute
walking distance radius approximately 1,500 linear feet from the intersection
of Camino Capistrano and Forster Street.
“Dining/Drinking Area.”
The area that includes tables and chairs used by patrons
for dining and/or drinking purposes.
“Public Parking Lot.”
An open public parking facility which is not accessory to
a structure or used on the same or another lot and which is located
within the Exhibit A Park Once Area.
“Shared Parking/Park Once.”
The development and use of City-owned public parking areas
for joint use by more than one business. Such parking areas as identified
in Exhibit “A” [to Ordinance No. 980] distribute shared
public parking lots and public garages within a defined geographic
area for the convenience of customers and to relieve individual properties
of providing parking on their own lots.
“Shared/Reciprocal Parking Agreement.”
A written binding document executed between property owners
to provide a designated number of off-street parking stalls within
a designated area to specified businesses or land uses.
(Ord. No. 869, § 2; Ord. No. 973, § 4, 2010; Ord. No. 980, § 2, 2011; Ord. No. 1076, §§ 13—15,2020; Ord. No. 1082, §§ 11—15,
2021)
(a) Purpose
and intent. The provisions of this section are established to provide
for the redemption and recycling of reusable materials and make such
facilities convenient to the consumer in order to reduce the solid
waste stream to landfills and increase the recycling of reusable materials.
The recycling facilities outlined by this section are intended to
encourage recycling services by providing a comprehensive and easily
understood program of permitting and regulating such uses.
(b) Land
use standards.
(1) Permit requirements. No person shall permit the placement, construction,
or operation of any recycling facility without first obtaining approvals
and a permit pursuant to the provisions set forth in this section.
The fees associated with the processing of conditional use permits
shall be established by separate City Council resolution. Recycling
facilities shall be permitted as set forth in Table 3-39.
Table 3-39
Allowed Recycling Facilities
|
---|
Base District
|
Reverse Vending Machine
|
Small Collection Facility
|
Large Collection Facility
|
Light Processing Facility
|
Heavy Processing Facility
|
---|
RA
|
—
|
—
|
—
|
—
|
—
|
HR
|
—
|
—
|
—
|
—
|
—
|
RSE-40,000
|
—
|
—
|
—
|
—
|
—
|
RSE-20,000
|
—
|
—
|
—
|
—
|
—
|
RS-10,000
|
—
|
—
|
—
|
—
|
—
|
RS-7,000
|
—
|
—
|
—
|
—
|
—
|
RS-4,000
|
—
|
—
|
—
|
—
|
—
|
RG-7,000
|
—
|
—
|
—
|
—
|
—
|
RG-4,000
|
—
|
—
|
—
|
—
|
—
|
RM
|
—
|
—
|
—
|
—
|
—
|
AF/SH
|
—
|
—
|
—
|
—
|
—
|
MHP
|
P
|
S
|
—
|
—
|
—
|
TC
|
P
|
S
|
—
|
—
|
—
|
NC
|
P
|
S
|
S
|
—
|
—
|
GC
|
P
|
S
|
S
|
C
|
C
|
OC
|
P
|
S
|
—
|
—
|
—
|
CM
|
P
|
S
|
S
|
C
|
C
|
IP
|
P
|
P
|
S
|
C
|
C
|
A
|
C/S
|
C/S
|
C/S
|
C/S
|
C/S
|
P&I
|
P
|
S
|
S
|
—
|
—
|
GOS
|
—
|
—
|
—
|
—
|
—
|
OSR
|
—
|
—
|
—
|
—
|
—
|
NP
|
—
|
—
|
—
|
—
|
—
|
CP
|
—
|
—
|
—
|
—
|
—
|
SP
|
—
|
—
|
—
|
—
|
—
|
RP
|
—
|
—
|
—
|
—
|
—
|
NOS
|
—
|
—
|
—
|
—
|
—
|
RC
|
P
|
S
|
—
|
—
|
—
|
FM
|
P
|
S
|
—
|
—
|
—
|
SWF
|
P
|
P
|
S
|
C
|
C
|
PC
|
P
|
S
|
—
|
—
|
—
|
SP/PP
|
P
|
S
|
—
|
—
|
—
|
— = Not permitted
|
P = Permitted
|
C = Conditional Use Permit
|
S = Site Plan Review
|
(2) Operational/site standards. Those recycling facilities permitted
shall meet all of the applicable criteria and standards listed. Those
recycling facilities permitted with a conditional use permit shall
meet the applicable criteria and standards provided that the Zoning
Administrator or Planning Commission, as the case may be, may grant
an exception to said stricter standards as an exercise of discretion
upon finding that such modifications are reasonably necessary in order
to implement the general intent of this section and would be compatible
with adjacent uses.
The criteria and standards for recycling facilities are as follows:
(A) Reverse vending machines. Reverse vending machines located outside
a structure do not require discretionary permits. Reverse vending
machines do not require additional parking spaces for recycling customers
and may be permitted in the districts identified in Table 3-39; provided,
that they comply with the following standards:
(i)
Are established in conjunction with a commercial use or community
service facility which is in compliance with the Zoning, Building
and Fire Codes of the City of San Juan Capistrano;
(ii)
Are located near the entrance to the commercial structure and
shall not obstruct pedestrian or vehicular circulation;
(iii)
Do occupy parking spaces required by the primary use;
(iv)
Do not occupy more than 50 square feet of floor space;
(v)
Are constructed of durable rustproof and water proof material;
(vi)
Have sign area of a maximum of four square feet per machine
exclusive of operating instructions;
(vii)
Comply with illumination requirements in this code;
(viii)
Are maintained in a clean, dry, and litter-free condition on
a daily basis;
(ix)
Are clearly marked to identify the phone number of the operator
or responsible person if the machine is inoperative or in violation
of this Code.
(B) Small collection facilities. Small collection facilities may be located
in the districts identified in Table 3-39 and do not require additional
parking spaces provided that they comply with the following standards:
(i)
The facility shall be established in conjunction with an existing
commercial use or community service facility which is in compliance
with the Zoning, Building and Fire Codes of the City of San Juan Capistrano;
(ii)
The facility shall be no larger than 500 square feet and occupy
no more than five parking spaces, not including space that will be
needed periodically for removal of materials or exchange of containers,
provided said parking spaces are not necessary to satisfy the minimum
on-site parking requirements of the Municipal Code;
(iii)
The facility shall be set back 10 feet from the street line
and shall not obstruct pedestrian or vehicular circulation;
(iv)
The facility and signs shall be in compliance with the requirements
of Chapter 3 Zoning Districts and Standards of this title;
(v)
No additional parking spaces will be required for customers
of small collection facilities;
(vi)
Hours of operations will be restricted to the same as the host
use;
(vii)
The facility shall be clearly marked to identify the phone number
of the operator or responsible person if the machines are inoperative
or in violation of this code;
(viii)
The site shall be maintained free of litter and any other undesirable
materials, and will be cleaned of loose debris on a daily basis.
(C)
Large collection facilities. A
large collection facility is one that is larger than 500 square feet,
or is on a separate property not appurtenant to a host use, and which
may have a permanent building. Large collection facilities are permitted
in the districts identified in Table 3-39, subject to approval of
a site plan review and/or conditional use permit, and the facility
shall meet the following standards:
(i)
The facility does not abut a property zoned or planned for residential
use;
(ii)
The facility will be screened from the public right-of-way by
operating in an enclosed building or;
(a)
Within an area enclosed by an opaque fence at least six feet
in height with landscaping;
(b)
At least 150 feet from property zoned or planned for residential
use;
(iii)
The facility shall meet all development standards as required
in Chapter 3 Zoning Districts and Standards of this title;
(iv)
The site shall be maintained free of litter and any other undesirable
materials, and will be cleaned of loose debris on a daily basis.
(D)
Processing facilities. A processing
facility is permitted in specific districts as identified under Table
3-39 of this Title, subject to approval of a conditional use permit,
and shall meet the following conditions:
(i)
The facility does not abut a property zoned or planned for residential
use;
(ii)
Processors will operate in a wholly enclosed building except
for incidental storage or:
(a)
Within an area enclosed on all sides by an opaque fence or wall
not less than six feet in height and landscaped on all street frontages;
(b)
Located at least 150 feet from property zoned or planned for
residential use;
(iii)
Operating hours shall be determined by the City through the
required permitting process;
(iv)
The site shall be maintained free of litter and any other undesirable
materials, and will be cleaned of loose debris on a daily basis;
(v)
The facility shall meet all development standards as required
in Chapter 3 Zoning Districts and Standards of this title.
(c) General
Requirements for On-Site Collection and Loading Facilities for Recyclable
Materials.
(1) Any new development project for which an application for a building
permit is submitted on or after October 1, 1995, shall include adequate,
accessible, and convenient areas for collecting and loading recyclable
materials.
(2) Any improvements for areas of a public facility used for collecting
and loading solid waste shall include adequate, accessible, and convenient
areas for collecting and locating recyclable materials.
(3) Any project for which an application for a building permit is submitted
on or after October 24, 1994, for modifications that meet one or both
of the conditions below shall include adequate, accessible and convenient
areas for collecting and loading recyclable materials:
(A) Modification to the project adds 30% or more to the existing floor
area; or
(B) The price of modification exceeds $50,000 in value.
(4) The following standards shall be applied to on-site recyclable materials
collection facilities:
(A) Single-family dwellings. Single-family dwelling detached receiving
curbside service: 133 cubic feet of storage area, either interior
or exterior, with minimum dimensions of 84 inches wide by 39 inches
deep by 72 inches high and not visible from adjacent rights-of-way
or other properties.
(B) Multifamily dwellings, detached. Multifamily dwellings detached receiving
curbside service: 95 cubic feet of storage area, either interior or
exterior, with a minimum dimension of 60 inches wide by 38 inches
deep by 72 inches high and not visible from adjacent rights-of way.
(C) Multifamily, attached. Multifamily dwellings attached receiving bin
service shall provide interior and exterior storage areas as identified
in Table 3-40.
Table 3-40
Multifamily Attached Uses On-Site Recyclable Storage Requirements
|
---|
Dwelling Units
|
External Space Allocation
|
Internal Space Allocation
|
---|
3-8 units
|
606 cubic feet of storage area with minimum dimensions 15′
wide by 4′ 6″ deep
|
4 cubic feet of storage area within living area of each unit
|
9-16 units
|
1,212 cubic feet of storage area with minimum dimensions 15′
wide by 4′ 6″ deep, no less than 200’ from any
unit
|
4 cubic feet of storage area within living area of each unit
|
17 and above units
|
Add 606 cubic feet to 1,212 cubic feet for every 8 units over
16 with minimum dimensions 15′ wide by 4′ 6″
deep, no less than 200′ from any unit
|
4 cubic feet of storage area within living area of each unit
|
(D) Commercial uses. Commercial uses shall provide interior and exterior
storage areas for recyclable materials as identified in Table 3-41.
Table 3-41
Commercial Uses On-Site Recyclable Storage Requirements
|
---|
Land Use
|
Building Floor Area
|
External Space Allocation
|
Internal Space Allocation
|
---|
Office/Retail
|
0-5,000 square feet
|
606 cubic feet with minimum dimensions 15′ wide by 4′6″
deep
|
44 cubic feet with minimum dimensions 60″ wide by 36″
deep by 74″ high each suite
|
5,001-25,000 square feet
|
1,212 cubic feet with minimum dimensions 15′ wide by
4′6″ deep, no less than 300′ from any suite
|
44 cubic feet with minimum dimensions 60″ wide by 36″
deep by 74″ high each suite
|
25,001 square feet and above
|
Add 606 cubic feet to 1,212 cubic feet for every 5,000 square
feet over 25,001 with minimum dimensions 15′ wide by 4′6″
deep, no less than 300 feet from any suite
|
44 cubic feet with minimum dimensions 60″ wide by 36″
deep by 74″ high each suite
|
Restaurant
|
0-3,000 square feet
|
606 cubic feet minimum dimensions 15′ wide by 4′6″
deep
|
44 cubic feet with minimum dimensions 60″ wide by 36″
deep by 74″ high each suite
|
3,001-6,000 square feet
|
1,212 cubic feet with minimum dimensions 15′ wide by
4′6″ deep, no less than 300′ from any suite
|
44 cubic feet with minimum dimensions 60″ wide by 36″
deep by 74″ high each suite
|
6,001 square feet above
|
Add 606 cubic feet to 1,212 cubic feet for every 5,000 square
feet over 25,001 with minimum dimensions 15′ wide by 4′6″
deep, no less than 300′ from any suite
|
44 cubic feet with minimum dimensions 60″ wide by 36″
deep by 74″ high each suite
|
Hotel
|
0-50 rooms
|
606 cubic feet with minimum dimensions 15′ wide by 4′6″
deep
|
n/a
|
51-100 rooms
|
1,212 cubic feet with minimum dimensions 15′ wide by
4′6″ deep, no less than 300′ from any suite
|
n/a
|
101 rooms and above
|
Add 606 cubic feet to 1,212 cubic feet for every 5,000 square
feet over 25,001 with minimum dimensions 15′ wide by 4′6″
deep, no less than 300′ from any suite
|
n/a
|
(d) Definitions.
For the purposes of this section, unless otherwise apparent from the
context, certain words and phrases used in this section are defined
as follows:
Development project.
Development project shall mean any of the following:
(1)
A project of which a building permit is required for a commercial,
industrial, or institutional building, marina, or residential building
having five or more living units, where solid waste is collected and
located and any residential project where solid waste is collected
and loaded in a location serving five or more living units.
(2)
Any new public facility where solid waste is collected and located
and any improvements for areas of a public facility used for collecting
and loading solid waste.
Project for which a building permit is required.
A project for which a building permit is required includes
all new projects, any single alteration of an existing project requiring
a building permit, and any sum total of alterations requiring a building
permit to an existing project conducted within a 12 month period.
(Ord. No. 869, § 2, 2022; Ord. No. 1042, § 17, 2017)
(a) Purpose.
The purpose of this section is to allow and appropriately regulate
two-unit projects in accordance with
Government Code Section 65852.21.
(b) Definitions.
A “two-unit project”
means the development of two primary dwelling units or, if
there is already a primary dwelling unit on the lot, the development
of a second primary dwelling unit on a legally subdivided lot in accordance
with the requirements of this section.
"Building height"
means the vertical distance from finished grade or flood
protection elevation to the topmost point of the roof of a building
or to the highest point of a structure other than a building. Chimneys,
finials, and other rooftop architectural projections are not included
in determining building height.
For structures in hillside areas, allowable building height
shall be determined by connecting an imaginary line, at the applicable
building height standard, between a series of vertical lines drawn
at the uppermost and the lowermost finish grades of a building (typically
measured at a point five feet away from the vertical building wall),
as shown in Figure 3-1b. For purposes of this definition, “hillside
area” means an area in which the average slope of the building
footprint area is 10% or more. For structures in hillside areas that
are constructed on a foundation system that include one or more retaining
walls or other retaining system, the measurement to establish allowable
building height shall be measured from five feet outside of the retaining
wall or system used to support the building.
|
Figure 3-1a: Building Height on Level Lot
|
Figure 3-1b: Building Height on a Hillside
|
(c) Application.
(1) Only individual property owners may apply for a two-unit project.
“Individual property owner” means a natural person holding
fee title individually or jointly in the person’s own name or
a beneficiary of a trust that holds fee title. “Individual property
owner” does not include any corporation or corporate person
of any kind (partnership, LP, LLC, C corp, S corp, etc.) except for
a community land trust (as defined by Revenue and Tax Code Section
402.1(a)(11)(C)(ii)) or a qualified nonprofit corporation (as defined
by Revenue and Tax Code Section 214.15).
(2) An application for a two-unit project must be submitted on the City’s
approved form.
(3) The applicant must obtain a certificate of compliance with the Subdivision
Map Act and the implementing regulations in Code for the lot and provide
the certificate with the application.
(4) Only a complete application will be considered. The City will inform
the applicant in writing of any incompleteness within 30 days after
the application is submitted.
(5) The City may establish a fee to recover its costs for adopting, implementing,
and enforcing this section of the Code, in accordance with applicable
law. The City Council may establish and change the fee by resolution.
The fee must be paid with the application.
(d) Approval.
(1) An application for a two-unit project is approved or denied ministerially,
by the Director of Development Services, without discretionary review.
(2) The ministerial approval of a two-unit project does not take effect
until the City has confirmed that the required documents have been
recorded, such as the deed restriction and easements.
(3) The approval must require the owner and applicant to hold the City
harmless from all claims and damages related to the approval and its
subject matter.
(4) The approval must require the owner and applicant to reimburse the
City for all costs of enforcement, including attorneys’ fees
and costs associated with enforcing the requirements of this Code.
(e) Requirements.
A two-unit project must satisfy each of the following requirements:
(1) Map act compliance. The lot must have been legally subdivided.
(2) Zone. The lot is in a single-family residential zoning district.
For purposes of this section, a single-family residential zoning district
is a zone where the only residential use that is allowed as a primary
use is a single residential dwelling on a lot.
(3) Lot location.
(A) The lot is not located on a site that is any of the following:
(i)
Either prime farmland or farmland of statewide importance, as
defined pursuant to United States Department of Agriculture land inventory
and monitoring criteria, as modified for California, and designated
on the maps prepared by the Farmland Mapping and Monitoring Program
of the Department of Conservation, or land zoned or designated for
agricultural protection or preservation by a local ballot measure
that was approved by the voters of that jurisdiction.
(ii)
Wetlands, as defined in the United States Fish and Wildlife
Service Manual, Part 660 FW 2 (June 21, 1993).
(iii)
Within a very high fire hazard severity zone, as determined
by the Department of Forestry and Fire Protection pursuant to Section
51178 of the
Government Code, or within a high or very high fire hazard
severity zone as indicated on maps adopted by the Department of Forestry
and Fire Protection pursuant to Section 4202 of the Public Resources
Code. This subsection does not apply to sites excluded from the specified
hazard zones by a local agency, pursuant to subdivision (b) of Section
51179 of the
Government Code, or sites that have adopted fire hazard
mitigation measures pursuant to existing building standards or State
fire mitigation measures applicable to the development.
(iv)
A hazardous waste site that is listed pursuant to Section 65962.5
of the
Government Code or a hazardous waste site designated by the
Department of Toxic Substances Control pursuant to Section 25356 of
the
Health and Safety Code, unless the Department of Toxic Substances
Control has cleared the site for residential use or residential mixed
uses.
(v)
Within a delineated earthquake fault zone as determined by the State geologist in any official maps published by the State geologist, unless the development complies with applicable seismic protection building code standards adopted by the California Building Standards Commission under the California Building Standards Law (Part 2.5 (commencing with Section 18901) of Division 13 of the
Health and Safety Code), and by any local building department under Chapter 12.2 (commencing with Section 8875) of Division 1 of Title
2 of the
Government Code.
(vi)
Within a flood plain as determined by maps promulgated by the
Federal Emergency Management Agency, unless the development has been
issued a flood plain development permit pursuant to Part 59 (commencing
with Section 59.1) and Part 60 (commencing with Section 60.1) of Subchapter
B of Chapter I of Title 44 of the Code of Federal Regulations.
(vii)
Within a floodway as determined by maps promulgated by the Federal
Emergency Management Agency, unless the development has received a
no-rise certification in accordance with Section 60.3(d)(3) of Title
44 of the Code of Federal Regulations.
(viii)
Lands identified for conservation in an adopted natural community
conservation plan pursuant to the Natural Community Conservation Planning
Act (Chapter 10 (commencing with Section 2800) of Division 3 of the
Fish and Game Code), habitat conservation plan pursuant to the Federal
Endangered Species Act of 1973 (16 U.S.C. Section 1531 et seq.), or
other adopted natural resource protection plan.
(ix)
Habitat for protected species identified as candidate, sensitive,
or species of special status by State or Federal agencies, fully protected
species, or species protected by the Federal Endangered Species Act
of 1973 (16 U.S.C. Section 1531 et seq.), the California Endangered
Species Act (Chapter 1.5 (commencing with Section 2050) of Division
3 of the
Fish and Game Code), or the Native Plant Protection Act (Chapter
10 (commencing with Section 1900) of Division 2 of the Fish and Game
Code).
(x)
Lands under conservation easement.
(4) Not historic. The lot must not be a historic property or within a
historic district that is included on the State Historic Resources
Inventory. Nor may the lot be or be within a site that is designated
by ordinance as a City or County landmark or as a historic property
or district.
(5) No impact on protected housing. The two-unit project must not require
or include the demolition or alteration of any of the following types
of housing:
(A) Housing that is income-restricted for households of moderate, low,
or very low income.
(B) Housing that is subject to any form of rent or price control through
a public entity’s valid exercise of its police power.
(C) Housing, or a lot that used to have housing, that has been withdrawn
from rental or lease under the Ellis Act (
Government Code Sections
7060–7060.7) at any time in the 15 years prior to submission
of the urban lot split application.
(D) Housing that has been occupied by a tenant in the last three years.
The applicant and the owner of a property for which a two-unit project
is sought must provide a sworn statement as to this fact with the
application for the parcel map. The City may conduct its own inquiries
and investigation to ascertain the veracity of the sworn statement,
including, but not limited to, surveying owners of nearby properties;
and the City may require additional evidence of the applicant and
owner as necessary to determine compliance with this requirement.
(6) Unit standards.
(A) Quantity.
(i)
No more than two dwelling units of any kind may be built on
a lot that results from an urban lot split. For purposes of this paragraph,
“unit” means any dwelling unit, including, but not limited
to, a primary dwelling unit, a unit created under this section of
this Code, an ADU, or a JADU.
(ii)
A lot that is not created by an urban lot split may have a two-unit
project under this section, plus any ADU or JADU that must be allowed
under State law and the City’s ADU ordinance.
(B)
Unit size.
(i)
The total floor area of each primary dwelling built that is
developed under this section must be:
(I)
Less than or equal to 800 square feet, and
(II)
More than (500) square feet.
(ii)
A primary dwelling that was legally established on the lot prior
to the two-unit project and that is larger than (800) square feet
is limited to the lawful floor area at the time of the two-unit project.
The unit may not be expanded.
(iii)
A primary dwelling that was legally established prior to the
two-unit project and that is smaller than 800 square feet may be expanded
to 800 square feet after or as part of the two-unit project.
(C) Height restrictions.
(i)
On a resulting lot that is larger than 2,000 square feet of
gross area, the maximum building height, as defined in this section,
of the new primary dwelling is 16 feet in height and may not exceed
a single story.
(ii)
On a resulting lot that is smaller than 2,000 square feet of
gross area, the maximum building height, as defined in this section,
of the new primary dwelling is 22 feet in height and shall not exceed
two stories. Any portion of a new primary dwelling footprint that
exceeds one story must be stepped back five feet from the ground floor
footprint; no balcony deck or other portion of the second story may
project into the required five foot stepback area.
(iii)
No rooftop deck is permitted on any new or remodeled dwelling
or structure on a lot resulting from an urban lot split.
(D) Demo cap. The two-unit project may not involve the demolition of
more than 25% of the existing exterior walls of an existing dwelling
unless the site has not been occupied by a tenant in the last three
years.
(E) Lot coverage. The lot coverage requirements established in Table 3-2 (Development Standards for Residential Districts) in Section
9-3.301 of this Code apply. These lot coverage standards are only enforced to the extent that they do not prevent two primary dwelling units on the lot at 800 square feet each.
(F) Ridgelines. No construction, along with any associated grading, may
occur within 200 feet (horizontal) of a General Plan designated ridgeline,
or as designated on a final City subdivision map in accordance with
required development conditions. This standard is only enforced to
the extent that it does not prevent two primary dwelling units on
the lot at 800 square feet each.
(G)
Setbacks.
(i)
Generally. All setbacks must conform to those setbacks that
are imposed through the underlying zone.
(ii)
Exceptions. Notwithstanding subsection (e)(6)(G)(i) above:
(I)
Existing structures. No setback is required from the new lot
split property line for an existing legally established structure
or for a new structure that is constructed in the same location and
to the same dimensions as an existing legally established structure.
(II)
Eight hundred square feet; four foot side and rear. The setbacks
imposed by the underlying zone must yield to the degree necessary
to avoid physically precluding the construction of up to two units
on the lot or either of the two units from being at least 800 square
feet in floor area; but in no event may any structure be less than
four feet from a side or rear property line.
(iii)
Front setback area. Notwithstanding any other part of this Code,
dwellings that are constructed after an urban lot split must meet
the required minimum front setbacks identified in Table 3-2 (Development
Standards for Residential Districts). The front setback areas must:
(I)
Be kept free from all structures greater than three feet high;
(II) Be at least 50% landscaped with drought-tolerant
plants, with vegetation and irrigation plans approved by a licensed
landscape architect;
(III) Allow for vehicular and fire-safety access to
the front structure.
(H)
Parking. Each new
primary dwelling unit that is built on a lot after an urban lot split
must have at least one off-street parking space per unit. No off-street
parking spaces are required for new primary dwelling units that are
built on a lot that meets the following:
(i)
The lot is located within one-half mile walking distance of
either:
(I)
A corridor with fixed route bus service with service intervals
no longer than 15 minutes during peak commute hours, or
(II)
A site that contains:
(ia) An existing rail or bus rapid transit station,
(ib) A ferry terminal served by either a bus or rail
transit service, or
(ic) The intersection of two or more major bus routes
with a frequency of service interval of 15 minutes or less during
the morning and afternoon peak commute periods.
(ii)
The site is located within one block of a car-share vehicle
location.
(I) Architecture.
(i)
If there is a legal primary dwelling on the lot that was established
before the two-unit project, any new primary dwelling unit must match
the existing primary dwelling unit in exterior materials, color, and
dominant roof pitch. The dominant roof slope is the slope shared by
the largest portion of the roof.
(ii)
If there is no legal primary dwelling on the lot before the
two-unit project, and if two primary dwellings are developed on a
lot, the dwellings must match each other in exterior materials, color,
and dominant roof pitch. The dominant roof slope is the slope shared
by the largest portion of the roof.
(iii)
All exterior lighting must be limited to down-lights.
(iv)
No window or door of a dwelling that is constructed on the lot
may have a direct line of sight to an adjoining residential property.
Fencing, landscaping, or privacy glass may be used to provide screening
and prevent a direct line of sight.
(v)
If any portion of a dwelling is less than 30 feet from a property
line that is not a public right-of-way line, then all windows and
doors in that portion must either be (for windows) clerestory with
the bottom of the glass at least six feet above the finished floor,
or (for windows and for doors) utilize frosted or obscure glass.
(J)
Landscaping.
(i)
Tree removal.
(I)
Notwithstanding the provisions of Section
9-2.349 (Tree Removal Permit), no mature tree may be removed on a lot for development under this article unless removal is necessary for constructing a minimum size dwelling unit that must be allowed under State law.
(II)
“Mature tree” means a tree with a diameter of six
inches or more measured three feet above grade.
(III) A tree may only be removed under subsection (e)(6)(I)(i)
above if it is replaced with at least two 24 inch box size trees of
the same tree species as the removed tree.
(IV)
If a qualified tree expert, as defined in Section
9-2.349 (Tree Removal Permit), determines that there is not enough space on the lot for the replacement trees that is required under subsection (e)(6)(I)(i) above, then a 1:1 replacement ratio, 15 gallon size trees, or different tree species may be used.
(ii)
Evergreen landscape screening must be planted and maintained
between each dwelling and adjacent lots (but not rights of way) as
follows:
(I)
At least one fifteen (15) gallon size plant shall be provided
for every five linear feet of exterior wall. Alternatively, at least
one twenty-four (24) inch box size plant shall be provided for every
10 linear feet of exterior wall.
(II)
Plant specimens must be at least six feet tall when installed.
As an alternative, a solid fence of at least six feet in height may
be installed.
(III) All landscaping must be drought-tolerant.
(K) Nonconforming conditions. A two-unit project may only be approved
if all nonconforming zoning conditions are corrected.
(L) Utilities.
(i)
Each primary dwelling unit on the lot must have its own direct
utility connection to the utility service provider.
(ii)
Notwithstanding subsection (e)(6)(K)(i) above, a primary dwelling
unit may have a direct utility connection to an on-site wastewater
treatment system in accordance with this subsection and the City’s
Code. Each primary dwelling unit on the lot that is or that is proposed
to be connected to an onsite wastewater treatment system must first
have a percolation test completed within the last five years or, if
the percolation test has been recertified, within the last 10 years.
(iii)
All utilities for new dwelling units must be underground.
(M) Building and safety. All structures built on the lot must comply
with all current local building standards. A project under this section
is a change of use and subjects the whole of the lot, and all structures,
to the City’s current Code.
(7) Fire-hazard mitigation measures.
(A) A lot in a very high fire hazard severity zone must comply with each
of the following fire-hazard mitigation measures in order to be eligible
for an urban lot split:
(i)
It must have direct access to a public right-of-way with a paved
street with a width of at least 40 feet. The public right-of-way must
have at least two independent points of access for fire and life safety
to access and for residents to evacuate.
(ii)
All dwellings on the site must comply with current fire code
requirements for dwellings in a very high fire hazard severity zone.
(iii)
All enclosed structures on the site must have fire sprinklers.
(iv)
All sides of all dwellings on the site must be within a 150
foot hose-pull distance from either the public right-of-way or of
an on-site fire hydrant or standpipe.
(v)
If the lot does not have a swimming pool, the lot must have
a water reservoir of at least 5,000 gallons per dwelling, with fire-authority
approved hookups compatible with fire-authority standard pump and
hose equipment.
(B) Prior to submitting an application for an urban lot split, the applicant
must obtain a certificate of compliance from the City demonstrating
that the developed or vacant lot proposed for an urban lot split complies
with all the applicable fire-hazard mitigation measures identified
in this subpart. The City or its authorized agent must inspect the
site, including all structures on the site, and certify as to its
compliance. The certificate must be included with the application.
The applicant must pay the City’s costs for inspection and issuance
of the certificate of compliance. Failure to pay is grounds for denying
the application.
(8) Separate conveyance.
(A) Primary dwelling units on the lot may not be owned or conveyed separately
from each other.
(B) Condominium airspace divisions and common interest developments are
not permitted within the lot.
(C) All fee interest in the lot and all the dwellings must be held equally
and undivided by all individual property owners.
(i)
No timeshare, as defined by State law or this Code, is permitted.
This includes any co-ownership arrangement that gives an owner the
right to exclusive use of the property for a defined period or periods
of time.
(9) Regulation of uses.
(A) Residential-only. No non-residential use is permitted on the lot.
(B) No short-term rentals. No dwelling unit on the lot may be rented
for a period of less than 30 days.
(C) Owner occupancy. Unless the lot was formed by an urban lot split,
the individual property owners of a lot with a two-unit project must
occupy one of the dwellings on the lot as the owners’ principal
residence and legal domicile.
(10) Notice of construction.
(A) At least 30 business days before starting any construction of a two-unit
project, the property owner must give written notice to all the owners
of record of each of the adjacent residential parcels, which notice
must include the following information:
(i)
Notice that construction has been authorized,
(ii)
The anticipated start and end dates for construction,
(iii)
The hours of construction,
(iv)
Contact information for the project manager (for construction-related
complaints), and
(v)
Contact information for the Building and Safety Department.
(B) This notice requirement does not confer a right on the noticed persons
or on anyone else to comment on the project before permits are issued.
Approval is ministerial. Under State law, the City has no discretion
in approving or denying a particular project under this section. This
notice requirement is purely to promote neighborhood awareness and
expectation.
(11) Deed restriction. The owner must record a deed restriction, on a
form approved by the City, that does each of the following:
(A) Expressly prohibits any rental of any dwelling on the property for
a period of less than 30 days.
(B) Expressly prohibits any non-residential use of the lot.
(C) Expressly prohibits any separate conveyance of a primary dwelling
on the property, any separate fee interest, and any common interest
development within the lot.
(D) If the lot does not undergo an urban lot split: Expressly requires
the individual property owners to live in one of the dwelling units
on the lot as the owners’ primary residence and legal domicile.
(E) Limits development of the lot to residential units that comply with
the requirements of this section, except as required by State law.
(f) Specific
adverse impacts.
(1) Notwithstanding anything else in this section, the City may deny
an application for a two-unit project if the building official makes
a written finding, based on a preponderance of the evidence, that
the project would have a “specific, adverse impact” on
either public health and safety or on the physical environment and
for which there is no feasible method to satisfactorily mitigate or
avoid the specific adverse impact.
(2) "Specific adverse impact" has the same meaning as in
Government Code
Section 65589.5(d)(2): “a significant, quantifiable, direct,
and unavoidable impact, based on objective, identified written public
health or safety standards, policies, or conditions as they existed
on the date the application was deemed complete” and does not
include: (1) inconsistency with the zoning ordinance or General Plan
land use designation; or (2) the eligibility to claim a welfare exemption
under
Revenue and Taxation Code Section 214(g).
(3) The building official may consult with and be assisted by planning
staff and others as necessary in making a finding of specific, adverse
impact.
(g) Remedies.
If a two-unit project violates any part of this Code or any other
legal requirement:
(1) The buyer, grantee, or lessee of any part of the property has an
action for damages or to void the deed, sale, or contract.
(2) The City may:
(A) Bring an action to enjoin any attempt to sell, lease, or finance
the property.
(B) Bring an action for other legal, equitable, or summary remedy, such
as declaratory and injunctive relief.
(C) Pursue criminal prosecution, punishable by imprisonment in County
Jail or State prison for up to one year, by a fine of up to $10,000,
or both; or a misdemeanor.
(D) Record a notice of violation.
(E) Withhold any or all future permits and approvals.
(F) Pursue all other administrative, legal, or equitable remedies that
are allowed by law or the City’s Code.
(Ord. No. 1094, § 4, 2021; Ord. No. 1100, § 4, 2022)
(a) Title.
This section shall be known as “The Sand, Gravel, and Mineral
Extraction Law of the City of San Juan Capistrano.”
(b) Purpose.
This section is adopted to safeguard life, limb, property, and the
public welfare by establishing minimum safety standards for the maintenance
of pits and the mining, quarrying, or commercial extraction of sand,
gravel, rock, aggregate, clay, or similar materials within the City
and to establish procedures pursuant to which such standards shall
be enforced.
(c) Scope.
All pits and operations used for mining, quarrying, or the commercial
extraction of sand, gravel, rock, aggregate, clay, or similar materials
within the City shall be maintained and conducted in compliance with
the provisions of this section, except for the following:
(1) Excavation operations incidental to the development of property in
which a specified quantity of material is to be removed to a predetermined
elevation so that, upon completion, the site will be left suitable
for development and for which a valid grading permit is in force.
Such exception, however, shall not apply to any such excavation operation
which reasonably cannot be completed or is not completed within one
year after the date of commencement; and
(2) The commercial processing or storage of sand, gravel, rock, aggregate,
clay, or similar materials where no extraction or excavation operation,
other than one regulated by a currently valid grading permit, is conducted
on the site.
(d) Permits—Required.
No person shall maintain a pit or commence or perform any operation
or activity within the scope of this section without first obtaining
the following appropriate permits to do so:
(1) Abandonment permit. Upon an application to the Director of Engineering
and Building Services by the owner or his legally authorized agent,
an abandonment permit shall be issued for any pit from which no extraction
operation has been conducted since July 5, 1978, provided the pit
is found to comply with the provisions of subsection (o) of this section.
No fee shall be charged for an abandonment permit.
(2) Extraction permit. No person shall maintain a pit from which materials
have been extracted since July 5, 1978, or perform any extraction
operation or activity without first obtaining an extraction permit.
An extraction permit may be issued by the Director of Building
and Engineering for the maintenance of pits from which no materials
have been extracted since July 5, 1978, provided the pit is found
to comply with the provisions of subsection (o) or (p) of this section
and all the other applicable requirements of this section have been
met.
(3) Grading permit for the repair of sand and gravel sites. Except as
provided in subsection (h) of this section, repair work required in
order to bring a pit into compliance with the provisions of subsection
(o) of this section shall be accomplished only after a grading permit
for the repair of the sand and gravel site has been obtained, and
the work shall be performed in compliance with the terms of such permit.
The Director of Engineering and Building Services may waive
the provisions of this section relating to permit procedures as he
deems appropriate.
(e) Permits—Applications,
filing, accompanying data required. An application for a permit, signed
by the owner or his legally authorized agent, shall be filed with
the Department of Engineering and Building Services upon forms provided
by said Department. The application shall be accompanied by a description
of the site and such fees, plans, reports, and engineering data as
determined by the Director of Engineering and Building Services.
(f) Permits—Approval
and inspections. Prior to the approval of any plan required by the
provisions of this section or the issuance of a permit, the Director
of Engineering and Building Services may inspect the site to determine
that such plans, reports, or other data are accurate and sufficient.
(g) Permits—Issuance
and conformity with plans. Upon the issuance of a permit, the plans
submitted by the applicant as required by the Director of Engineering
and Building Services shall be approved and so stamped by the Department
of Engineering and Building Services. The pit and all work pertinent
thereto shall be maintained in conformity with the approved plans,
unless authorization to modify the pit or operation is obtained from
the Director of Engineering and Building Services, and the plans and
records are so changed and noted.
(h) Permits—Term.
Each extraction permit issued for an existing or proposed operation
shall continue in effect only as long as none of the provisions of
this section is violated and as long as the annual permit fees have
been paid.
The extraction permit shall expire on July 1, unless the annual permit and inspection fees for the subsequent fiscal year have been paid by such date. No operation, other than such corrective work as may be designated by the Director of Engineering and Building Services, shall be conducted after July 1, unless a new permit has been approved by the Director of Engineering and Building Services. In the case of existing pits, such corrective work shall include compliance with all the provisions of subsection
(o) of this section.
(i) Permits—Renewal.
Any extraction permit which has expired or been revoked may be renewed
by making an application to the Department of Building and Safety
and upon the following conditions:
(1) The submission of an application, up-to-date plans, reports, and
the other data required by this section or required by the Director
of Engineering and Building Services;
(2) The site shall be in compliance with all the applicable provisions
of this section; and
(3) The payment of the fees required by Section
9-5.101 Fees, Deposits, and Bonds.
(j) Permits—Revocation. The Director of Engineering and Building Services may revoke any permit, in whole or in part, after notification and demand as set forth in subsection
(m) of this section if any of the following conditions exists:
(1) The pit or work covered by such permit has been materially extended
beyond the limits of the permit;
(2) Any fence or wall or other protective device required by the provisions
of this section has not been constructed or maintained in good repair;
or
(3) Other provisions of this section have been violated by the operator,
owner, or permittee.
(k) Permits—Limitations.
The issuance, granting, or renewal of a permit shall not be deemed
or construed to be a permit for, or an approval of, any violation
of the provisions of this section or any other law. No such permit,
presuming to give authority to violate or cancel the provisions of
this section shall be valid, except insofar as the work or use which
is authorized by the issuance, granting, or renewal of such permit
is lawful.
(l) Conditional use permits. All uses pertaining to the mining, quarrying, or commercial extraction of sand, gravel, rock, aggregate, clay, or similar materials on private property in the City shall require a conditional use permit, pursuant to Section
9-2.317 Conditional Use Permit.
(m) Inspections. The Director of Engineering and Building Services shall inspect each site regulated by the provisions of this section at the time of the payment of the annual fees required by Section
9-5.101 Fees, Deposits, and Bonds, and at such other times as he deems necessary, for the purpose of ascertaining whether the operations are being conducted and the site maintained in conformity with the minimum standards of this section and the applicable permits.
Whenever the Director of Engineering and Building Services determines
that the work does not comply with the terms of the permit or the
requirements of this section, or that the soil or other conditions
are not as set forth on the permit, he shall notify the permittee
of such fact in writing, demanding compliance within 30 days after
the date of such notice. If the permittee, within the stated time,
has not complied with the terms of the permit or the requirements
of this section, or given reasonable assurances that steps are being
taken to so comply, the Director of Engineering and Building Services
may order the cessation of all work, or any portion thereof, and such
work shall cease until the requirements of the permit and this section
have been met.
(n) Abandonment—Notices
and inspections. Whenever a pit or excavation operation is to be abandoned,
the operator shall notify the Director of Engineering and Building
Services in writing of his intention to abandon the pit or operation
at least 30 days prior to such abandonment.
The Director of Engineering and Building Services shall inspect the site prior to the date of the proposed abandonment and notify the operator of what protective devices or structures and what corrective measures are or may be necessary for the protection of adjacent properties and the general public as set forth in subsection
(o) of this section. The Director of Engineering and Building Services shall also notify the property owner and the operator what assurance, if any, the Director of Engineering and Building Services requires for the continued maintenance of the protective devices and the future correction of possible unsafe conditions as may occur.
Within 30 days after the abandonment of the pit or operation, the Director of Engineering and Building Services shall again inspect the site for compliance with the provisions of subsection
(o) of this section and notify both the property owner and the operator of his findings.
Whenever the Director of Engineering and Building Services determines that the site has been abandoned in accordance with the provisions of subsection
(o) of this section, he shall so note on the permit.
(o) Standards—Inoperative
operations. Each pit not currently in use for commercial extraction
operations shall be maintained in accordance with the following minimum
standards:
(1) Setbacks and slopes.
(A) The finished perimeter slope shall not be steeper than two feet horizontal
to one foot vertical projecting into the pit from a 50 foot setback
adjacent to the perimeter of the property.
(B) In addition, where the Director of Engineering and Building Services determines there is a possibility of potentially hazardous seepage or flow into a pit from a flood control channel, reservoir, conservation or flood retarding basin, or natural watercourse, the Director of Engineering and Building Services shall establish the setback and slope requirements based on the preservation of the integrity of the existing flood control channel, reservoir, conservation or flood retarding basin, or natural watercourse so that the subject property shall continue to receive and carry off waters in a manner equal to that experienced prior to any excavation. In the discretion of the Director of Engineering and Building Services, the setback requirements imposed pursuant to this subsection may exceed the 50 foot requirement set forth in subsection
(A) of this subsection, but such setbacks may not be less than 50 feet as set forth in subsection
(A) of this subsection. In the discretion of the Director of Engineering and Building Services, the slope requirements may be greater or less than that set forth in subsection
(A) of this subsection. The applicant may be required to furnish reports and engineering data, as required by the Director of Engineering and Building Services, to justify the setback and slope requirements requested in such cases. The Director of Engineering and Building Services may require such reports in any case.
(C) Where the Director of Engineering and Building Services determines
that the pit extends below, or in the future may extend below, groundwater
elevations, the slopes shall not be steeper than the safe values determined
by the Director of Engineering and Building Services, based on the
reports required as part of the permit application, which reports
may be required by the Director of Engineering and Building Services
in such cases.
(D) The provisions of this subsection may be modified by the Director
of Engineering and Building Services in cases where safety conditions
and engineering and geological data submitted to the Director of Engineering
and Building Services for approval indicate that a less restrictive
setback or slope may be permitted.
(2) Diversions. No pit shall be maintained in or adjacent to the floodplain
of any watercourse which, by reason of the shape, location, berm elevations,
or area of the excavation in the opinion of the Director of Engineering
and Building Services, is likely to produce a diversion of the natural
watercourse away from the pit and outside the natural watercourse
in the event flow from the watercourse enters the excavation.
(3) Drainage. Adequate provisions for the conveyance of water across
and from the site and for the long-term retention of water shall be
accomplished so as to minimize potential dangers from landslides and
erosion.
(4) Fencing. Other than in cases where data is submitted to the Director
of Engineering and Building Services for approval and which data indicate
to the Director of Engineering and Building Services that no safety
hazards exist, a fence shall be constructed enclosing the area of
each existing pit. Such fence shall be chain link, of steel, and a
minimum of six feet in height above the existing grade of the property
outside the fenced area. The bottom of such fence shall conform to
the ground surface so as to prevent any opening between it and the
ground surface exceeding four inches.
Gates of the same material and height as the fence shall be
installed at all points of vehicular or pedestrian ingress and egress.
Such gates shall be equipped with keyed locks and shall be kept locked
at all times when not in regular use.
Such fences, gates, and locks shall be maintained in good condition
and repair.
(5) Protective devices - Correction and repair. Whenever the Director of Engineering and Building Services determines that the maintenance of protective devices or structures or the correction of potentially unsafe conditions may be necessary for the protection of adjacent properties and the general public, he shall notify in writing the owner or other responsible persons, who shall take such corrective action as necessary and post a surety bond or other financial security in an amount sufficient to insure the continued maintenance of the protective devices for such potentially unsafe conditions. A grading permit shall be required for any repair work. The fees for such permit shall be as set forth in Chapter 1 of Title
8 of this Municipal Code for grading operations.
(p) Standards—Active
operations. The mining; quarrying, and commercial extraction of sand,
gravel, rock, aggregate, clay, or similar materials shall be performed
in accordance with the following minimum standards:
(1) Setbacks.
(A) No excavation activity shall be carried on within 50 feet of the
following:
(i)
The common property line of any parcel of land not used for
the same purpose; or
(ii)
The ultimate right-of-way of any public street, either existing
or whose precise alignment has been adopted by the County or the City.
(B) In addition, where the Director of Engineering and Building Services
determines there is a possibility of potentially hazardous seepage
or flow into a pit from a flood control channel, reservoir, conservation
or flood retarding basin, or natural watercourse, the Director of
Engineering and Building Services shall establish the setback requirements
based on the preservation of the integrity of the existing flood control
channel, reservoir, conservation or flood retarding basin, or natural
watercourse so that the subject property shall continue to receive
and carry off waters in a manner equal to that experienced prior to
any excavation.
(C) At the discretion of the Director of Engineering and Building Services, the setback requirements imposed pursuant to this subsection may exceed the 50 foot requirement set forth in subsection
(A) of this subsection, but such setbacks may not be less than 50 feet, as set forth in subsection (1) of subsection (o) of this section. The applicant may be required to furnish reports and engineering data, as set forth in subsection (e) of this section, to justify the setback requirements requested in such cases. The Director of Engineering and Building Services may require such reports in any case.
(2) Slopes.
(A) Where the Director of Engineering and Building Services determines there is a potentially hazardous seepage into a pit from a flood control channel, reservoir, conservation or flood retarding basin, or natural watercourse, or where the Director of Engineering and Building Services determines that the pit extends below, or in the future may extend below, groundwater elevations, the finished perimeter slope shall not be steeper than two and one-half (2 1/2) feet horizontal to one foot vertical, except as provided in subsection
(C) of this subsection.
(B) The finished perimeter slope shall not be steeper than two feet horizontal
to one foot vertical projecting into the pit from the required setback
line adjacent to the perimeter of the property.
(C) Notwithstanding subsections
(A) and
(B) of this subsection, the slope requirement may be modified by the Director of Engineering and Building Services in cases where the Director of Engineering and Building Services determines that the proposed excavation operations present a potential hazard to adjacent property or where other safety conditions and engineering or geological data, as set forth in subsection (e) of this section, submitted to the Director of Engineering and Building Services for approval, or as may be required by him, indicate that less restrictive slopes may be permitted or more restrictive slopes may be required.
(3) Diversions. No excavation shall be made or pit maintained in or adjacent
to the floodplain of any watercourse which, by reason of the shape,
location, berm elevations, or area of the excavation or pit in the
opinion of the Director of Engineering and Building Services, is likely
to produce a diversion of a natural watercourse away from the pit
and outside the natural watercourse in the event flow from the watercourse
enters the excavation.
(4) Drainage. Adequate provisions for the conveyance of water across
and from the site and for the long-term retention of water shall be
accomplished in a manner meeting the approval of the Director of Engineering
and Building Services so as to minimize potential dangers from landslides
and erosion.
(5) Fencing. Prior to the commencement or continuation of any excavation
or extraction operation or the construction or use of any settling
basin, a fence shall be constructed enclosing the area of such proposed
or existing excavation or settling basin, or the entire site, other
than in cases where data are submitted to the Director of Engineering
and Building Services for approval and which data indicate to the
Director of Engineering and Building Services that no substantial
safety hazard exists. Such fence shall be chain link, of steel, and
a minimum of six feet in height above the existing grade of the property
outside the fenced area. The bottom of such fence shall conform to
the ground surface so as to prevent any opening between it and the
ground surface exceeding four inches.
Gates of the same material and height as the fence shall be
installed at all points of vehicular or pedestrian ingress and egress.
Such gates shall be equipped with keyed locks and shall be kept locked
at all times when not in regular use.
Such fences, gates, and locks shall be maintained in good condition
and repair.
(6) Boundary markers. The site shall be surveyed by a registered civil
engineer or licensed surveyor and shall be defined by a series of
poles (two and one-half (2 1/2) inch pipe), six feet in height, measured
from the ground level and painted a bright color, which poles shall
be installed and maintained at each change of direction and along
the entire length of the subject site in such a manner that an individual
standing at one such pole can clearly see the next pole in either
direction.
For good cause shown, the Director of Engineering and Building
Services may waive or modify the provisions of this subsection for
any extraction operation proposed to result in finished elevations
which are not below the average natural ground elevations at the perimeter
of the site or for any extraction operation proposed to be located
more than 1,000 feet from any property line.
(7) Signs. Within 90 days after a permit has been issued pursuant to
the provisions of this section, the outer boundaries of the site shall
be continuously posted with signs not less than 500 feet apart and
at each change of direction of such boundary lines in such a manner
as will reasonably give notice to passersby of the matters contained
in such signs, stating in letters not less than four inches in height,
“Public Notice,” and stating in letters not less than
one inch in height: “This Property May Be Used for the Mining,
Quarrying, or Commercial Extraction of Sand, Gravel, Rock, Aggregate,
Clay, and Similar Materials Subject to Permits Which Have Been Issued
by the Director of Engineering and Building Services, City of San
Juan Capistrano.” Such signs shall be of wood or metal and shall
be maintained in legible condition at all times.
(8) Ingress, egress, and traffic safety. Roads providing vehicular access
to public highways which are used for transporting materials shall
be located only at points designated on plans as approved by the Department
of Engineering and Building Services. Adequate sight distance shall
be maintained for traffic safety. A distance of not less than 80 feet
from the intersection of the drive or access road with the right-of-way
line of the public highway shall be paved for a width of not less
than 12 feet.
In addition, that portion of the access road lying between the
right-of-way line and the existing pavement of the public highway
shall be constructed in accordance with the terms of an encroachment
permit issued by the Department of Engineering and Building Services
or, in the case of State highways, issued by the California Department
of Transportation.
(q) Responsibility.
The permittee, operator, and property owner, and their authorized
agents, and any other person in control of property used for mining,
quarrying, and commercial extraction operations pursuant to the provisions
of this section, individually and collectively, shall be responsible
for the observation and compliance with all the provisions of this
section. Such responsibility shall include the correction of any unsafe
condition and the construction and continued maintenance of all fences
and other protective devices required by the provisions of this section
or as deemed necessary by the Director of Engineering and Building
Services to protect the general public and adjacent properties.
In the event the owner or other responsible person shall fail, neglect, or refuse to perform the required corrections, maintenance, or repairs within the time set forth in subsection
(m) of this section after being notified in writing to do so by the Director of Engineering and Building Services, the Director of Engineering and Building Services shall cause the required corrections, repairs, or maintenance to be done, and the cost thereof shall be a charge and expense against the owner and the land.
(r) Enforcement. The Director of Engineering and Building Services shall enforce the provisions of this section. If at any time the Director of Engineering and Building Services finds that any owner, permittee, or operator is violating any provision of this section, the Director of Engineering and Building Services may order compliance in the manner set forth in subsection
(m) of this section. If compliance does not proceed, the Director of Engineering and Building Services, at the end of 30 days, or in the absence of reasonable assurance given as set forth in said subsection
(m) of this section, may order the immediate cessation of operations.
If, in the opinion of the Director of Engineering and Building Services, an immediate and substantial hazard exists to adjacent property or the general public, the Director of Engineering and Building Services may order the immediate cessation of that portion of the operation which may contribute to such a hazard within the 30 day period set forth in said subsection
(m) of this section, and which cessation shall continue until the correction of the hazardous condition.
(s) Appeals. The operator, permittee, or owner shall have the right to appeal determinations of the Director of Engineering and Building Services pursuant to Section
9-2.311 Appeals.
(t) Definitions.
For the purposes of this section, unless otherwise apparent from the
context, certain words and phrases used in this section are defined
as follows:
"Abandonment"
means the cessation of mining, quarrying, and extraction
operations on the site in compliance with the provisions of this section.
"Operator"
means the person, whether a proprietor, lessee, or independent
contractor, actually in charge and in control of the pit or operation
being conducted upon the site.
"Owner"
means a person who owns a site upon which a pit is located
or upon which mining, quarrying, or commercial extraction operations
are being conducted or may be conducted.
"Site"
means a lot or parcel of land, or a series of contiguous
or adjacent lots or parcels of land, described by a lease or similar
document upon which a pit is located or upon which commercial extraction
operations are being or may be conducted, and which site is covered
by a permit.
"Slope"
means the exposed surface of an excavation or fill which
forms an incline.
"Ultimate right-of way"
means the right-of way shown as ultimate on an adopted precise
plan of highway alignment, or a street right-of-way shown within the
boundary of a recorded tract map, a recorded parcel map, or a recorded
Planned Community (PC) development plan. The latest adopted or recorded
document in such cases shall take precedence. If none exists, the
ultimate right-of-way shall be considered to be the right-of-way required
by the highway classification as shown on the Master Plan of Arterial
Highways. In all other instances, the ultimate right-of-way shall
be considered to be the existing right-of-way, in the case of a private
street, and the existing right-of-way, but not less than 60 feet,
in the case of a public street.
(Ord. No. 869, § 2)
(a) Intent
and purpose. Service stations warrant special attention in this Code
because they constitute a use attracting vehicular patronage exclusively.
The exposed nature of the activity, distinctive physical appearance
and long hours of operation necessitate special requirements to insure
compatibility with the City General Plan as it relates to aesthetic
and visual aspects.
(b) Locational
criteria. Service stations and fuel dispensing stations shall not
be located in the Town Center (TC), Town Center Edge (TCE), and General
Commercial (GC) Districts bounded by Interstate 5 on the east, San
Juan Creek on the south, Trabuco Creek on the west and La Zanja Street
on the north.
(c) Development
standards. The following development standards are the minimum standards
with which service stations and accessory uses shall be evaluated:
(1) Dispensing islands location. Service stations located on a corner
lot shall locate the service buildings to the front of the site, with
the dispensing islands located behind the building, to visually screen
the islands from the adjacent roadways.
(2) Project identification signs. All project identification signs shall conform to the design regulations as set forth in Section
9-3.543 Signs.
(3) Price sign identification. In accordance with Section 13531 of the
Business and Professions Code of the State, service stations shall
post all prices charged for the purchase of vehicle fuels. Such signs
shall conform to said Section 13531, subject to the following design
regulations:
(A) Pricing categories. Individual pricing signs shall identify the price
of all grades of gasoline and diesel fuels sold on the premises, including
any differential between “self-service” and “full-service”
and whether the price is cash or credit.
(B) Advertising media. All letters, figures, or numerals used on signs
designating the price of gasoline or motor fuels shall be a minimum
of six inches and a maximum of nine inches in height. All letters
or numerals designating the grade of gasoline or motor fuels shall
not be less than one-sixth the size of the numerals designating the
price. Such letters shall have a medium or heavy type face or stroke
and shall be plainly visible. The colors of the letters shall contrast
to the sign background so as to be easily readable.
(C) Sign location and size. Price identification signs shall be of a monument design with a maximum height of eight feet with a sign face not exceeding 32 square feet. Only one sign per street frontage shall be permitted. The location of the sign shall be approved by the Planning Director and shall not conflict with the vehicular sight distance requirements of Section
9-3.559 Visibility at Intersections/Driveways.
(D) Architectural style and color. The City encourages the design and
location of such signs to be in harmony with the architectural style
of the building on the premises. The use of earth-tone mission colors
shall be encouraged. Examples of such colors include, but are not
limited to, browns, pale yellows, tan, beige, and similar shades.
The use of an adopted lettering style or color scheme for an individual company may be permitted consistent with the provision of Section
9-3.543 Signs.
(4) Required signs by governmental agencies. Signs required to be placed
at a service station, including, but not limited to, “No Smoking,”
“Licensed Inspections and Adjustments,” and similar identification
mandated by a governmental agency and not otherwise provided for in
this section, shall be permitted.
(5) Pump island signs. Signs designating operation instructions, self-serve
and full-serve islands, or similar information designed for customer
convenience, provided the cumulative signage does not exceed 10 square
feet per island, shall be permitted.
(6) Window signs. Temporary window signs may be permitted provided they
do not exceed 25% of the window area and do not advertise merchandise
for which an alternate method of signage is permitted by this section
or other applicable provisions of this article.
(7) Prohibited signs. All temporary signs not permitted by this section or Section
9-3.547 Special activities, shall be prohibited.
(8) Parking. The size, arrangement, and access of all parking areas shall conform to Section
9-3.535 Parking. All vehicles, except those within the main structure of the service station or those being serviced at the pump islands, shall be parked within the designated parking spaces.
(9) Outside activities. Activities conducted outside the permanent structure
shall be limited to the dispensing of gasoline, diesel fuel, oil,
air, water, and minor repairs, such as the replacement of fan belts,
light bulbs, wiper blades, batteries, and tire changes. All repair
activities shall be confined to a designated area on the site as approved
by the City.
(10) Outside storage of motor vehicles. The outside storage of motor vehicles
shall be strictly prohibited. For the purposes of this section, “outside
storage” shall mean the parking of a motor vehicle outside the
main structure of the service station for a period in excess of 24
hours, unless such vehicle is in the process of being serviced, in
which case it may be parked outside the main structure for a period
not exceeding seven days and located in a designated parking space.
Such vehicles shall be stored in such a condition that all exterior
components of the vehicle are in place (i.e., tires, doors, hoods,
fenders, and the like).
(11) Accessory uses. The following accessory uses shall be permitted:
(A) Vending machines. Vending machines shall be either placed within
the main building or in a designated area immediately adjacent to
the building provided the area does not exceed 40 square feet.
(B) Merchandise displays. All merchandise shall be stored and/or displayed within the permanent building, with the exception of accessory and lubrication items, such as oil, wiper blades, and the like, which are normally kept on pump islands, in which case they shall be located in a specially designed case enclosure. The outside display of any other merchandise shall be prohibited. Except during those occasions when a special activity permit has been issued as set forth in Section
9-3.547 Special activities.
(C) Accessory uses not listed. The Planning Director may approve accessory
uses not listed in this subsection (10) if such uses will not be detrimental
to the safety and welfare of adjacent uses or potential patrons of
the service station.
(12) Landscaping. Landscaping, including boundaries, streetscapes, and
buildings, shall be approved during the development review.
(13) Drainage. Drainage resulting from the development of service and
fuel dispensing stations shall meet all NPDES (National Pollutant
Discharge Elimination System) and BMPs (Best Management Practices)
requirements.
(Ord. No. 869, § 2; Ord. No. 1082, § 16, 2021)
(a) General
provisions. The following general provisions shall apply pertaining
to title, scope, definitions, and purpose and intent.
(1) Title. This chapter shall be known and cited as the “Sign Ordinance
for the City of San Juan Capistrano.”
(2) Scope. It is unlawful for any person to construct, maintain, display
or alter or cause to be constructed, maintained, displayed or altered,
a sign within the City except in conformance with this chapter.
(3) Definitions. Sign definitions are set forth in Appendix A of the
San Juan Capistrano Municipal Code.
(4) Purpose and intent. The City Council finds and declares:
(A) The City of San Juan Capistrano is a community of natural beauty,
distinct and notable architecture and historic tradition. Signs have
a strong visual impact on the character and quality of the community
as they are a prominent part of the scenery, attract or repel the
viewing public, and set the tone of neighborhoods and districts.
(B) The City relies on its scenic beauty to invite tourism and commerce
and aesthetic considerations that promote economic value. The primary
purpose of signs is proper business and directional identification
for the public. It is the intent of the City to limit the size, type,
and location of signs in order to minimize their distracting effect
on pedestrians and motorists and not subject citizens or guests to
excessive competition for their visual attention, It is also the intent
of the City to encourage creativity, high quality and superior design
in all signs.
(C) The Community Design Element of the General Plan sets forth goals
and policies to ensure that the design of this community be of the
highest quality, and that accessory facilities, including signs, be
compatible with the overall theme, and do not create a visual blight
that detracts from the quality of the environment and an individual’s
perception of the City.
(D) The procedures and standards set forth in this sign code are intended
to:
(i)
Ensure that signs erected within the City are compatible with
their surroundings and are in keeping with the goals and policies
of the Community Design Element of the General Plan;
(ii)
Generally provide for the identification of business enterprises
and shall not be used for general advertising purposes;
(iii)
Promote traffic safety and community identity while also enhancing
the quality of the visual environment in the City;
(iv)
Establish procedures and design regulations which control the
location, size, type, and number of signs which may be permitted;
(v)
Promote harmony with the building architecture;
(vi)
Be appropriate for the neighborhood character;
(vii)
Protect those uses which are adequately and appropriately identified
from too many and too large signs;
(viii)
Protect commercial districts from sign clutter;
(ix)
Assure the proper maintenance of signs.
(b) General
requirements. The following requirements pertaining to design criteria,
sign copy, acceptable materials, unacceptable materials, logos/trademarks,
illumination, calculating area and height, and noncommercial signs
shall apply to all signs, including signs that are exempt from the
permit requirement, within the City.
(1) Design criteria. The design and placement of signs shall comply with
the specific design standards set forth in this section, the City’s
adopted Architectural Design Guidelines and the Community Design Element
of the General Plan, including, but not limited to, standards relating
to sign visibility, legibility and readability.
(2) Commercial sign copy. The text or copy of signs may identify the
name, and/or location, and/or address, and/or nature of the business
or center. Sign copy shall not include general advertising.
(3) Acceptable sign materials and methods of construction. The following
sign materials and methods of construction are acceptable and desirable:
(A) High quality hand carved, sandblasted, painted or routed wood;
(B) High quality metal letters;
(C) Painted or sandblasted ceramic tile;
(D) Painted stucco or similar background;
(E) Wrought iron with painted or stained backgrounds and lettering;
(F) Flush or insert mounted signs of tile or stone;
(G) Sign style, including any proposed illumination, shall be compatible
with the buildings architecture and age/period;
(K) Other materials that provide the same finish appearance as materials
listed in this subsection and subject to City approval.
(4) Unacceptable sign materials and methods of construction. The following
materials are unacceptable and prohibited:
(B) Exposed spot lights, exterior neon tubing, and exposed electrical
conduits;
(C) Canvas materials (except awnings);
(D) Painted plywood background;
(E) Other materials that provide the same finish appearance as the materials
listed in this subsection.
(5) Trademarks. The use of a company adopted or registered trademark
may be permitted only if the size and location will not be in substantial
conflict with the architectural design of the building and/or the
approved sign or sign program lettering style and colors.
(6) Illumination. The illumination of sign copy shall be limited as follows:
(A) External illumination. External illumination where the sign copy
is either illuminated by an external light source that illuminates
the sign copy or by backlighting where the illumination of the sign
is from a light source internal to the sign copy (letters) and where
the light is projected onto the wall surface upon which the sign is
attached. External light sources are to be integrated into the architectural
or landscape features of a project such that it is not generally visible
to the general public from the public right-of-way. External illuminated
signs shall have subdued lighting. The use of halogen as a light source
shall be prohibited.
(B) Internal illumination. Sign copy may use internal illumination where
the specific sign copy lettering uses translucent material and the
only portion of the sign copy that is illuminated is limited to the
actual lettering and/or a company adopted or registered trademark
or logo. Internal illumination in the TC (Town Center) and TCE (Town
Center Edge) zones requires approval of the Community Development
Director who may refer to the Design Review Committee and/or Planning
Commission for approval.
(C) Lighting intensity. Lighting shall be subdued and provide the minimum
intensity for reading the sign at any given time. Lighting on signs
between sunset and sunrise may be required to include ambient light
monitors to limit or adjust brightness, timers to turn off sign lighting,
or certification for sign specifications by the sign manufacturer
or contractor. Controlling and monitoring lighting intensity shall
be subject to review of the Community Development Director who may
refer to the Design Review Committee and/or Planning Commission.
(7) Calculating sign area and sign height. Calculations for sign area
and height of specific signs shall be as set forth below.
(A) Generally. Unless otherwise noted in this section, the sign area
and sign height shall be calculated as provided below.
(i)
Sign area.
a.
The sign area shall be determined by drawing a rectangular box,
four sides connected by four right angles, around the periphery of
the sign face and calculating the area of the rectangular box. The
area of the rectangular box will be equal to the sign face’s
greatest height multiplied by the sign face’s greatest width,
as shown in Figure 3-7.
b.
For a double-faced sign, aggregate area of both faces count
towards the sign area.
(ii)
Sign height. The sign height shall be measured from the topmost
edge of the sign face to the finished grade at the base of the sign.
(B) Freestanding monument signs. For a freestanding monument sign, the
sign area and sign height shall be calculated as provided below.
(i)
Sign area. The sign area of a free standing monument sign shall
be calculated based on the sign copy area.
a.
The sign copy area is determined by drawing a rectangular box,
four sides connected by four right angles, around each individual
word, number, or image of the sign copy, and calculating the aggregate
area of the rectangular boxes, as shown in Figure 3-5.
b.
If the copy area includes upper-case and lower-case letters,
then the sign copy area is determined by boxing around individual
letter ascenders and descenders for each individual word of the sign
copy, and calculating the aggregate area of the boxes, as shown in
Figure 3-6.
c.
For a freestanding monument sign that is double-sided, a sign
area limit applies to each face individually, not in the aggregate.
(ii)
Sign height. The sign height of a free standing monument sign
shall be measured from the topmost edge of the sign face to the finished
grade at the base of the sign, as shown in Figures 3-5.
Figure 3-5. Freestanding Monument Sign
|
(C) Building-mounted signs, flush. For a building-mounted sign that is
flush against the building, the sign area and sign height shall be
calculated as provided below:
(i)
Sign area. The sign area of a building-mounted sign that is
flush against the building shall be calculated based on the sign copy
area.
a.
The sign copy area is determined by drawing a rectangular box,
four sides connected by four right angles, around each individual
word, number, or image of the sign copy, and calculating the aggregate
area of the rectangular boxes, as shown in Figures 3-5 and 3-6.
b.
If the copy area includes upper-case and lower-case letters,
then the sign copy area is determined by boxing around individual
letter ascenders and descenders for each individual word of the sign
copy, and calculating the aggregate area of the boxes, as shown in
Figure 3-6.
(ii)
Sign height. The sign height of a building-mounted sign that
is flush against the building shall be measured from the topmost edge
of the topmost letter to the finished grade at the base of the building
wall, as shown in Figure 3-6.
Figure 3-6. Building-Mounted Signs (Flush)
|
(D) Building-mounted signs, projecting. For a building-mounted sign that
is projecting from the building, the sign area and sign height shall
be calculated as provided below:
(i)
Sign area.
a.
The sign area shall be determined by drawing a rectangular box,
four sides connected by four right angles, around the periphery of
the sign face and calculating the area of the rectangular box. The
area of the rectangular box will be equal to the sign face’s
greatest height multiplied by the sign face’s greatest width,
as shown in Figure 3-7.
b.
For a building-mounted sign that is projecting from the building
and is double-faced, the aggregate area of both faces count towards
the sign area.
(ii)
Sign height. The sign height of a building-mounted sign that
is projecting from the building shall be measured from the topmost
edge of the sign face to the finished grade at the base of the sign.
Figure 3-7. Building-Mounted Signs (Projecting)
|
(8) Noncommercial signs. Notwithstanding any other provision of this
Article, noncommercial signs are allowed in all zoning districts and
may be substituted for any sign expressly allowed. Noncommercial signs
are subject to the same standards and total maximum allowances per
site or building of each sign type specified in this section.
(9) Placement. Signs shall not be posted, placed or displayed in a manner
that creates a safety hazard, including, but not limited to, by obstructing
the flow of vehicular, bicycle or pedestrian traffic or the visibility
of vehicular, bicycle or pedestrian traffic, street signs, signals,
or emergency equipment.
(c) Sign permit required. Unless specifically exempted by subsection
(f) of this section, it is unlawful for any person to erect, alter or relocate any sign within the City, or to direct or authorize another person to do so, except pursuant to a sign permit. Review procedures for sign permits are set forth in Section
9-2.343(b). No permit shall be required for repainting, cleaning, or other normal maintenance and repair of a sign unless the structure, design, color or character is altered.
(d) Sign programs. A sign program shall be included in the application for review of any discretionary entitlement that proposes new nonresidential office, commercial, service, industrial, and developments with outdoor display and sales. Automobile dealerships may submit sign programs at its [their] discretion. Review procedures for sign programs are set forth in Section
9-2.343(c).
(e) Prohibited
signs. In addition to any sign not conforming to the provisions of
this chapter, the following signs are prohibited:
(1) Signs mounted on or above roofs;
(2) Signs which incorporate moving, flashing or vibrating components,
smoke intermittent lighting or other similar attractive characteristics,
including signs manipulated by individuals. This prohibition does
not include non-commercial signs that are carried, but not otherwise
manipulated by individuals;
(3) Signs in public right-of-way, except as authorized pursuant to Title
7, Chapter
9, “Temporary Signs”;
(4) Signs which are placed on or written on a vehicle providing direction
where the vehicle is parked in such a way as to promote or advertise,
whether on public or private property;
(5) Off-site signs except directional signs or signs that have been permitted
by the Planning Commission pursuant to an approved sign program;
(6) Billboards and mobile billboards;
(7) Flags, streamers, pennants and other similar attraction devices except as permitted under Section
9-3.547(b)(4)9-3.547(b)(4), Special activity permits for car dealers;
(8) Balloons and any inflatable signs;
(9) Signs which are installed on any public utility installation, utility
pole, or tree on public or private property;
(10) Signs which resemble or conflict with any traffic control devices
or interfere with the flow of traffic;
(11) Signs which create a safety hazard by obstructing the clear view of pedestrian or vehicular traffic per Section
9-3.559, Visibility at intersections/driveways;
(12) Exposed neon signs exceeding four square feet in area;
(13) Spot lights and search lights, except as part of an approved community
event or as approved by the Community Development Director;
(14) Any sign placed or maintained that interferes with free ingress or
egress from any door, walkway, window or fire escape;
(15) Signs erected on public or private property without the permission
of the property owner;
(16) Signs visible from the public street or parking lot attached to or
placed on merchandise or materials stored or displayed outdoors except
for parking lot sales;
(17) Any sign displaying obscene, indecent or immoral matter as defined
in the California
Penal Code;
(18) Signs on awnings or canopies, except on the valance;
(19) Any signs that are tacked, nailed, posted, pasted, glued or otherwise
affixed to trees, poles, stakes, fences or the exterior of a building
or other structure, unless otherwise expressly allowed by this Code;
(f) Signs exempt from a permit. The following signs shall be allowed without a sign permit and shall not be included in the determination of type, number or area of signs allowed on a building or parcel except as otherwise specified below. These signs, however, are subject to the general design standards outlined in this section, as well as any additional standards set forth in this subsection
(f).
(1) Flags. A maximum of one flag each, not exceeding 40 square feet in
area per flag for nonresidential zones and 24 square feet for residential
zones.
(2) Temporary noncommercial signs.
(A) General design standards.
(i)
Area per sign. A single temporary noncommercial sign shall not
exceed nine square feet in area. The sign may be single or double-faced.
(ii)
Height per sign. If freestanding, the temporary noncommercial
sign shall not exceed six feet in height. If mounted to a building,
the temporary noncommercial sign must be below the roof eves.
(B) Aggregate area and timing.
(i)
A property owner may place a maximum aggregate of nine square
feet of area of temporary noncommercial signage on the property for
one period of 45 days per year.
(ii)
During 90 days prior to and seven after a local, State, or national
election, a property owner may place temporary noncommercial signage
on the property as follows:
a.
For residential property, 63 additional square feet of area;
and
b.
For nonresidential property 81 additional square feet of area.
(3) Real estate sale or lease signs (not including banners).
(A) During the period in which property is offered for sale or lease
and seven days after the sale or lease of the property is executed,
one property sale or lease sign is allowed on each 600 lineal feet
of street frontage of the property.
(B) Such sign may be single- or double-faced and is limited in area to:
(i)
Not more than nine square feet for lots less than one acre,
(ii)
Not more than 16 square feet for lots more than one acre, and
(iii)
Not more than 32 square feet for lots immediately adjacent to
the I-5 Freeway. The Development Services Director may approve a sign
up to 60 square feet adjacent to the I-5 Freeway, if unique visibility
conditions exist.
(4) Temporary signs on produce stands. Temporary signs on produce stands
that do not exceed an aggregate 64 square feet and located within
100 feet of the produce stand, with individual signs not exceeding
32 square feet in area.
(5) Temporary signs placed in the public right-of-way pursuant to Chapter 9 of Title
7 of the Municipal Code, Temporary Signs.
(6) Government required signs.
(A) Government and legally required posters, notices, and signs. Such
signs may be located off site.
(B) Development application signs. Signs posted on properties for discretionary
applications set forth by City Council Resolution 07-09-04-01 as may
be amended.
(C) Environmental signs. Signs that must be posted in accordance with
a mitigation measure adopted pursuant to the California Environmental
Quality Act or as a condition of approval for a specific development
application.
(D) “No Trespassing” sign. “No trespassing” signs
allowed or required by the California
Penal Code shall not exceed
one square foot in size, placed at each corner or entrance to the
property and at intervals of not less than 50 feet.
(7) Hazards and safety signs.
(A) Signs that warn of construction, excavation or similar hazards so
long as the hazard exists;
(B) Traffic and safety signs including signs of public utility agencies
and construction contractors serving as directional or safety aids
(may be illuminated). Examples include street signs, freeway off-ramp
signs, and roadwork signs.
(8) Residential signage. Residential signage, such as nameplates, that
does not exceed two square feet in area;
(9) Professional occupation signage. Professional occupation signage,
such as and nameplates, that does not exceed one per tenant, and does
not to exceed two square feet.
(10) Memorial signs and tablets. Memorial signs and tablets permanently
installed at building sites, which denote a noncommercial message,
shall not exceed six square feet in area.
(11) Vehicle signs. Vehicle signs painted directly on vehicles indicating
the name of the establishment using the vehicle. For the purpose of
this section, a vehicle sign may include text or trademark logo, but
shall not include directional arrows or similar graphics.
(12) Menu board signs. Menu board signs (permanent) building mounted that
do not exceed four square feet in area (may be illuminated) and only
one per entrance.
(13) Gasoline pump, telephone booth, and news rack. Any sign on a gasoline
pump, telephone booth, and news rack, provided the sign identifies
only the product contained therein, or displays operating instructions,
and the lettering does not exceed four inches in height.
(14) Residential event signs. On residential property, a sign denoting
a one-time event, such as a garage sale, on the residential property
may be may be posted no more than 24 hours before the one-time event,
shall be removed no more than 24 hours after the event, and may be
posted for not more than 72 hours. A one-time event sign shall have
a sign area not to exceed three square feet.
(g) Sign
standards by type and zoning district. The maximum size of signs and
height provisions for various signs in various zoning districts are
set forth in Table 3-42. Signs and/or illumination of signs that are
visible from City entry ways and view corridors (i.e., Camino Capistrano,
Rancho Viejo Road, Ortega Highway and the I-5 Freeway) may be referred
to the Planning Commission as determined by the Community Development
Director.
|
Zone Districts
|
---|
(1)
|
Residential Zones
|
|
(A)
|
RA—Residential Agriculture
|
|
(B)
|
HR—Hillside Residential
|
|
(C)
|
RSE 40,000—Single-Family 40,000
|
|
(D)
|
RSE 20,000—Single-Family 20,000
|
|
(E)
|
RS 10,000—Single-Family 10,000
|
|
(F)
|
RS 7,000—Single-Family 7,000
|
|
(G)
|
RS 4,000—Single-Family 4,000
|
|
(H)
|
RG 7,000—Residential Garden 7,000
|
|
(I)
|
RG 4,000—Residential Garden 4,000
|
|
(J)
|
RM—Multiple-Family
|
|
(K)
|
AF/SH—Affordable Family/Senior Housing
|
|
(L)
|
MHP—Mobile Home Park
|
(2)
|
Commercial Zones
|
|
(A)
|
TC—Tourist Commercial
|
|
(B)
|
NC—Neighborhood Commercial
|
|
(C)
|
GC—General Commercial
|
|
(D)
|
OC—Office Commercial
|
(3)
|
Industrial Zones
|
|
(A)
|
CM—Commercial Manufacturing
|
|
(B)
|
IP—Industrial Park
|
|
(C)
|
A—Agri-Business
|
(4)
|
P&I—Public & Institutional Zones
|
(5)
|
Open Space Zones
|
|
(A)
|
GOS—General Open Space
|
|
(B)
|
OSR—Open Space Recreation
|
|
(C)
|
NP—Neighborhood Park
|
|
(D)
|
CP—Community Park
|
|
(E)
|
SP—Specialty Park
|
|
(F)
|
RP—Regional Park
|
|
(G)
|
NOS—Natural Open Space
|
|
(H)
|
RC—Recreation Commercial
|
(6)
|
FM—Farm Market
|
(7)
|
SP/PP—Specific Plan/Precise Plan
|
(8)
|
PC—Planned Community
|
(9)
|
CDP—Comprehensive Development Plan
|
(10)
|
SWF—Solid Waste Facility
|
Note:
|
*
|
For discretionary projects see sign program pursuant to Planning Commission and/or Design Review Committee standards Section 9-3.543(d).
|
(h) Signs requiring Planning Commission review. Notwithstanding the requirements of Section
9-2.343(b)(1)9-2.343(b)(1), the following signs require Planning Commission review prior to issuance of a sign permit. The Community Development Director shall have the authority to require all applicable materials to deem an application complete to be forwarded to the Planning Commission.
(1) Monument (freestanding) signs;
(4) Electronic message centers;
(5) Sign programs for discretionary project applications;
(8) Outdoor inventory sellers;
(9)
Community Development Director may refer any sign to the Planning
Commission.
(i) General design criteria. This section is intended to be used in conjunction
with other standards contained in these sign regulations. In no case
may the maximum number or size of signs, or their illumination levels
exceed standards provided by this title.
(1)
Building mounted (flush) signs (wall signs).
(A)
General design criteria: Building mounted (wall) signs shall
comply with the following design criteria:
(i)
Include channel letters made out of wood, metal, plastic or
other acceptable material;
(ii) Be painted on a wall, or on a board that is attached to a wall with approved materials pursuant to Section
9-3.543(b)(3)9-3.543(b)(3);
(iii) Should be oriented to achieve balanced composition
and harmony with other architectural elements of a building façade.
(iv) Shall be placed on a flat building surface and
not be placed over or otherwise obscure architectural building features.
(B)
Location and number permitted. Wall signs must be located on
a building face that has a public entrance, if feasible. The maximum
number of wall signs permitted shall not exceed one per building exposure
(wall).
(C)
Size. Wall signs may be a maximum of 18 square feet each or
aggregate 24 square feet and shall in no case exceed 2% of the building
face as determined by the Community Development Director.
(E)
Zoning. Wall signs are allowed in TC, GC, NC, RC, OSR, P&I,
CM, IP, OC zoning districts.
(2)
Monument (freestanding) signs.
(A)
General design criteria. Monument signs shall comply with the
following design criteria:
(i)
Be used to identify tenants when building setbacks, orientation
or design make it difficult to provide other types of signage, such
as wall signs, that are plainly visible to people that are trying
to identify a use. The primary function is to provide project or tenant
identification.
(ii) Shall have a solid base that the sign face is
installed upon.
(iii) Shall be designed so that the style of the sign
and its base are consistent with the architecture of the buildings
on the site.
(iv) Monument signs shall include landscaping at the
base to enhance their appearance.
(B)
Location and number permitted. Monument signs may be located in required setback areas for any given zone, subject to the approval of the Planning Commission, as provided for in Section
9-3.543(h)(1)9-3.543(h)(1) of these regulations. Only one monument sign is permitted per street frontage. Except, shopping centers or multiple tenant centers may have two monument signs, one sign on each side of the main entrance drive access.
(C)
Size. Monument signs may be a maximum of the area and height
identified in Table 3-42. Sign area is calculated pursuant to Figure
3-5.
(D)
Illumination. Illumination shall be in accordance with Section
9-3 543(b)(6).
(E)
Zoning. Monument signs are allowed in all commercial, industrial
and public and institutional zones.
(3)
Building mounted (projecting) signs.
(A)
General design criteria. Building mounted (projecting) signs
shall comply with the following design criteria:
(i)
Be attached to a building face and project out perpendicular
to the building wall and oriented to pedestrians on the sidewalk level.
(ii) Sign and sign text shall use appropriate materials
including wood and metal with carved or applied lettering or design
features, or other material that is architecturally compatible with
the building that the sign is attached to.
(iii) Multiple projecting signs should not be installed
within 10 feet of each other if on the same property and should be
separated from projecting signs on adjacent properties by a minimum
of 10 feet to ensure proper visibility.
(B)
Location and number. A minimum clearance of seven feet must
be maintained above the public right-of-way or private sidewalk area.
One projecting sign is allowed per tenant space.
(C)
Size. Projecting signs may have a maximum area of eight square
feet.
(E)
Zoning. Projecting signs may be allowed in all zoning districts.
(4)
Building mounted (hanging and suspended) signs.
(A)
General design criteria. Building mounted (hanging and suspended)
signs shall comply with the following design criteria:
(i)
Hanging signs, or suspended signs, are used to help define entries
and identify business names to pedestrians and can be particularly
useful for storefronts that have multiple tenants.
(ii) Hanging signs are small and can hang over or adjacent
to a building entry.
(B)
Location and number. A minimum clearance of seven feet must
be maintained above any public right-of-way or private sidewalk area.
One hanging or suspended sign is allowed per tenant space.
(C)
Size. Hanging signs may have a maximum area of eight square
feet.
(E)
Zoning. Allowed in all zoning districts.
(5)
Window (permanent) signs.
(A)
General design criteria. Window (permanent) signs shall comply
with the following design criteria:
(i)
Be scaled to the pedestrian and oriented to window shoppers
on the sidewalk, as opposed to passing vehicles.
(ii) Be limited to small graphics and text that serve
to frame a window or to provide information.
(iii) Shall not obscure the view into a store or place
of business.
(B)
Location and number. There is no specific location requirement
or limit to the number of window signs allowed.
(C)
Size. Permanent window signs shall not exceed 25% of the window
area.
(E)
Zoning. Permanent window signs are allowed in all commercial
and industrial zoning districts.
(6)
Awning signs.
(A)
General design criteria. Awning signs shall comply with the
following design criteria:
(i)
Be limited to the valance of the awning and not on the awning
face.
(B)
Location and number. Signs may be located on awning subject
to size criteria. One awning sign may be permitted per tenant space
and must maintain a minimum clearance of seven feet above any public
right-of-way or private sidewalk area.
(C)
Size. Signs on awnings shall not cover more than 30% of the
valance area of the awning, or exceed 18 square feet in size, whichever
is less.
(E)
Zoning. Awning signs may be located in all commercial zones.
Installation of new awnings is subject to architectural control review.
(7)
Portable signs (including sandwich boards, A-frames, etc.).
(A)
General design criteria. Portable signs (including sandwich
boards, A-frames, etc.) shall comply with the following design criteria:
(i)
May have rewritable surfaces, such as chalkboards or dry-erase
boards.
(ii) Shall be professionally designed, fabricated and
maintained.
(iii) Shall be restricted for display only during business
hours.
(iv) Shall require a sign permit.
(B)
Location and number. Portable signs are prohibited in the public
right-of-way and may only be placed on the sidewalks of private property,
a foyer, portico or other building entry provided they do not interfere
with pedestrian ingress or egress as required by the California Building
Code. Only one portable sign may be permitted per tenant space located
within 50 feet of the tenant main entrance. The Community Development
Director may approve one portable sign for tenants not visible from
the right-of-way within 50 feet of the tenant main entrance, otherwise
Planning Commission approval is required.
(C)
Size. Portable signs may have a maximum area of five square
feet and a maximum height of four feet six inches, measured from the
ground to the top of the sign structure.
(D)
Illumination. Portable signs shall not be illuminated.
(E)
Zoning. Portable signs may be allowed in all nonresidential
zoning districts.
(8)
Murals.
(A)
Noncommercial. Murals shall not contain text or any specific
commercial message, shall be strictly an artistic expression and shall
not be used for advertising purposes, otherwise they are classified
as a wall sign. Mural proposals which are classified as a wall sign
shall conform to the design standards applicable to wall signs.
(B)
General design criteria. Murals shall comply with the following
design criteria:
(i)
No part of a mural shall exceed the height of the structure
to which it is tiled, painted or affixed.
(ii) No part of a mural shall extend more than six
inches from the plane of the wall upon which it is tiled, painted
or affixed.
(iii) No part of a mural shall exceed a height of the
first floor or 15 feet above grade.
(iv) No mural may consist of, or contain, electrical
or mechanical components, or changing images (moving structural elements,
flashing or sequential lights, lighting elements, or other automated
methods that result in movement, the appearance of movement, or change
of mural image or message).
(v)
No mural, except for murals consisting completely of paint,
shall be placed over the exterior surface of any building opening,
including, but not limited to, windows, doors and vents. Notwithstanding
the foregoing, a mural consisting of paint or any other material may
be placed on roll down security doors on a commercial or industrial
building.
(C)
Location and number. Murals may be located on any building wall.
There is no specific limit on the number of murals permitted.
(D)
Size. Murals may not exceed, in the aggregate, 48 square feet
per building wall.
(F)
Zoning. Murals may be located in nonresidential zoning districts.
(9)
Residential subdivision signs (permanent).
(A)
General design criteria. Residential subdivision signs (permanent)
shall comply with the following design criteria:
(i)
The purpose of residential subdivision signs is to identify
the name of a subdivision.
(ii) Are usually freestanding monument signs or building
mounted wall signs placed on a wall feature in a landscaped open space
area at the entry of the development.
(B)
Location and number. Two residential subdivision signs are allowed
at each project entry of a subdivision. The signs shall be located
within a landscaped area.
(C)
Size. Each sign shall not exceed 24 square feet with an aggregate
area not exceeding 48 square feet. Freestanding signs shall not exceed
six feet in height from grade.
(E)
Zoning. Residential subdivision signs are allowed in all residential
and Planned Community zones.
(10)
Directory signs.
(A)
General design criteria. Directory signs shall comply with the
following design criteria:
(i) Are used for multi-tenant buildings to provide
a directory of tenant locations within the building.
(ii) May serve as the address sign for the property.
(iii) Small scale and are oriented to pedestrians.
(B)
Location and number. Directory signs may be freestanding or
may be fixed on an exterior wall if the building has no setback. One
directory sign may be permitted per building.
(C)
Size. Directory signs shall be no larger than 12 square feet
in area, and individual letters shall not exceed six inches in height.
(E)
Zoning. Directory signs are allowed in all zoning districts.
(j)
Temporary signs. The following signs shall be deemed temporary
subject to development standards, time limitations and permits.
(1) Banners (temporary business promotional). One banner not exceeding
48 square feet in area may be permitted per tenant or suite (not including
subleases) for one time only, for a maximum of 45 days per calendar
year. The Community Development Director may extend the time limit
a temporary business identification banner is displayed with a signed
contract that states when a permanent sign will be completed. Time
extensions shall not include promotional banners. Banners shall require
a sign permit. Banners shall only be mounted on building façades.
(2) Business promotional (community-wide special events). The Community
Development Director may approve banners within the public right-of-way
for community-wide special events provided the street banner request
meets the provisions of City Council Policy 419.
(3) Construction (major). On-site, major construction signs shall be
permitted upon issuance of a building or grading permit for the project
site that exceeds 10,000 square feet. The maximum allowable size for
major construction signs is 16 square feet in area and eight feet
in height, Such signs shall be removed prior to issuance of a certificate
of use and occupancy for the project or the last phase of a project
provided a valid building or grading permit has not expired.
(4) Construction (minor). On-site, minor construction signs on property
less than 10,000 square feet shall be permitted. The maximum allowable
size for minor construction signs is six square feet in area and four
feet in height.
(5) Subdivision (temporary). Temporary subdivision signs shall be permitted
and used to identify an approved residential subdivision for a project
located in the City. Said signs shall be removed upon issuance of
the last certificate of use and occupancy for units within the subdivision.
For the purpose of this section, subdivision directional signs shall
only be permitted for those residential subdivisions located within
the City.
(6) Special activities. Special activities signs, under Section
9-3.547 Special Activities, shall be permitted. Signs and banners identifying the event may be placed on the site no earlier than 14 days prior to the designated activity and shall be removed within 48 hours after the special activity. Signs and banners shall not exceed 48 square feet in area or six feet in height.
(7) Temporary window/door signs. Temporary window/door signs shall not
exceed 25% of the total window area. For the purpose of this section,
total window area shall mean the total square footage of window area
located on a specific building elevation for which the temporary sign
is located.
(8) Portable signs. Portable signs shall not exceed one sign per tenant,
four feet six inches in height, or five square feet in area. Portable
signs shall be professionally designed, fabricated and maintained,
shall be restricted for display only during business hours, shall
be placed on sidewalks on private property, foyer or portico of building
entry not interfering with pedestrian access, and shall be located
within 50 feet of the tenant main entrance. The Community Development
Director may approve one portable sign for tenants not visible from
the right-of-way within 50 feet of the tenant main entrance, otherwise
Planning Commission approval is required.
(9) Public and institutional temporary banners. Properties in the Public
and Institutional Zones shall be allowed temporary banners as follows:
(A) A banner program shall be submitted to the City on an annual basis,
memorializing the proposed banners to be used throughout the year.
The program shall detail the following:
(iii)
Anticipated message on each banner,
(iv)
Anticipated timeframe of the posting of each banner;
(B) A maximum of one banner per each public street, private street, or
railroad right-of-way frontage;
(C) A maximum of one banner facing a public street, private street, or
railroad right-of-way;
(D) Each temporary banner shall not exceed 48 square feet;
(E) Temporary banners shall only be placed onto the perimeter fence/wall
or building façade facing and/or adjacent to the public street,
private street, or railroad right-of-way. Temporary banners cannot
be placed over or extending into the public rights-of-way, onto trees
or landscaping, light standards or higher than 15 feet above adjacent
grade;
(F) Temporary banner shall be removed within seven days of the conclusion
of event or special announcement;
(G) Any temporary banner sign exceeding the standards listed above shall
require application of a sign program to be reviewed and approved
by the Planning Commission and possibly review by the Design Review
Committee prior to issuance of a banner sign permit;
(k) Exceptions.
Exceptions to the standards set forth in this section may be granted
by the Planning Commission. In order to grant an exception, the Planning
Commission shall make all of the following findings:
(1) The sign complies with all other applicable criteria of this section;
(2) The scale of the sign will be in harmony with the architectural design
for the building which it will serve;
(3) The sign will not create a hazard to other adjacent properties or
tenants.
(l) Revocation
sign permit. Any permit issued under this chapter may be revoked by
order of the Planning Commission.
(1) Grounds. The Planning Commission must determine subject to substantial
evidence that one of the following exists:
(A) The permit was issued without or in excess of the authority provided
in this chapter.
(B) The application for permit contained any misrepresentation of fact.
(C) The sign has been installed inconsistent with or contrary to approved
sign plans.
(2) Hearing. Prior to revoking a sign permit, the Planning Commission
shall hold a hearing concerning said revocation. Written notice of
said hearing shall be given to the permittee not less than 10 days
prior to the date of the hearing. Following the hearing, if the Planning
Commission revokes the sign permit, it shall adopt findings setting
forth the basis for its decision. The findings shall be mailed to
the permittee.
(m) Appeals. The applicant or any interested person may appeal decisions concerning sign permit applications pursuant to Section
9-2.311 of the Municipal Code.
(n) Enforcement
and penalties.
(1) Temporary signs. This section applies to any temporary sign described in Section
9-3.543, subsectio
n (f)(2) or subsection
(j).
(A) Temporary signs which obstruct the visibility of traffic, street
signs, signals or emergency equipment and are determined by the Community
Development Director to pose a hazard to public safety, are subject
to immediate removal by City employees. Temporary signs removed in
accordance with this subsection shall be stored and the owner notified
pursuant to subsection (n)(1)(C).
(B) Temporary signs placed in the public right-of-way are subject to the removal provisions set forth in Chapter 9 of Title
7 of this Municipal Code.
(C) Any temporary sign that is improperly marked, affixed, or otherwise
illegally located, is subject to removal by City employees upon 24
hour notice. A notice of removal will be affixed to the illegal sign
during this 24 hour period. A reasonable attempt will be made to notify
the sign owner of the violation and the need to remove the illegal
sign. An owner of an illegal temporary sign given notice to remove
the sign may file a written request for an administrative hearing
by the Community Development Director, if he or she disputes whether
the sign is illegal. This written request must be filed prior to the
expiration of the 24 hour period of notice. The sign will not be removed
until the administrative hearing is conducted. The Community Development
Director must hold an administrative hearing within 72 hours of receipt
of written request to consider whether the sign is illegal. If the
Community Development Director finds that the sign does not meet all
applicable requirements of this Code for temporary signs, the owner
shall remove the sign within 24 hours. If the sign is not removed,
the City will cause the sign to be removed and it will be stored at
City offices for a period of 10 days. If the sign is not retrieved
by the owner within 10 days, the sign will be destroyed or disposed
of by the City.
(D) Removal of a sign, when authorized by this Code, may be done by officers
of Police Services, Building Inspectors, Planners, or by a Code Enforcement
Officer.
(2) Other illegal or abandoned signs. This section applies to any other
sign that is constructed, erected or installed in violation of this
section; improperly maintained; abandoned; illegal; unsafe; or the
sign permit has terminated, been revoked or is otherwise in violation
of this section. An “abandoned sign” shall mean any sign
remaining in place or maintained for a period of 90 days which no
longer advertises or identifies an ongoing business, product, or service
available on the business premises where the sign is located.
(A) Notice of violation. Where it is determined that a sign is illegal
or abandoned, the Community Development Director, or designee, shall
mail or deliver notice to the owner of the sign. If the notice cannot
be sent or delivered to the owner, then the notice shall be attached
to the sign. The notice shall give the owner an opportunity to cure
the violation or to appeal the City’s determination to remove
without notice and shall include instructions for how to request a
hearing or appeal. An invoice for costs may be included with the notice.
(B) Removal. If the City is required to remove any signs or if no response
is made to a notice of violation within 10 days of mailing of the
notice, the sign may be removed by the City. The sign will be stored
by the City for a period of 30 days and may be reclaimed by the owner
after the payment of all removal and storage costs. Any sign not reclaimed
within such time, may be destroyed or disposed of by the City. In
the event the responsible party does not reclaim the sign, or pay
all fees assessed by the City, the City may recover its costs through
the cost recovery mechanism identified in this section.
(C) Hearing.
(i)
Unless stated otherwise in this section, any person who has
received a notice and/or invoice pursuant to this section may request
a hearing. Any hearing request must be in writing to the Community
Development Director within 10 business days of the date of the mailing
of the notice/invoice. The request for hearing must set forth the
basis of such person’s objection.
(ii)
Upon receipt of a request for a hearing, the Community Development
Director shall set a hearing date before a hearing officer appointed
by the City Manager within 30 days of receipt of the request for a
hearing. The Director shall provide the person requesting the hearing
at least five days’ advance notice of the hearing. The hearing
date may be changed by mutual consent of the Community Development
Director, the person requesting the hearing, and the hearing officer.
At the hearing, the person requesting the hearing will have an opportunity
to present evidence supporting his or her position.
(iii)
Within 10 days following the conclusion of the hearing, the
hearing officer shall render a written decision. A copy of this decision
shall be promptly sent to the responsible party (also referred to
as the “appellant”).
(iv)
If no appeal is filed, the responsible party, within seven days,
following the finality of the determination of the hearing officer,
shall commence the repairs or improvements or removal ordered, and
such work shall be completed within 30 days from the commencement
thereof, unless otherwise agreed to by the Community Development Director.
(D) Penalties.
(i)
Fines. A violation of this section may be punishable by fines
up to the following amounts:
a.
For a first violation, $100 for the first day of the violation
plus $10 per day that the violation continues after the first day.
b.
For the second violation within one year of the first violation,
$200 for the first day of the violation plus $20 per day that the
violation continues after the first day.
c.
For the third and each subsequent violation within one year
of the first violation, $500 for the first day of the violation plus
$50 per day that the violation continues after the first day.
(ii)
Nuisance. Notwithstanding any other provision of this section,
any illegal or abandoned sign is declared a nuisance and may be abated
pursuant to this Municipal Code.
(iii)
In addition to the above, every violation of any provision of this section shall be punishable as set forth in Chapter 2 of Title
1.
(Ord. No. 869, § 2; Ord. No. 934, § 1, 2008; Ord. No. 960, § 1, 2009; Ord. No. 971, § 6, 2010; Ord. No. 996, § 2, 2012; Ord. No. 1012, § 2, 2014; Ord. No. 1065, § 4, 2019; Ord. No. 1082, § 19, 2021)
(a) Purpose.
The purpose of this program is to establish specific measures that
will provide financial resources and programs to assist in the correction
of damages arising from slope displacement.
(b) Projects
subject to program. “Significant residential development”
covered by this program means all residential development proposals
in hillside areas as defined by having natural slopes of greater than
10% consisting of: (1) 10 or more subdivision lots; or (2) any development
which requires corrective grading to eliminate a potential slope or
soils stability problem. Slopes subject to the provisions of this
section are defined as follows:
(1) All designated common area landscape slopes maintained by a homeowners’
association who has been designated by the project CC&Rs responsibility
for their maintenance;
(2) All manufactured slopes having a minimum height of five feet in vertical
height;
(3) All natural slopes within 200 feet of individual lots, or within
150 feet if within the fuel modification zone.
(c) Program
components. Each subdivision tentative map approval or other development
requiring a land use entitlement covered by this title shall include
conditions of approval implementing the following provisions. Said
provisions shall be established and recorded prior to or concurrent
with a final map or issuance of a grading permit whichever would occur
first.
(1) Catastrophic soil displacement program element. The following standard
condition of approval shall be applied to all residential subdivisions
in the City that incorporate manufactured slopes of either a cut or
fill nature within an area subject to this program:
(A) Type of remediation program. Prior to the issuance of a grading permit, the subdivider shall create a Geologic Hazard Abatement District authorized under
Public Resources Code Section 26500 et seq. Said District upon creation shall be activated upon a subsidence occurrence per the definition in subsection
(B) below.
(B) Definition of catastrophic coverage. Catastrophic soils subsidence
is defined as displacement of a manufactured or natural slope at a
depth greater than three feet with a vertical movement of one foot
or more, regardless of cause.
(C) Covered repairs (short-term). The subdivider will make or cause to
be made all repairs to correct any damages to individual lots and
structures, or common/public improvements due to soils displacement
at their sole expense for the first three years after completion of
rough grading of the entire site or the close of escrow for all lots
within the subdivision whichever is latter.
(D) Covered repairs (long-term). If a catastrophic displacement should occur subsequent to subsection
(C) above, the Geologic Hazard Abatement District shall cover the cost of the actual repairs including damage to individual lots and structures, or common/public improvements due to soils displacement.
(E) Reserved rights clause. This clause shall be included in the formation
of the Geologic Hazard Abatement District reserving the right of the
subdivider, a homeowner association or the Geologic Hazard Abatement
District to assert claims against any person or entity responsible
in whole or in part for the displacement of soils covered by this
section.
(F) Public disclosure of district formation. Public disclosure of the
formation of the district shall be provided by a recorded document
on the Grant Deed for all lots or parcels within the boundaries of
the Geologic Hazard Abatement District. Furthermore, the California
Department of Real Estate Report on the subdivision offering the lots
or parcels for initial sale shall also include a disclosure statement
for prospective buyers.
(2) Surficial soil displacement remediation program element. The following
program elements shall be incorporated into CC&Rs for any residential
subdivision applications subject to the provisions of this chapter
to insure the long-term stability of subdivision slopes over the life
of the project for surficial displacement:
(A) Definition of surficial coverage. “Surficial soils subsidence”
is defined as displacement of a manufactured slope at a depth up to
three feet with a vertical movement of one foot or more, regardless
of cause. Soils subsidence does not include surface cracking and fissures,
including desiccation cracks, or erosion (defined as the wearing away
of surface of the slope, as opposed to movement of the slope, resulting
from the force of water, wind, persons, or vehicles moving over the
surface, unless erosion ultimately results in displacement). Surficial
damage shall be considered catastrophic if due to the extent of movement,
sufficient funds as required under subsection (D) following, are not
available to repair the damage.
(B) Reserved rights clause. This clause is to reserve the right of the
subdivider, a homeowner association or the Geologic Hazard Abatement
District to assert claims against any person or entity responsible
in whole or in part for the displacement of soils covered by this
program.
(C) Covered repairs (short-term). The subdivider will make or cause to
be made all repairs to correct any damage to individual lots, structures
or public/private improvements soils displacement at their sole expense
for the first three years after the completion of rough grading or
the close of escrow for all lots within the entire subdivision whichever
is latter.
(D) Covered repairs (long-term). A homeowners’ association shall
be formed for all subdivisions subject to the City soils subsidence
remediation program. The purpose of the Association is to insure the
maintenance of a homeowner assessment fund which will collect and
maintain a restricted fund to correct damage to individual lots, structures
or public/private improvements due to soil displacement occurrences.
Said restricted account is to be established prior to the issuance
of the first grading permit for the subdivision. The subdivider is
to deposit into the homeowners’ association restricted account,
an initial amount as determined by the City. Regulation and use of
the restricted account shall be in accordance with the following:
(i)
Funds deposited into the homeowners’
association restricted account can only be used for actual costs associated
with correcting soils displacement events as described above. The
initial security shall be in such form and manner as to guarantee
and secure the performance of the seller (subdivider) and shall consist
of one of the following, at the option of the seller and with the
approval of the City Council:
(a)
Corporate sureties approved by the City Attorney;
(b)
A deposit, either with a responsible escrow agent or trust company,
of money or negotiable bonds of the kind approved for securing deposits
of public moneys; or
(c)
An instrument of credit, from one or more financial institutions
subject to regulation by the State or federal government, pledging
that the funds necessary to carry out the warranty program are on
deposit and guaranteed for payment.
(ii)
Special assessments shall be applied to all parcels within the
subdivision. Said assessments shall commence on the initial close
of escrow, pursuant to the regulations of the California Department
of Real Estate. Said assessments shall be collected by the Homeowner
Association until the account reaches a predetermined minimum as established
by the City. The subdivider shall be able to withdraw its initial
deposit provided the fund does not fall below 75% of the predetermined
minimum. If a claim occurs during the period the developer is responsible,
and the fund drops below the 75% level the developer shall restore
the fund to the minimum 75% level.
(iii)
If the amount in the account is less than the minimum amount
as specified above at the conclusion of the initial time period (short-term),
then the subdivider shall deposit sufficient funds to meet the minimum
requirements.
(iv)
Appropriate provisions shall be included in the homeowners’
association CC&Rs and in the grant deeds to grant an exclusive
license to the subdivider or the Homeowner Association, the right
to enter onto common lots and individually-owned lots so that the
subdivider or its agents or Homeowner Association can maintain and
inspect all landscaping, irrigation and drainage devices, and all
other natural and artificial conditions which affect or might affect
the integrity of slopes which are subject to the provisions of this
program.
(v)
A provision in the CC&Rs that requires any proposed alterations
by homeowners to the landscaping, grading, irrigation or drainage
installed as part of the subdivision on individually-owned property
to be subject to review and approval by the Homeowners Association
and City.
(E) Claim processing. The Homeowner Association in the administration
of this program shall retain the services of an independent claims
adjusting service. The service shall be responsible to adjust all
claims for work which are claimed to be within the coverage of the
program. Claims asserted to be within the coverage of the program
will be processed by forms provided by the homeowners’ association
and filed with the independent adjuster, who will promptly adjust
such claims after obtaining an analysis on the scope and cost of completing
all necessary repairs. The assessment fund or other approved funding
device will compensate for the cost of the independent claims adjusting
service.
(F) Modification to required CC&Rs. A provision shall be incorporated
into a subdivisions CC&Rs that will require City approval of any
modifications to specific provisions of the CC&Rs designed to
carry out the provisions of this chapter.
(Ord. No. 869, § 2)
(a) Intent
and purpose. The intent and purpose of this section are to establish
a permit procedure for the regulation of the display of merchandise
and products and/or temporary banners outside normal sales areas which
may occur in association with a special promotional/sale activity
and in addition, certain short-term uses which due to their brief
duration may be adequately managed through a permit process. This
section is not intended to control or regulate the normal promotional/sale
activities conducted within the approved display area of a business
establishment as provided for by other applicable provisions of this
Code.
(b) Applicability.
(1) Business owners/property owners who are engaged in conducting a permitted
business activity in the Office Commercial (OC), Neighborhood Commercial
(NC), Town Center (TC), Town Center Edge (TCE), General Commercial
(GC), Farm Market (FM), Commercial Manufacturing (CM), and those portions
of the Planned Community (PC) District which permit commercial uses
may apply for a special activities permit.
(2) Christmas tree sales. The sale of Christmas trees shall be permitted
only during the month of December, subject to the following requirements:
(A) A special activities permit shall be obtained prior to the issuance
of any other permit relating to the operation of this use.
(B) The facility shall be removed and the premises upon which it was
located shall be cleared of all debris and restored to its original
condition by January 1st following the holiday.
(3) Carnivals, festivals, exhibits, and sidewalk sales. These uses and
similar enterprises may be operated on a temporary basis provided
they meet the following requirements:
(A) A special activities permit shall be obtained prior to the issuance
of any other permit relating to the operations of this use;
(B) Sponsorship shall be limited to public agencies or religious, fraternal,
or service organizations directly engaged in civic or charitable efforts;
(C) The time period for such activities shall not exceed five consecutive
days within any three month period;
(D) Such activities shall not cause or produce dust, gas, smoke, fumes,
odors, or vibration detrimental to other persons or properties in
the vicinity;
(E) The lights used to illuminate the event shall be arranged so as to
direct light away from nearby residences;
(F) No public address system shall be installed in conjunction with the
event unless such system is modulated so as not to disturb the occupants
of nearby dwellings;
(G) All structures, apparatus, and appurtenances shall be removed from
the premises as soon as possible following the closing of the event;
and
(H) The hours of operation shall be subject to the review and approval
of the Planning Director.
(4) Car dealers desiring to use tents, pennants, banner signs, window
decals, inflatable corporate logos, light-pole banners, ground flags,
bounce houses and similar attraction devices to temporarily promote
sales are subject to the following:
(A) A maximum period of up to 90 days plus the month of March annually
may be approved under a special event permit application issued by
the Director.
(B) The annual period during which car dealers may use tents by special
activity permit shall be on a calendar year basis.
(C) Design standards:
(i)
No signs or other structures may be affixed to the tent.
(ii)
Tents shall be situated within auto inventory and/or display
areas and shall not displace any required guest/customer parking.
(iii)
Use of tents shall be subject to Orange County Fire Authority
(OCFA) review and approval.
(iv)
Banner signs shall not exceed a maximum area of 100 square feet
and shall not be affixed on the building above the eaves.
(v)
Window decals/signage shall not exceed 50% of the window area.
(vi)
Inflatable corporate logos shall not exceed a maximum dimension,
either height, width or depth, of 15 feet subject to Director approval;
and, not exceed a maximum dimension of 25 feet subject to Planning
Commission approval.
(vii)
Light-pole banners shall not exceed an area of 24 square feet
and ground flags shall not exceed a maximum area of 15 square feet.
(viii)
Bounce houses and similar attraction devices shall be situated
within auto inventory and/or display areas and shall not displace
any required guest/customer parking.
(5) A grand opening event of 14 days shall be exempt from these provisions.
(c) Review
process.
(1) The Planning Director, or designated agent, may issue special activities permits, pursuant to Section
9-2.303 Administrative Approvals, provided the following criteria are met and the application is consistent with the design standards set forth in subsection (d) of this section:
(A) The special activity permits shall be issued for not more than 32
days during any 12 month period with the exception of automobile dealerships
for which special activity permits shall be issued for not more than
90 days plus the month of March.
(B) The property owner has authorized the special activity in writing;
and
(C) The application is submitted 14 days prior to the scheduled activity.
(d) Application
information. The Planning Director shall prescribe the type and form
of information required to process an administrative permit.
(e) Specific
design standards. The following specific design standards shall apply
to all special activities:
(1) Banners/signs. Banners and signs may be permitted in accordance with the provisions of Section
9-3.543 Signs.
(2) Flags. The use of flags shall be strictly prohibited.
(f) General
conditions of approval. The following general operational conditions
shall be considered for all special activity permits:
(1) Activities shall be restricted to that portion so designated on the
site plan;
(2) A site plan has been approved by the Orange County Fire Authority
and Orange County Sheriff’s Departments for meeting public safety
requirements when applicable;
(3) The City has reviewed the site plan regarding adequate parking and
traffic circulation for both vehicular and pedestrian, including provisions
for emergency ingress/egress;
(4) Adequate space shall be provided on walkways for the passage of pedestrian
traffic (minimum five feet);
(5) The site plan and all signage complies with this Code and the specific
design standards set forth in subsection (e) of this section;
(6) Displays shall be removed by 10:00 p.m. on the last day of the activity;
(7) A valid business license has been issued for the applicant by the
City;
(8) A cleaning deposit had been made if determined to be applicable by
the Planning Director;
(9) The activities shall be confined to the sale of the specified goods
only;
(10) Additional conditions as determined by the Planning Director or designated
agent as necessary to protect the public’s health, safety, and
welfare shall be met; and
(11) Must be issued all applicable building permits.
(g) Additional
activities. The Planning Director or his or her agent may approve,
conditionally approve, or deny special activity permit requests for
the following types of uses. These uses may be permitted for a period
of time not to exceed 32 days. The 32 days allowed under a special
use permit application shall not be broken into more than three individual
times per calendar year. Applications for such uses shall be on forms
provided by the City and shall include all necessary information to
review such requests for compliance with all applicable regulations.
(2) Carnivals, festivals, and exhibits by nonprofit community groups;
(3) Sidewalk sales and special retail promotional events;
(4) Horse shows and exhibitions not located at an existing equestrian
center;
(6) Any special activity proposed for a residential district (shall require
adjacent property owner approval).
(Ord. No. 869, § 2; Ord. No. 996, § 2, 2012; Ord. No. 1082, § 17, 2021)
(a) Outside
storage as principal or conditional uses. The outside storage of materials,
equipment, and other items shall be prohibited, except where specifically
permitted in individual districts. Where outside storage is permitted
as a comparable mobilehome park, specific conditions providing for
adequately screening the storage area shall be imposed by the Planning
Commission.
(b) Outside
storage as accessory use. The outside storage of materials and equipment,
where permitted as incidental to the use of an office, store, factory,
or other commercial or industrial building located on the same building
site, shall conform to the following:
(1) Any outdoor area used for storage shall be completely enclosed by
a solid masonry wall, with necessary solid appearing gates, with a
minimum height of six feet and a maximum height of eight feet. The
substitution of a fence, decorative wall, or dense plantings which
will adequately buffer the area may be approved as a part of the development
review procedures.
(2) The storage of materials or equipment shall not be higher than the
enclosure surrounding it. Exceptions may be granted by the Planning
Commission in cases where the stored materials are within a container,
such as a silo, bins, or tanks, for finished products in transition
or in other situations where the provisions of this subsection are
not appropriate.
(c) Outside
displays of merchandise and products. The outside displays of merchandise
and products shall be prohibited in all districts, except where specifically
permitted by this Code. Permitted outside displays shall comply with
the following provisions:
(1) Every portion of a lot used for outside displays shall comply with
all the setback requirements for the applicable base district, except
for vehicular sales and rentals;
(2) Every portion of a lot used for outside displays shall be considered
as a part of the gross floor area in calculating the parking requirements
for the subject use, except for vehicular sales and rentals;
(3) Every portion of a lot used for the sale, rental, or lease of automobiles, trucks, trailers, and other similar vehicles shall comply with the screening, access, circulation, paving, bumper, lighting, and other applicable provisions of this chapter required for parking facilities. For inventory parking of vehicles, tandem parking is permitted, subject to maintenance of a 25 foot drive aisle. In addition to the landscape requirements required by Section
9-3.535 Parking, all sites shall provide a minimum 10 foot landscaped buffer area between the street frontage and display area; and
(4) All outside display areas shall be designated and approved during
the development review procedure.
(Ord. No. 869, § 2)
(a) Purpose
and intent. The City finds and determines that the purpose and intent
of this section is to provide appropriate areas within the City to
locate supportive housing facilities that may include transitional
housing, emergency homeless shelters, and/or accommodate a year-round
emergency homeless shelter; and as required by Senate Bill No. 2.
(b) Applicability.
The requirements of this section apply to all supportive housing,
as defined in Appendix A Definitions.
(c) Development standards. Emergency shelter establishments shall comply with all development standards set forth in Section
9-3.307 Public and Institutional District, as well as the following development standards:
(1) Capacity. No more than one bed per 250 square feet of gross building
space.
(2) Off-street parking. Unless otherwise provided herein or in applicable land use regulatory documents, off-street parking shall be provided at the rate of one space for each three beds. The design and location of entrances and off-street parking shall be consistent with the provisions of Section
9-3.535 Parking.
(3) Size and location of on-site waiting areas and client intake areas.
An on-site waiting area must be clearly identified for all clients.
The waiting area is to be no larger than two square feet for every
one bed provided. The waiting area is to be screened from all public
right-of-way areas with landscaping to the extent feasible. The client
intake area shall be located directly adjacent to the on-site waiting
area.
(4) On-site management. Prior to the issuance of a certificate of occupancy
for supportive housing, submittal of a written agreement between the
City and the operator of the housing units addressing all of the following:
(A) The provision of on-site management during all hours of operation,
to oversee the housing facilities.
(B) Hours of operation shall be limited, based on the scope of services
to be provided, and identified in a management plan.
(C) An individual or individuals who do not utilize the homeless beds
and/or other services and who maintain(s) their own off-site residence
may serve as an on-site manager(s). At least one such manager shall
be on site during all hours of operation and are required to be accompanied
by one supporting staff member (an individual hired or contracted
by the operator who does not utilize the homeless beds and/or other
services, who maintains their own off-site residence). There shall
be at least one supporting staff member for every 20 beds, or fraction
thereof in the facility.
(D) At a minimum, one manager shall be on site during all hours of operation,
and one supporting staff member shall be available in each segregated
populated sleeping section.
(E) Establishment and ongoing enforcement of written rules of conduct
for residents, including the prohibition of alcohol and illegal activities.
(F) Strategic plan for handling complaints or concerns from neighboring
properties.
(G) No loitering of facility residents and others near the housing units
and/or in adjacent neighborhoods.
(H) Implementation of a security plan with appropriate security measures
as approved by the Chief of Police or designee.
(I) The provision of counseling, vocational, and other supportive services
to residents.
(J) Ongoing maintenance of structures and landscaping.
(K) Availability of the operator to meet with City officials to resolve
complaints.
(5) Proximity to existing emergency shelter facilities. In no event shall
an emergency shelter be established within 200 feet of an existing
emergency shelter.
(6) Client length of stay. No client shall be allowed to stay more than
180 consecutive days in a year or 240 overall days within any 12 month
period of time.
(7) Lighting. Lighting shall be consistent with the provisions of Section
9-3.529(b)(1)(B)9-3.529(b)(1)(B) Lighting Standards for Enhanced Security Areas.
(d) Public
health requirements.
(1) Health permit. Supportive housing facilities, operating without any
food services, shall be required to comply with the applicable Orange
County Health Care Agency provisions and secure any necessary permits
prior to certificate of occupancy. Kitchens of supportive housing
facilities without food services shall meet all applicable Orange
County Health Department provisions, but shall not be remodeled into
a commercial kitchen.
(2) Fire and life safety. Sleeping sections or rooms shall be provided
with a smoke detector, handheld fire extinguisher, and evacuation
plan subject to the review of the Orange County Fire Authority. The
City may require the installation of a sprinkler system or other appropriate
safety measures on the recommendation of the Orange County Fire Authority.
(e) Other
licenses and permits. Supportive housing facility owners/operators
shall obtain the licenses and permits from the City and any others
required by Federal, State, and local laws and ordinances when applicable,
including, but not limited to:
(1) Business license in compliance with Municipal Code Title
3, Chapter
1 (Business Licenses).
(2) California Department of Public Health (CDPH) Licensing and Certification
Program (L&C).
(3) The U.S. Department of Health and Human Services’ Centers for
Medicare and Medicaid Services (CMS).
(Ord. No. 994, § 1, 2012)
Swimming pools, whirlpools, and spas shall be permitted in all
residential districts subject to the following requirements:
(a) RS-10,000,
RS-7,000, RS-4,000, RG-7,000, RG-4,000, RM, AF/SH and PC Districts.
Swimming pools, whirlpools and spas located in the Single-Family-10,000
(RS-10,000), Single-Family-7,000 (RS-7,000), Single-Family-4,000 (RS-4,000),
Residential Garden-7,000 (RG-7,000), Residential Garden-4,000 (RG-4,000),
Multiple-Family (RM), Affordable Family/Senior Housing (AF/SH), and
Planned Community (PC) Districts shall be located no closer than five
feet from the edge of the water to any side or rear property line,
and shall maintain the front yard setback as specified in this Code
for the principal building on the lot. In no case shall pools be located
where the fence height is restricted to less than five feet.
(b) RSE-40,000,
RSE-20,000, RA, A, and HR Districts. Pools in the Single-Family-40,000
(RSE-40,000), Single-Family-20,000 (RSE-20,000), Residential/Agriculture
(RA), Agri-Business (A), and Hillside Residential (HR) Districts shall
be located no closer than 10 feet from the edge of the water to any
side or rear property line and shall maintain the same minimum front
yard setback as specified in this Code for the principal building
on the lot. In no case shall pools be located where fence height is
restricted to less than five feet.
(c) Filter and heating equipment. Filter, heating, and other pool support equipment shall be located no closer than 20 feet from any neighboring dwelling, unless such equipment is placed within a building, underground vault, or other enclosure which the Planning Director determines provides effective noise and vibration damping. In order to make such a determination, the Planning Director may require sound tests of the proposed enclosure by a qualified professional. The Planning Director shall use the requirements of Section
9-3.531 Noise Standards as a guide to determining the adequacy of acoustical damping.
(d) Fence
requirements. All pools shall be completely enclosed by a fence or
wall pursuant to Title 8 of this Municipal Code.
(e) Supplemental structures. The following supplemental structures including pool slides, waterfalls, grottos, etc., that exceed six feet in height shall comply with all setback provisions of Section
9-3.501 Accessory Uses and Structures.
(Ord. No. 869, § 2)
The following uses and structures may be established as temporary uses or structures subject to prior approval by the Planning Director according to Section
9-2.347 Temporary Use Permit. Additional temporary uses may be established by the City Council by resolution.
(a) Temporary
storage of building materials. The temporary storage of building materials
shall be restricted to those materials used during the construction
of a building project. For the purposes of this subsection, “storage”
shall include the temporary office of the contractor provided such
office is located on the construction site or on property adjoining
the construction site.
(b) Large
construction in residential yards.
(1) Large construction in residential yards shall pertain to a type of
construction which is not incidental to the residential use nor of
a commercial nature such as boat, plane, nonoperable automobile restoration,
etc. Such activities may be permitted within a residential district
subject to the issuance of a temporary use permit by the Planning
Director:
(2) The applicant for a temporary use permit for such purpose shall comply
with all of the following requirements:
(A) The proposed construction shall be of a type which will not be permanent,
to the site and which shall not require the issuance of a building
permit, such as for boat construction and car restoration;
(B) The construction shall not project into any required front or exterior
side yard;
(C) The proposed item for construction shall be for the personal use
of the applicant or the members of his or her immediate family;
(D) The proposed construction shall adhere to the requirements limiting excessive noise as set forth in Section
9-3.531 Noise Standards; and
(E) The temporary use permit shall be issued for a period not longer
than one year. Extensions may be granted subject to the approval of
the Planning Director.
(c) Model
homes and subdivision sales offices.
(1) General requirements. Temporary model homes and subdivision sales
offices may be erected and maintained in conjunction with approved
subdivisions in the City. Such uses shall be restricted to the first
sales of lots or units within approved subdivisions and shall be subject
to the following:
(A) All temporary elevation alterations of homes for commercial purposes
shall be subject to prior approval by the Planning Director.
(B) The furnishings placed in a model home shall be maintained solely
for the purposes accessory to the display of the model home.
(C) Banners, posters, pennants, ribbons, streamers, strings of light
bulbs, spinners and other moving devices shall be prohibited.
(2) Use and occupancy. Temporary certificates of use and occupancy for
the operation of model homes and subdivisions sales offices shall
be issued by the Division of Building and Safety upon approval by
the Planning Director, subject to record of administrative approval.
(3) Enforcement. Any violation of this Code pertaining to the operation
or occupancy of model homes or subdivision sales offices shall be
cause for the revocation of any use and occupancy permit previously
issued for any model home or subdivision sales office.
(d) Temporary
residences and temporary caretaker residences.
(1) Outside the Floodplain Management District.
(A) Temporary residences or temporary caretaker residences located outside
the Floodplain Management District are subject to the following requirements:
(i)
Temporary residences or temporary caretaker residences shall
be listed as a permitted use in the applicable district; and
(ii)
Temporary residences or temporary caretaker residences shall
meet all yard setback requirements of the applicable district.
(B) Temporary residences or temporary caretaker residences located outside
the Floodplain Management District are also subject the following
requirements:
(i)
Temporary residences and temporary caretaker residences shall
have a floor area no greater than 750 square feet; and
(ii)
Temporary residences and temporary caretaker residences shall
be removed no later than nine months after the issuance of the set-up
permit for the permanent primary residence or temporary caretaker
residence or upon the issuance of the “certificate of use and
occupancy” for the permanent principal residence, permanent
caretaker residence, or permanent use, whichever occurs first.
(C) The set-up permit for the temporary residence or temporary caretakers
residence shall not be used until after the issuance of the building
permit for the permanent principal residence, permanent caretakers
residence, or permanent use.
(D) In order to assure compliance with the requirements of this subsection, a cash deposit or other form of surety shall be deposited in accordance with Section
9-5.101 Fees, Deposits, and Bonds.
(e) Within
the Floodplain Management District. No temporary residences or temporary
caretakers residences shall be situated within the Floodplain Management
District.
(f) Use
of vehicles. The temporary use of a mobilehome, recreational vehicle,
truck, or other vehicle as a residence or commercial structure shall
not exceed 10 days in all districts.
(g) Temporary
classrooms for private schools. Temporary classrooms used at private
schools shall be subject to the regulations contained in City Council
Policy 415.
(Ord. No. 869, § 2)
(a) Purpose
and intent. The purpose and intent of this section is to establish
development standards that encourage the construction and operation
of upscale, high quality and appropriate uses that will benefit the
City’s economic core by providing convenient and attractive
downtown goods and services for visitors to the historic downtown,
Mission San Juan Capistrano, and the Los Rios Historic District, contributing
to the energy and economic vitality of the City’s downtown,
and strengthening the City’s economic base and fiscal circumstances
in order to support the provision of public services to the City’s
residents and businesses.
(b) Projects
proposed within the Town Center (TC) and Town Center Edge (TCE) Districts
shall be subject to applicable review procedures as set forth in Article
3, Development Review Procedures, of Chapter 2 of this title.
(c) For
sign, parking, fence, swimming pool, and similar regulations for the
Town Center (TC) and Town Center Edge (TCE) Districts, see Article
5, Supplementary District Regulations, of this chapter.
(d) Environmental
overlay standards. Standards related to management of project effects
on sensitive natural resources (i.e., floodplains, ridgelines, etc.)
shall be as set forth in Article 4, Environmental Overlay Districts,
of this chapter.
(e) General
requirements. This section provides standards for particular elements
of buildings/sites as well as certain operational standards to ensure
a consistent and high level of quality in building design, materials,
and operations. This section applies to the following within the Town
Center (TC) and Town Center Edge (TCE) Districts:
(1) Alterations, restoration, rehabilitation, ordinary repair and maintenance. For nonconforming structures, see Section
9-3.533.
(2) Demolition. See San Juan Capistrano Municipal Code, Title 8 and Title
9.
(3) Building entrances.
(A) The primary entrance shall be distinguished by architectural features
such as, but not limited to: an entry portal; change in material or
color; change in scale of other openings; addition of columns, lintels
or canopies.
(B) Secondary entrances shall have architectural features that are smaller
in height and width, with fewer or simpler architectural elements
than the primary entrance in scale and detail.
(4) Awnings and canopies. Awnings and/or canopies shall accentuate the
character-defining features of a building as follows:
(A) Awnings and canopies shall be mounted to highlight architectural
features such as moldings that may be found above the storefront.
(B) Awnings and canopies shall match the shape of the opening that they
are shading.
(C) Odd shapes and bubble awnings are prohibited except where the shape
of an opening requires a bubble awning, or a historic precedent shows
they have been previously used on the building.
(D) Canopies and awnings shall not conflict with the buildings’
proportions or with the shape of the openings that the awning or canopy
covers.
(E) Awnings and canopies may be constructed of metal, wood or fabric,
subject to the approval of the Development Services Director.
(F) Lights that illuminate the pedestrian way beneath the awning shall
be reviewed by the Development Services Director to determine if they
are appropriate for their context:
(i)
Lights may illuminate the storefront;
(ii)
Internally illuminated awnings that glow are prohibited.
(5) Walls (street screen) and fences.
(A) Site walls and fences shall not be erected in such a way as to block
views of or from public spaces and are not allowed where a frontage
is required.
(B) Low walls (24 inches to 36 inches in height) may be used to divide
space, in landscape areas and to define site edges.
(C) Screening elements such as landscaping, fencing, etc., shall be used
to screen service areas, storage areas, or garbage areas from public
view from the street or pedestrian ways.
(D) Solid walls (up to 96 inches in height) are permitted to screen mechanical
equipment, garbage receptacles, loading areas and other unsightly
areas; and provide privacy at the back of lots and along streets in
compliance with the requirements for frontages.
(E) All chain link fences are prohibited except for dark vinyl coated
chain link fences used in conjunction with landscape buffering and
screened with plantings.
(6) Lighting. Site lighting shall be designed and maintained consistent
with the Title 9, Land Use Code lighting standards and the City’s
Architectural Design Guidelines.
(7) Service areas and mechanical equipment. Services areas and mechanical
equipment areas shall be designed and maintained consistent with the
Title 9, Land Use Code supplemental regulations and the City’s
Architectural Design Guidelines.
(8) Outdoor storage and display. Outdoor storage and display areas shall
be designed and maintained consistent with the Title 9, Land Use Code
supplemental regulations and the City’s Architectural Design
Guidelines.
(9) Public gathering spaces. A public gathering space is a space within
a private development project that the general public can readily
access to view and enjoy, and is designed to accommodate community
gatherings, passive uses or recreation.
(A) A public gathering space shall be designed as an “outdoor room”
in the form of a plaza, green or square and shall include public amenities
such as, but not limited to, high-quality hardscape, pergolas, gazebos,
potted plants, strung lighting, fountains, fire pits, high-quality
furniture (e.g., benches, chairs, tables), and family games (e.g.,
bocci ball courts, bean bag toss, etc.).
(B) Direct access to the public gathering space by pedestrians from the
public right-of-way shall not be blocked or impeded by use of walls/fences,
landscaping, signage, or other devices. The use of decorative bollards
or potted plants spaced out appropriately to allow easy access may
be appropriate. Public access to the public gathering space shall
be fully compliant with the federal Americans with Disabilities Act
and applicable California law.
(C) Allowance for an increase in floor area ratio (FAR) above 0.75:1
and up to a maximum of 1.5:1 shall be accompanied by a public gathering
space of an area equivalent to 0.25 (25%) of the floor area above
0.75:1. The minimum area for any public gathering space shall equal
625 square feet and provide a minimum lineal dimension in any direction
of 25 feet.
Table 3-554-0. Public Gathering Space
(Sample Area Calculations based on a 10,000 sq. ft. Lot)
|
---|
FAR
|
Subtotal
|
Size of Public Gathering Space = 25% of Subtotal x (FAR - 0.75)
|
---|
1.0
|
10,000
|
625 sq. ft.
|
1.25
|
12,500
|
1,250 sq. ft.
|
1.5
|
15,000
|
1,875 sq. ft.
|
(10) General public right-of-way requirements. The following standards
are to be applied to streets, open space and any other right-of-way.
Street furnishings are exterior amenities, including but not limited
to, tables, chairs, umbrellas, landscape pots, wait stations, valet
stations, bicycle racks, planters, benches, bus shelters, kiosks,
waste receptacles and similar items that help to define pedestrian
use areas:
(A) Prohibited street furnishings. The following street furnishings are
prohibited within the right-of-way (street or open space):
(iii)
Automated machines (except ATMs); and
(iv)
Inanimate figures such as animals, mannequins or any such cartoon
or human figure. This section does not affect public art as defined
in Appendix A of this Code.
(B) Street furnishing materials:
(i)
Street furnishings shall be made of wood, metal, stone, terra
cotta, cast stone, hand-sculpted concrete, or solid surfacing material;
(ii)
Plastic resin furnishings are prohibited.
(f) Development
and operational standards.
(1) No person shall develop, establish, operate or conduct any use in
violation of any of the following regulations:
(A) Building placement and type:
(i)
Buildings shall be located on the lot and configured as allowed
in Figure 3-554-1 below.
(ii)
Building façades shall conform to the frontage standards
identified in subsection (b)(2).
Figure 3-554-1. Development Standards in the Town Center
(TC) and Town Center Edge (TCE) Districts
|
(B) Floor area ratio (FAR).
(i)
A maximum floor area ratio (FAR) of 0.75 is permitted within
the TC and TCE Districts.
(ii)
Up to 1.5 FAR is permitted for building(s) providing public
gathering space(s), according the standards established in subsection
(e)(9).
(C) Building configuration.
(i)
Buildings shall comply with the standards in Table 3-554-1 below:
Table 3-554-1. Building Placement and Configuration Standards
in the Town Center (TC) and Town Center Edge (TCE) Districts. This
table corresponds with Figure 3-554-1
|
---|
Standards
|
TC and TCE Districts
|
---|
Placement/Type
|
Min.
|
Max.
|
---|
a Lot width
|
50′
|
200′
|
b Lot depth
|
50′
|
NA
|
c Front setback F
|
0′
|
10′
|
d Side street setback F
|
0′
|
15′
|
e Side setback FC
|
0′
|
NA
|
f Rear setback A
|
10′
|
NA
|
Notes:
|
---|
F -
|
As specified for the selected frontage type.
|
FC -
|
Fire Code - building protection per local fire/safety code.
|
Standards
|
TC and TCE Districts
|
---|
Configuration
|
Min.
|
Max.
|
---|
g Building height (stories)
|
1
|
2 R/3 H
|
h Building height (feet)
|
10′ R
|
35′ R/45′H
|
i Ground floor level S
|
2′
|
4′
|
j Ground floor height S
|
10′ R
|
20′ R
|
k Landscape
|
per City design review
|
Notes:
|
---|
H -
|
Hotel
|
R -
|
Subject to requirements of Frontage.
|
S-
|
Measured vertically from average adjacent sidewalk grade. Sidewalk
grade must comply with ADA requirements.
|
A -
|
Where an alley provides vehicular access, minimum setback is
5 feet.
|
(D) Frontages and encroachments.
(i)
Buildings in locations identified in Figure 3-554-3 shall incorporate
the frontages identified in the appropriate Frontage Zone, as described
below, to the satisfaction of the City’s Design Review Committee.
(FR-1) Frontage Zone 1: Camino Capistrano and Ortega Highway.
Frontages in the FR-1 zone are pedestrian-oriented and for the purpose
of accommodating ground floor shopping, restaurants and other sidewalk-dependent
land uses. Buildings are near or at the sidewalk with massing that
spatially defines the streetscape. This frontage zone is the most
intense of the four frontage zones. Allowed frontages provide pedestrians
and storefronts with shade and open views into ground floors.
(FR-2) Frontage Zone 2: Camino Real, Verdugo, Forster. Frontages
in the FR-2 zone are pedestrian-oriented and for the purpose of accommodating
ground floor shopping, restaurants and other sidewalk-dependent land
uses. The FR-2 zone does not include the Historic Town Center Park
frontage. Buildings are near or setback from the sidewalk with massing
that spatially defines the streetscape and/or public open space. This
frontage zone is the second most intense of the four frontage zones.
Allowed frontages vary from providing pedestrians and storefronts
with shade and open views into ground floors to providing active building
façades along public open space.
(FR-3) Frontage Zone 3: Avenida del Obispo, Camino Capistrano
(south). Frontages in the FR-3 zone are pedestrian-oriented and for
the purpose of accommodating ground floor shopping, restaurants and
other sidewalk-dependent land uses. Buildings are near or setback
from the sidewalk with massing that spatially defines the streetscape.
This frontage zone is the third most intense of the four frontage
zones. Allowed frontages vary from providing pedestrians and storefronts
with shade and open views into ground floors to providing active building
façades along public open space.
(FR-4) Frontage Zone 4: Camino Capistrano (north), El Camino
Real (north), Spring Street. Frontages in the FR-4 zone range from
pedestrian-oriented and for the purpose of accommodating ground floor
shopping, restaurants and other sidewalk-dependent land uses to defining
the edges of the historic mission and nearby properties. Buildings
and/or existing perimeter walls are near or setback from the sidewalk
with massing that spatially defines the streetscape. This frontage
zone is the least intense of the four frontage zones. Allowed frontages
vary from providing pedestrians and storefronts with shade and open
views into ground floors to enclosing the private gardens on the historic
mission.
(ii)
Buildings shall be designed with the frontage types identified
in Table 3-554-2 and accompanying Figure 3-554-2 to the satisfaction
of the City’s Design Review Committee.
(iii)
Building elements may encroach into setbacks as identified in
Figure 3-554-2.
Figure 3-554-2. Frontage and Encroachment Standards in
the Town Center (TC) and Town Center Edge (TCE) Districts
|
Table 3-554-2. Frontage and Encroachment Standards in
the Town Center (TC) and Town Center Edge (TCE) Districts
|
---|
Standards
|
TC and TCE Districts % of Lot Frontage
|
---|
Frontage Location
|
Min.
|
Max.
|
---|
P Along “primary street”
|
100%
|
n.a.
|
S Along “secondary street”
|
65%
|
100%
|
E Allowed frontages encroaching into the public right-of-way
(encroachment permit required)
|
Arcade
|
See Frontage standards.
|
Gallery
|
|
|
F Allowed frontages
|
Storefront and awning
|
See Frontage standards
|
Forecourt
|
|
|
Stoop
|
|
|
Terrace (Dooryard)
|
|
|
Porch and wall/fence
|
|
|
The letter references above relate to Figure 3-554.2
|
Figure 3-554-3. Frontages in the Town Center (TC) and
Town Center Edge (TCE) Districts
|
(E) Parking and above-ground utilities.
(i)
Parking and above-ground utilities shall be located on the lot
as shown in Figure 3-554-4 and Table 3-554-3. To the extent possible,
utilities shall be underground and/or in alleys.
(ii)
For allowable parking standards, see Section
9-3.535(h).
Figure 3-554-4. Parking and Screening Development Standards
in the Town Center (TC) and Town Center Edge (TCE) Districts
|
Table 3-554-3. Parking and Screening Development Standards in
the Town Center (TC) and Town Center Edge (TCE) Districts
|
---|
Standards
|
Setback
|
Screening, notes
|
---|
Parking Location
|
|
|
---|
a Front setback
|
50′
|
Building, wall, or hedge; 3′ min. height. S
|
b Rear setback to alley
|
5′
|
No screening required.
|
c Rear setback—no alley
|
10′
|
Wall or fence; 5′ min. height.
|
d Max. above ground plane
|
N.A.
|
1 story with wall or fence, 5′ min. height; 3 stories
for hotel with architectural design and landscaping incorporated.
|
e Side street setback
|
5′
|
Wall or hedge; 3′ min. height. S
|
Notes:
|
---|
S-
|
Measured vertically from average adjacent sidewalk grade.
|
(2) Frontage types. The following frontages apply to the various blocks
and streets within the TC and TCE Districts as identified in Figure
3-554-3. Figures 3-554-5 through 3-554-11 identify the allowed frontages
for each block and street. Tables 3-554-4 through 3-554-10 identify
the requirements for how a building is to address the lot’s
frontage line(s). Buildings shall be designed with vertical and horizontal
mass articulation and upper floors shall be set back from lower floors
to the satisfaction of the City’s Design Review Committee.
(A) Arcade.
(i)
Arcades are composed of a building with ground floor façades
which align with the property line, and upper floors which project
over the property line to cover the sidewalk. A colonnade structurally
and visually supports the building mass which encroaches into the
public right-of-way. An encroachment permit or license agreement may
be required prior to issuance of a building permit. Arcades contain
ground-floor storefronts, making them ideal for retail use. Landscaping
is strongly encouraged. Vines may be employed at the arcade columns
and shall be planted on grade in vine pockets located between the
columns and street curb. Planter boxes or pots may be placed in between
columns to provide enclosure for such uses as café or restaurant
seating.
(ii)
Design standards.
a.
Arcades shall be large enough in dimension to allow passage
along the sidewalk without impediments both horizontally and vertically.
b.
Arcades may be combined with the storefront frontage type.
c.
Arcades may encroach over the sidewalk in the public right-of-way,
subject to the issuance of an encroachment permit or license agreement
prior to issuance of a building permit.
d.
Column spacing and colonnade detailing shall be consistent with
the style of the building to which it is attached.
e.
Columns shall be placed in relation to curbs so as to allow
passage around and to allow for passengers of cars to disembark. Clearances
per table below.
Table 3-554-4.
Frontage Standards, Arcade
|
---|
Standards
|
Arcade
|
Storefront
|
---|
Arcade
|
Min.
|
Max.
|
Min.
|
Max.
|
---|
a. Height (clear from sidewalk grade to ceiling)
|
12′
|
16′
|
See Figure 3-554-5
|
b. Depth (façade to interior column face)
|
10′
|
16′
|
n/a
|
n/a
|
c. Depth (exterior column face to street curb)
|
2′
|
14′
|
n/a
|
n/a
|
(B) Gallery.
Figure 3-554-6. Gallery
|
Gallery Example - a one-story version with colonnade, roof,
and open deck which shades both the sidewalk and storefront display
windows.
|
Gallery diagram - storefront and columns making up the gallery.
|
(i)
Gallery frontages are composed of a building where the façade
is aligned on the front property line and includes an attached cantilevered
shed, or a roof or deck supported by a colonnade overlapping the sidewalk.
Galleries may be two stories in height, with the upper portion
of the Gallery being open loggias or decks. Galleries contain ground-floor
storefronts, making them ideal for retail use.
Landscaping may be required. Vines may be employed at the gallery
columns and shall be planted on grade in vine pockets located at the
columns. Planter boxes or pots may be placed adjacent to columns to
provide enclosure for such uses as cafe or restaurant seating. Pottery
may be used where possible.
(ii)
Design standards.
a.
Galleries shall be large enough in dimension to allow passage
along the sidewalk without impediments both horizontally and vertically.
b.
Galleries may be combined with the storefront frontage type.
c.
Galleries may encroach over the sidewalk in the public right-of-way,
subject to the issuance of an encroachment permit or license agreement
prior to issuance of a building permit.
d.
Column spacing and colonnade detailing shall be consistent with
the style of the building to which it is attached, and to the satisfaction
of the City’s Design Review Committee.
e.
Columns shall be placed in relation to curbs so as to allow
passage around column’s and to allow for passengers of cars
to disembark. Clearances per table below.
Table 3-554-5. Frontage Standards, Gallery
|
---|
Standards
|
Gallery
|
Storefront
|
---|
Gallery
|
Min.
|
Max.
|
Min.
|
Max.
|
a. Height 1st level (from sidewalk grade to ceiling)
|
10′
|
16′
|
See Figure 3-554-6
|
b. Height 2nd level (from sidewalk grade)
|
21′
|
26′
|
n/a
|
n/a
|
c. Depth (façade to interior column face)
|
6′
|
16′
|
n/a
|
n/a
|
d. Depth (exterior column face to street curb)
|
2′
|
14′
|
n/a
|
n/a
|
(C) Storefront and Awning
Figure 3-554-7. Storefront and Awning
|
Storefront and Awning Example - large glazing area of display
window, tile bulkhead under window, glass door, clerestory and shade
awning.
|
|
Storefront and Awning diagram - elements and dimensions making
up the frontage.
|
(i)
Storefront and awning is the frontage type for buildings with
ground floor commercial/retail uses. The frontage is made by insertion
of large openings filled with transparent windows at the ground level
façades. The façade is located near or at the property
line. Recessed storefronts are allowed. The building entrance is at
the grade of the sidewalk and provides direct access to the commercial/
retail uses on the ground floor.
The basic architectural elements comprising the storefront are
large windows, doors with glass, clerestory glass, and a solid base
(bulkhead). Optional elements include awnings, cantilevered shed roof
or canopy, signage, lighting, and cornices. Awnings, shed roofs, or
canopies are optional and may encroach into the public right-of-way
and cover the sidewalk within a few feet of the curb. Awnings, signage,
and other encroachments shall comply with this Code for minimum height
above sidewalk grade for safety. See Table 3-554-6.
Landscaping may be required for this frontage type. Vines grown
in vine pockets at the building façade are allowed and may
encroach into the public way. Pottery may be used where possible.
(ii)
Design standards.
a.
Storefronts shall be tall enough to provide adequate view into
ground floor spaces.
b.
Storefronts may occur at the property line.
c.
Storefront glass shall be clear without reflective glass or
dark tinting, frosting.
d.
Storefront windows may have clerestory windows (horizontal panels)
between the storefront and second floor. Glass in clerestory windows
may be of a character to allow light, while moderating it as the clerestory
is located above awnings such as stained glass, glass block, painted
glass, or frosted glass.
e.
Storefront bulkhead shall be of material similar or complementary
to main materials of the building.
Table 3-554-6. Frontage Standards, Storefront and Awning (See
Figure 3-554-7)
|
---|
Standards
|
Storefront
|
Awning
|
---|
Storefront & Awning
|
Min.
|
Max.
|
Min.
|
Max.
|
---|
a. Height 1st level (from sidewalk grade to top
of opening)
|
10′
|
16′
|
8′
|
18′
|
b. Width
|
6′
|
20′
|
8′
|
20′
|
c. Height (bulkhead)
|
8″
|
2′
|
-
|
-
|
d. Depth of entrance recess
|
0′
|
3′
|
10′ or 50% of sidewalk width, whichever is less for 65%
of façade
|
-
|
e. Glass area (% of ground façade)
|
65%
|
n/a
|
n/a
|
n/a
|
(D) Forecourt.
Figure 3-554-8. Forecourt
|
Forecourt Example - a brick wall and metal gate form the forecourt
for this building, comprising1/3 of the building’s façade.
|
(i)
Forecourts are open or semi-enclosed areas adjacent to the sidewalk
made from setting back a portion of the building façade from
the front property line. Typically, the setback portion is the middle
section, which creates a small entry court. This can also be achieved
by setting back the façade when a building’s neighboring
structures have zero set- back at their respective property lines.
Forecourts may be combined with other frontage types as allowed
by this Code. Forecourts may be further defined by low walls or landscape
between the sidewalk and adjacent property line. Forecourts may be
landscaped or paved. Landscape may include lawn, grasses, small shrubs,
and accent trees with sufficiently transparent canopies to allow views
of the building façade.
(ii)
Design standards.
a.
Forecourts dimensions per Table 3-554-7.
b.
Forecourts may be elevated from the adjacent sidewalk as allowed
by this code. An elevated forecourt shall meet accessibility code
for access with the building and the sidewalk.
Table 3-554-7. Frontage Standards, Forecourt (See Figure 3-554-8)
|
---|
Standards
|
Depth
|
Width
|
Height*
|
---|
Forecourt
|
Min.
|
Max.
|
Min.
|
Max.
|
Min.
|
Max.
|
---|
a. Dimensions
|
10′
|
Fore-court width
|
10′
|
1/3 Bldg. Façade
|
-
|
-
|
b. Wall
|
n/a
|
n/a
|
n/a
|
n/a
|
1′
|
1 story
|
c. Fence
|
n/a
|
n/a
|
Na/
|
n/a
|
3′
|
4′
|
*
|
Measured vertically from average adjacent sidewalk grade.
|
(E) Stoop.
Figure 3-554-9. Stoop
Stoop Example - stairs, landing, and landscape area of a typical
stoop.
Stoop diagram- elements and dimensions making up the stoop frontage
type.
|
(i)
Stoops are exterior stairs with landings which provide access
to buildings located at their front property lines. The ground floor
of the building is raised to provide some privacy for the rooms facing
the public street and passersby. The exterior stairs can be perpendicular
or parallel to the adjacent sidewalk. The landing may be covered or
uncovered. Landscaping shall be placed on the sides of the stoop at
grade or in raised planters. Demarcating garden walls is allowed subject
to this Code.
(ii)
Design standards.
a.
Stoops shall be of such dimensions to allow for easy access
to the ground floor of the building. See Table 3-554-8:
Table 3-554-8. Frontage Standards, Stoop
(See Figure 3-554-9)
|
---|
Standards
|
Depth
|
Width
|
Height*
|
---|
Stoop
|
Min.
|
Max.
|
Min.
|
Max.
|
Min.
|
Max.
|
---|
a. Dimensions
|
3′
|
-
|
3′
|
-
|
2′
|
3′
|
b. Wall
|
n/a
|
n/a
|
n/a
|
n/a
|
1′
|
4′
|
c. Fence
|
n/a
|
n/a
|
n/a
|
n/a
|
2′
|
3′
|
*
|
Maximum height one story for stoop cover.
|
(F) Terrace.
(i)
The terrace frontage sets back the building façade back
from the front property line, and places an elevated garden or terrace
in that setback. Terraces are enclosed by a low wall at or near the
property line with a stair or ramp from the sidewalk up onto the terrace.
The building activities are slightly separated from the adjacent sidewalk
by the terrace height, and the depth of the terrace provides a buffer.
The buffer provides clear area distinctions for commercial uses such
as dining patios, and provides private yards and residences secure
buffers from public encroachment.
(ii)
Design standards.
a.
Terrace dimensions per Table 3-554-9.
b.
Terrace may be enclosed by low walls or fences. Walled terraces
may additionally have fences to provide for safety.
Table 3-554-9. Frontage Standards, Terrace
(See Figure 3-554-10)
|
---|
Standards
|
Depth
|
Width
|
Height
|
---|
Terrace
|
Min.
|
Max.
|
Min.
|
Max.
|
Min.
|
Max.
|
---|
a. Terrace yard
|
Per Bldg. Setback
|
0′
|
Lot width
|
0.5′
|
3.5′
|
|
b. Wall or fence
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
0′
|
5′
|
(G) Porch and wall/fence.
Figure 3-554-11. Porch and Fence
Porch and Fence Example - low wall creates privacy for front
yard, while maintaining relationship with sidewalk and street for
neighborhood character and security.
Porch and Fence diagram - low wall at property line and minimum
porch size attached to building.
|
(i)
The porch and fence consists of a building with a front set
back from the property line, and a porch attached to it, and a wall
or fence at or near the property line. The porch and fence encroach
into the front setback. The porch shall have dimensions (per table
this page) which allow a useful space which is raised above the average
front grade of the lot.
This frontage provide the necessary physical separation from
the public sidewalk and the private lot, while maintaining visual
connection between buildings and the public space of the street.
(ii)
Design standards.
a.
Porch and fence dimensions as identified in Table 3-554-10.
Table 3-554-10. Frontage Standards, Porch and Fence
(See Figure 3-554-11)
|
---|
Standards
|
Depth
|
Width*
|
Height**
|
---|
Porch and Fence
|
Min.
|
Max.
|
Min.
|
Max.
|
Min.
|
Max.
|
---|
a. Porch
|
8′
|
-
|
40%
|
80%
|
1.5′
|
3.5′
|
b. Wall of fence
|
0′
|
5′
|
n/a
|
n/a
|
1′
|
4′
|
*
|
Width: based on percentage of building façade width.
|
**
|
Porch deck height: above average adjacent sidewalk grade.
|
(3) Architectural style standards. Buildings within the TC and TCE Districts
shall utilize one of the following architectural styles to the satisfaction
of the City’s Design Review Committee. Figures 3-554-12 through
3-554-16 identify the allowed architectural styles for each block
and street. Each architectural style provides a narrative description
of the characteristics commonly utilized. Similar to the frontage
standards, buildings shall be designed with vertical and horizontal
mass articulation and upper floors shall be set back from lower floors.
(A) Mediterranean Revival.
Figure 3-554-12. Mediterranean Revival
|
The Mediterranean Revival style is a part of the vast
Eclectic movement of 1890-1940 in the U.S. Mediterranean Revival is
the broad term which includes several architectural styles including
the Spanish Colonial Revival, Mission Revival, and Italianate. Inspired
by precedents from Classical, Medieval, and Renaissance periods, Mediterranean
Revival draws from those origin periods and cultural traditions -
Spanish, North African Moorish, Italian, Greek. It also incorporates
these same cultures’ later colonial efforts in North and South
America (1690-1800), which adapted to new indigenous climates, materials,
and cultures. Mediterranean Revival is distinguished by its restrained,
horizontal massing. Smooth plaster walls, light earth tone or off-white
colors, deeply set windows and doors, and red tile roofs [or flat
roofs] make up the signature palette. The generally bulky mass of
the building is punctuated by rhythmic placement of deeply set windows
and doors, which can be regular or syncopated. A regular rhythm is
typically varied by window type or window treatment to prevent repetition.
Color and decoration are used sparingly as compared with other styles,
these items being reserved for such details as wrought iron railings,
grilles, and gates, or stone and colorful tile surrounds at key doors,
windows, and water features. Shading is provided by the deeply recessed
openings, as well as devices [arcades, galleries, overhangs, balconies,
awnings] which are arranged as counterpoints to the austere building
forms.
(B) Main Street Commercial.
Figure 3-554-13. Main Street Commercial
|
Main Street Commercial is the generic stylistic title
for a multi-story building found on most U.S. main streets (hence
the term), town squares, and plazas. The style is derived from a number
of historic precedents, including Spanish Colonial Revival, Greek
Revival, Victorian, Victorian Italianate, and Richardsonian Romanesque.
While varying in stylistic details, the basis of the style is found
in a simple, rectangular building form made up of a logical, repetitive,
and legible structural framework which is expressed externally by
the rhythmic placement of structural elements, doors, windows, and
storefronts. Original building frameworks were of load-bearing masonry,
but the style is easily adapted to steel, poured concrete, or wood.
The building type and style proliferated in the late nineteenth century
when cities began densifying and housing was built over ground floor
store fronts. The Main Street Commercial style building stands adjacent
to others of similar building type (flex block, lined block, row house),
with little or no side setbacks, thus forming a solid enclosure for
the street or square. This means that only one façade (or two
if located on a corner) need detailed design attention. The plane
of the façade wall is articulated by expression of the structural
underlayment by means of vertical protrusions or setbacks defining
columns and lintels. The façade is articulated into a base,
a body, and a top, with the ground floor base being the tallest of
the individual floors. The style tops the building with a flat roof
line which is stopped visually by a projecting cornice or articulated
parapet (protruding or recessed). The ground floor houses commercial
uses such as offices or retail businesses, and therefore is quite
open visually with expansive storefront windows and doors. Upper levels
are punctuated with relatively smaller openings which belie their
purpose for offices or apartments. Substantial materials express the
civic nature of the style, using brick, stone, or heavy cementitious
plaster.
(C) Agricultural Heritage.
Figure 3-554-14. Agricultural Heritage
|
Agricultural Heritage style is based on structures built
specifically for agricultural purposes in the U.S. during the 19th
Century. This tradition is found in San Juan Capistrano and in California.
Using the forms, materials and colors of these purposeful precedents
in new buildings, where appropriate, helps maintain a continuum of
the vernacular of the region. Buildings utilizing this style would
be made of simple, limited forms (one form for one use), typically
rectangular, with a pitched metal roof, and sheathed in wood or metal
siding. There is little architectural ornament, with functional building
elements providing the detail to the building. These would include
items such as roof, rafter tails, ridge beams (protruding), overhangs
and struts, lanterns, clerestories, exposed columns, and exposed foundations.
Colors used for these structures were traditionally muted, as the
paints were derived from milk and a minimal amount of pigment. Original
agricultural buildings were single purpose-built for distinct agricultural
processes, and hence, this was not a style. The buildings represent
a distinct change in architecture for the region in the 1800s. Several
factors changed the way Californians built, shifting from handmade
masonry Spanish Colonial buildings, to the more expedient wood “balloon
framed” buildings. The Gold Rush of 1849, the Homestead Act
of 1862, and the development of the railroads brought property ownership
for new waves of citizens, displaced native peoples, and changed settlement
patterns. Houses were made quickly of wood to establish the farming
homestead, Example: Agricultural heritage present in new building—simple
massing, useful porches (galleries), wood siding and were either placed
in a rural pattern of isolated farmsteads, or in loose townships.
This was in contrast to Spanish Colonial and Eastern U.S. patterns
of contained urban villages with farmlands beyond. During the period
of change, newcomers built from their memories of the East or Midwest,
or used simple technical manuals called “pattern books.”
Both these manners changed the style and method of building, with
pioneers using the “balloon frame” technique in the 1840s
and 1850s. Buildings were made of wood which was mill-cut, in standardized
board sizes, and fastened with standard, manufactured nails. This
was a much faster way to build than using the traditional masonry.
It allowed anyone to easily build the framework of the house which
was then covered with siding. Along with the “pattern books”
and balloon framing came the firm tradition of agricultural buildings
and methods of farming in the East and Midwest. Farming there had
established a tradition of purposebuilt structures made with no adornment
and with materials found readily at hand. Structures were pragmatic,
and generally constructed for a distinct, single purpose, such as
silos to hold grain, barns to house livestock, water cisterns to collect
water, etc. As most locations had access to trees, lumber became the
primary material for agricultural out-buildings. Railroad development
increased access to mechanized wood working tools, and to light metals,
which helped create more standardized shapes/forms, more weather-tight
techniques, and more long-lasting roofing/siding methods.
(D) Craftsman.
Figure 3-554-15. Craftsman
|
The Arts and Crafts movement of the late 1880s had its
origins in England, led by Architect William Morris. He and the English
Arts and Crafts Exhibition Society inspired U.S. architects such as
Bernard Maybeck, Gustav Stickley, and brothers Charles and Henry Greene
of Pasadena, California who evolved the style. This style treated
all parts of the home—both exterior and interior—as artwork,
focusing on honest use and detailing of natural materials such as
redwood, stone, brick, tile, and copper. Greene and Greene Architects
designed the paradigmatic works which are located in Pasadena. They
also designed modest, inexpensive and low- profile bungalow homes
in the region. Popular magazines of the time (1909), such as Good
Housekeeping, made the style familiar to the general public. Pattern
book makers, in turn, made the Craftsman style house the most reproduced
style in the country. Pre-cut lumber packages soon became available
as well to assist contractors in building the style. Craftsman’s
interior/exterior space relationship and its adaptability to varying
weather conditions allowed regional variations to easily occur, thus
increasing its popularity. Building massing is a simple rectangle
or square with horizontal proportions in one- and two-story volumes.
An additional third floor is sometimes concealed within the volume
of the roof with the assistance of dormers. Additional volumes are
sometimes attached to the main mass, which receive independent roof
forms. Porches are numerous and generous in depth. Roofs are large,
low-pitched forms, and vary from 3:12 to 6:12. In larger two story
versions, it is common for gabled roofs to have a high pitch as much
as 10:12. Roof eaves project a minimum of two feet over the wall,
and have exposed rafter tails. Gable roof projections are supported
by large timber braces or extended beams. Walls receive horizontally
oriented wood siding or shingles, and the foundation base is expresses
with stucco, brick or river stone. Windows and doors are vertical
in proportion and are combined into horizontal patterns. They are
trimmed in large scale wood.
(E) Art Moderne.
Figure 3-554-16. Art Moderne
|
The Art Moderne is also called Streamline Moderne and
American Deco. The style was utilized from 1920 to 1940. It derived
from two sources: (1) Eliel Saarinen’s competition design for
the Chicago Tribune headquarters in Chicago which was largely of the
precedent style Art Deco; and (2) the streamlined graphic arts and
industrial design for ships, planes, autos, and even household appliances
which evolved Saarinen’s designs. Smooth surfaces, curved corners,
and horizontal emphasis gave the impression of smooth movement through
a stream of air, hence the term streamlined. Initially, Art Moderne
style was applied to commercial building types such as airport terminals,
railroad depots, and other transportation-related buildings. It then
became popular enough to grace public institutional buildings, and
eventually single-family homes. While not contributing any evolution
to floor plans or construction technology, the style represents still
a merging of the machine age in U.S. building styles. Building massing
is a simple rectangle or square with horizontal proportions in one-
and two-story volumes. The massing is asymmetrical. Additional volumes
are sometimes attached to the main mass, which receive independent
roof forms. There are no porches typically on this style. Roofs are
flat and hidden by parapet walls. Parapet wall edges are usually defined
by a small protruding ledge (coping) at roof line. These are sometimes
covered in metal with a striated, or linear pattern. Walls are smooth
stucco, with rounded corners at main volumes. Horizontal grooves or
lines are recessed into wall plaster. Details include steel pipe balustrades
give additional horizontal emphasis. Windows and doors are horizontal
in proportion and are continuous around corners. They are made of
metal. Glass blocks are used for windows or entire portions of walls,
and occasionally round windows are found in elevational compositions.
(F) Monterey.
Figure 3-554-17. Monterey
|
In the early part of the 18th Century, Californians
sought to define an indigenous style of architecture by fusing local
Spanish-influences with Colonial designs. Used primarily for residential
properties, Monterey style buildings are typically two stories in
height with shallow pitched side gable roofs, and a second story cantilevered
covered balcony. Roofs are generally covered with clay tiles or asphalt
shingles and exterior wall surfaces can be finished in brick, stucco
or clapboard reflecting the fusion of Anglo and Hispanic styles. Windows
are often narrow and tall and are grouped in pairs. The balcony and
a side facing gable roof gives the building a dominant rectilinear
character. From the influence of Anglo settlers, hipped or gabled
roofs were added with a moderate slope and covered with wood shingles.
The balcony could possibly have originally been inspired by Spanish
townhouses but was affectionately adopted and modified by new settlers
from the eastern U.S. bringing traditional details with them. By the
1920s, eclecticism dominated a fast-growing and style-conscious American
culture and as such variations on the Monterey style are broad. Early
examples of the Monterey Style tend to favor Spanish detailing such
as tile roofs and carved balcony porch posts, while later examples
emphasize Colonial details, such as double hung multi-light windows
adorned with shutters and paneled entry doors.
(Ord. No. 1082, § 20,
2021)
(a) Purpose
and intent. The City of San Juan Capistrano finds and determines that
the purpose and intent of this section is to:
(1) Reduce traffic congestion which contributes to significant deterioration
of air quality and increase the efficient use of energy resources;
(2) Increase mobility, improve the overall efficiency of the City transportation
system by enhancing vehicular flow and shifting transportation demand
to facilities with available capacity; and
(3) Improve air quality and reduce noise levels associated with traffic.
(b) Applicability.
(1) The provisions of this section shall apply to all proposed nonresidential
development.
(2) The facility standards provisions of this section shall apply to
proposed nonresidential development projects based on projected number
of employees according to subsection (3) of this subsection and based
on
Table 3-43. For those facility standards which are discretionary,
the Planning Director shall have the authority to require the provision
of such improvements based on their trip reduction capability.
Table 3-43 Facilities Standards
|
---|
|
Number of Employees
|
---|
15-25
|
25-49
|
50-99
|
100-249
|
250+
|
---|
Rideshare Information Area
|
R
|
R
|
R
|
R
|
R
|
Secure Bike Storage
|
D
|
R
|
R
|
R
|
R
|
Preferential Parking
|
—
|
R
|
R
|
R
|
R
|
Rideshare Passenger Loading
|
—
|
D
|
R
|
R
|
R
|
Shower Facilities
|
—
|
—
|
D
|
R
|
R
|
Bus Turnout*
|
—
|
—
|
—
|
D
|
R
|
Central Lunchroom
|
—
|
—
|
D
|
D
|
R
|
(R: Required; D: Discretionary; —: Not Required)
|
*
|
Provided OCTA designates a bus stop adjacent to the project
site.
|
(3) For the purpose of determining whether a proposed development project
is subject to the provisions of this section, projected total number
of employees shall be determined based on the following:
(A) Employment projections shall be based on the proposed area (square
feet) of nonresidential development, the type of land use, and the
following “employee generation factors” included in Table
3-44:
Table 3-44
Employee Generation Factors
|
---|
Land Use
|
Building Area/Employee
|
---|
Commercial
|
500 square feet
|
Office
|
250 square feet
|
Industrial
|
525 square feet
|
Hotel
|
1.2 rooms
|
Others
|
Determined by City Engineer
|
(B) In cases where the applicant believes that the “employee generation
factors” of Table 3-44 are not appropriate, they may request
approval to use alternative “employee generation factors”
subject to review and approval by the Planning Director. The Planning
Director may approve such alternative “employee generation factors”
based on findings that they are based on comparable or more accurate
survey data conducted by a professionally recognized organization
and that they will result in a more accurate estimate of potential
employees for a given project.
(c) Facility standards. All nonresidential development projects which are required to provide rideshare facilities pursuant to subsection
(b) of this section shall comply with the following facility standards:
(1) Rideshare information area.
(A) Rideshare information areas shall be an area that provides employees
with information on available transportation alternatives to the single-occupancy
vehicle.
(B) The area shall be centrally located and accessible to all employees
or tenants.
(C) Information should include current routes and schedules for public
transit, ridesharing match lists, available employee incentives, and
ridesharing promotional material supplied by commuter-oriented organizations.
(2) Secure bicycle storage.
(A) Bicycle storage facilities for use by employees or tenants shall
be conveniently located in relationship to employee building entrances.
(B) Bike storage facilities shall be provided for five bicycles for every
100 employees or fraction thereof.
(3) Preferential parking.
(A) A minimum number of parking spaces restricted for use by “car/van
pool” vehicles shall be based on the following percentage of
total required parking:
Commercial Uses
|
4.5%
|
Office/Professional Uses
|
12.75%
|
Industrial/R&D Uses
|
13.5%
|
Hotel Uses
|
4.5%
|
(B) “Car/van pool” parking spaces shall be clearly designated
by surface painting and/or signs indicating “Carpool vehicle
use only” and will be located in close proximity to the employee
entrance to the building to the satisfaction of the Planning Director.
(4) Rideshare vehicle loading area.
(A) Loading areas shall be provided for rideshare vehicles in close proximity
to the building’s employee entrance(s).
(B) Rideshare vehicle loading areas will be sized to accommodate the
anticipated type of rideshare vehicle and should be designed in a
manner that does not impede vehicular circulation in the parking area.
(5) Employee shower facilities.
(A) Employee shower facilities for use by bicycle and pedestrian commuters
will be conveniently located and available to all employees.
(B) Employee shower facilities shall be provided at a minimum of two
for every 250 employees or fraction thereof.
(6) Bus turnouts.
(A) Bus stop improvements including bus pullouts, bus pads, and right-of
way for bus shelters may be required by the City Engineer for major
developments located along high traffic volume streets and established
bus routes based on the recommendation of the “Transit Authority”
which provides public bus service to the project site.
(B) Bus stop improvements will be designed to conform with standard traffic
engineering standards.
(7) Central lunchroom.
(A) Central lunchroom facilities will provide employees with on-site
food preparation and eating areas. Central lunchrooms shall provide
a minimum of 10 square feet per employee.
(B) Central lunchrooms shall include, at a minimum, a rangetop, refrigerator,
microwave, and sink.
(d) Transportation
Management Association (TMA) standards. All proposed nonresidential
development projects which consist of multi-tenant or multiple parcel
development shall be required to establish a Transportation Management
Association (TMA) within the conditions, covenants, and restrictions
(CC&R) for the property. The TMA provisions of the conditions,
covenants, and restrictions shall include the following elements:
(1) Establish TMA membership and operational procedures.
(2) Establish tenant responsibility to participate in the operation and
administration of the TMA and the implementation of TMA programs.
(3) Grant the TMA the authority to levy an assessment to finance the
programs and activities of the Association.
(4) Grant the TMA the authority to administer and implement rideshare
and trip reduction programs including but not limited to the following:
(A) Implement carpool, buspool, and/or vanpool programs;
(B) Fund a vanpool purchase program;
(C) Provide cash allowances, passes or other public transit subsidies;
(D) Impose parking fees or restrictions on single occupancy vehicles;
(E) Provide full or partial parking subsidies for ridesharing vehicles;
(F) Administer commuter rideshare matching service;
(G) Provide employees with guaranteed ride-home program for ridesharing;
(H) Limit service vehicle deliveries to non-peak hours;
(I) Provide on-site day care services;
(J) Pay cash bonuses for ridesharing;
(K) Provide housing including preferential financing, assistance, moving
expenses; and
(L) Assign staff responsibility for coordinating ridesharing activities.
(e) Implementation
and exceptions.
(1) All applicable nonresidential development projects shall demonstrate
compliance with the provisions of this section as part of the land
development application review process as follows:
(A) Facility standards shall be reviewed for compliance as part of the
“site plan review” or “architectural control”
application process.
(B) The establishment of a Transportation Management Association (TMA)
shall be subject to the review and approval of the Planning Director
as part of the “subdivision” or “site plan review”
process. The approved TMA document shall be recorded prior to the
issuance any grading/building permits.
(2) The Planning Director shall have the authority to grant exceptions
to the provisions of this section based on findings that the exception
is not contrary to the purpose and intent of this section and is consistent
with the provisions of the General Plan.
(f) Enforcement.
To assure compliance with this section, the City may withhold the
issuance of “building permits,” “certificates of
use or occupancy,” and/or “business licenses” for
a development project or its tenants until all required facility improvements
have been completed and/or any necessary CC&R documents have been
recorded.
(g) Definitions.
For the purposes of this section, unless otherwise apparent from the
context, certain words and phrases used in this section are defined
as follows:
"Development project"
means any proposed nonresidential proposal subject to a discretionary
review process including rezoning, subdivision, conditional use permit,
site plan review, or architectural control.
(Ord. No. 869, § 2; Ord. No. 1042, § 18, 2017)
(a) Purpose
and intent. The purpose and intent of this section is to provide for
the preservation and maintenance of existing trees within the City
while permitting reasonable use and development of properties containing
such trees, as well as the reasonable trimming and maintenance of
such trees.
(b) Severe
tree trimming regulations. No property owner or his or her agent in
any district in the City shall cause any tree on his or her property
to be severely trimmed, unless prior approval is given by the Planning
Director, upon recommendation of an arborist.
(1) Suggested tree trimming standards. The primary aim of trimming is
to preserve the health, beauty, and longevity of trees. Trimming for
such purpose will also make trees safer, more functional, and valuable.
Practices such as stub cuts, random branch removal, and topping (stubbing
back the entire crown) defeat the primary aim, create hazards, and
drastically reduce the monetary value of trees. Therefore, such practices
shall not be employed. The following standards identify trimming methods
which will give maximum benefits to both trees and people:
(A)
Types of cuts.
(i)
Removal of laterals,
(a)
Shoulder cuts. The final cut in removing a lateral branch should
be immediately beyond the branch bark ridges, preserving the branch
collar, as shown in Figure 3-6. Do not make stub cuts (an inch or
more beyond the branch collar). Do not make flush cuts (through the
branch collar).
(b)
Triple cuts. For any branch too large to be held while being
cut, remove by means of the following cuts, as shown in Figure 3-7:
(1)
Undercut the branch four inches to 10 inches beyond the base.
(2)
Cut off the branch beyond the undercut.
(3)
Remove the remaining stub via a shoulder cut as described above.
(ii)
Removal of terminals (tip thinning and drop crotching)
(a)
Thinning. “Lace out” the terminal portions of branches
by cutting the terminals back to the laterals as shown in Figure 3-8.
(The basal diameter of the remaining lateral should be 1/3 the diameter
of the terminal being removed.) Remove numerous small terminals and
laterals rather than taking out a few large ones.
(b)
Size reduction. To take out portions of the crown for reducing
height, remove the terminals back to the laterals as shown in Figure
3-9. Each lateral should be suitably situated to serve as the new
terminal, thus establishing the crown at a lower level. The basal
diameter of a lateral should be at least 1/3 the basal diameter of
the terminal being removed. (Laterals smaller than this cannot function
effectively as new terminals, and the effect is then similar to a
stub cut.)
Figure 3-9 Size Reduction
|
(B)
Pruning functions. Not all of
the following procedures will apply to any one tree, and two or more
may be performed more or less simultaneously. In most cases, however,
trimming done in the following general sequence will be more efficient
and will help avoid unnecessary trimming.
As a rule, not more than 1/4 of the total foliage mass should
be removed at one trimming. Exceptions are: (1) extreme thinning of
heavy crowns of brittle trees, such as lawn-grown (irrigated) kaffir-boom
coral trees, and (2) severe thinning of crowns to prevent blow-down
when root pruning is done.
(i)
Remove branches as needed and redirect new growth to clear pedestrian
and vehicular traffic areas, buildings, outdoor lights, walls, and
other objects, as well as trees and shrubs.
Do not make stub cuts on branches four inches or greater. Do
not cut terminals back to very small laterals. Retain a screen effect
as much as possible.
(ii)
Remove dead, broken, diseased, or markedly unthrifty branches.
(iii)
Remove crossing branches and those which will become crossing
branches (such as suckers, water sprouts, and branches growing vigorously
into the interior of the crown).
(iv)
Remove sharp-angled branches. Remove most branches arising at
angles of less than 30 degrees (Exceptions: eucalyptus and other species
which fuse at branch bases). If a narrow-angled branch needs to be
retained for the sake of form, it should be lightened and restricted
in growth to reduce the danger of wind breakage.
(v)
Remove parallel branches. If two branches within a foot or so
of each other run parallel for several feet along their main stems
the less desirable one should be taken out.
(vi)
Trim for balance and form.
(a)
To maintain the natural shape, if a tree grows in an unbalanced
manner which is atypical and unattractive, or which poses a potential
hazard (as may occur with aleppo pines, for example), remove such
branches as may need to be eliminated to restore more typical form
or to minimize the perceived hazard.
(b)
To alter the natural shape, for picturesque or formal effects
(for example, espaliers, hedges, sheared specimens, or “Japanese
garden” styles), trim in a manner and frequency appropriate
to the intended effect.
(vii)
Trim to reduce wind resistance. (Note: the use of dry habitat
trees, such as pinus radiata, eucalyptus species, and kaffirboom corral
(erythrina caffra), in irrigated lawns often results in shallow-rooted
specimens with excessively tall, heavily foliaged crowns. Such are
susceptible to blow-down or limb breakage in high winds. This usually
necessitates annual thinning. It does not call for topping: beheading
tall or dense trees ruins their form and vitality and intensifies
wind hazards in subsequent years.) This type of thinning should be
done by removing a large number of small branches rather than a few
large branches. The end effect should maintain most of the original
form, but with a lacy openness.
(2) Exceptions. The Planning Director or the Director of Public Works,
subject to the approval of the City Manager, may approve trimming
trees in a manner not typical of the natural form of the tree specie.
Such approval shall be based upon a finding that the resulting shape
is necessary for the public health and safety of the tree and the
community or consistency with a project design.
(3) Penalties and remedies. The City Council hereby finds and declares
that a violation of subsection (b) of this section is a public nuisance.
(A) Abatement. In addition to any other civil remedy available, the City
Council hereby establishes the following summary abatement procedure
pursuant to state law:
(i)
Notices to abate nuisances. The Enforcement Officer, upon finding
that any person has caused a violation of this subsection, and therefore
a public nuisance, shall cause a notice to be given to the violator
which shall order the violator to immediately cease and desist from
further violations of this section.
(B) Form of notices. The heading of the notice shall be “Notice
to Abate Public Nuisance—Severe Tree Trimming.” Such heading
shall be capitalized and on a form containing the following provisions:
Notice is hereby given by the City of San Juan Capistrano that you are violating Section 9-3.557 Tree Preservation of the Cites Municipal Code by causing the severe trimming of a tree. Section 9-3.557 Tree Preservation is attached.
|
You are hereby ordered to immediately cease and desist from
severe trimming of the tree(s). This condition is a public nuisance
and must be immediately abated. If this nuisance results in the destruction
or removal of the tree as determined by the Enforcement Officer, you
are also hereby ordered to immediately replace said tree(s) with mature
plantings of the same specie in the same location. If you do not do
so within 10 days, the City will cause said replacement, and the costs
of replacement, plus reasonable overhead costs, shall be assessed
upon the land, and said costs shall constitute a lien upon the land
until paid. If you have any objections to the proposed abatement order,
you are hereby notified to attend a hearing of the Planning Commission
of the City of San Juan Capistrano to be held on ________, 20____,
when evidence will be taken as to whether a nuisance exists, objections
will be heard to the abatement order, and a final decision will be
rendered.
|
Dated__________, 20_______.
Enforcement Officer
|
(C) Public hearings and determinations. Upon the conducting of a public
hearing, based upon the testimony and evidence introduced at the hearing,
the Planning Commission shall determine whether the circumstances
recited by the Enforcement Officer constitute a public nuisance. Upon
making a determination that there exists a public nuisance, the Planning
Commission may order that the property owner immediately cease and
desist from severe tree trimming and/or immediately order the City
abatement of the nuisance, all such costs to be made a lien against
the property upon which the trees are located.
(D) Public hearings regarding actual costs. Following the City abatement
of the public nuisance, the Enforcement Officer shall present to the
Planning Commission, during a public hearing, the total costs incurred
in the City abatement. The Planning Commission shall then adopt a
resolution making a finding as to the reasonable costs incurred in
the abatement. The costs of the abatement shall constitute a special
assessment against the parcel upon which the trees are located. After
the assessment is made and confirmed, it shall be a lien on the parcel.
The County Auditor-Controller shall then enter such assessment on
the County tax roll opposite the parcel of land in question.
(c) Tree removal regulations. The definitions, rules for compliance, identification of procedures, and other matters relating to the removal of trees on public and private property are set forth in Section
9-2.349 Tree removal permit.
(d) Definitions.
For the purposes of this section, the following definitions shall
apply:
"Tree"
shall mean any living woody perennial plant having a trunk
diameter greater than six inches, measured at a point three feet above
the ground.
"Severely trimmed"
shall mean the cutting of the branches and/or trunk of a
tree in a manner which will substantially reduce the overall size
of the tree area so as to destroy the existing symmetrical appearance
or natural shape of the tree in a manner which results in the removal
of main lateral branches leaving the trunk of the tree in a stub appearance.
"Stand of trees"
shall mean a cluster of trees existing of not less than four
trees.
(Ord. No. 869, § 2)
(a) In
accordance with the Urban Agriculture Incentive Zones Act (California
Government Code Section 51040 et seq.) and all amendments thereto,
this section establishes an urban agriculture incentive zone (UAIZ)
within the City. The UAIZ shall apply to the following zoning districts:
(1) Agriculture-Business (A).
(2) Residential/Agriculture (RA).
(3) General Open Space (GOS).
(b) As
authorized by the Act, the City may enter into UAIZ contracts with
landowners to use vacant, unimproved, or blighted lands for small-scale
agricultural use in exchange for tax incentives.
(c) As
authorized by the Act, the Director may adopt rules and regulations
for the implementation and administration of the UAIZ and UAIZ contracts.
(d) The
City shall not enter into a UAIZ contract or renew an existing UAIZ
contract after January 1, 2019, unless the Act is amended to authorize
contracts after that date. Any UAIZ contracts entered into pursuant
to the Act and this chapter on or before January 1, 2019 will be valid
and enforceable for the duration of the UAIZ contract.
(Ord. No. 1051 § 3, 2017)
(a) Intersection
visibility. On a corner lot in any district, no fence, wall, hedge,
or other barrier shall be erected, placed, planted, or allowed to
grow so as: (1) to materially impede vision above a height of three
feet the triangular area on the parkway side of the curb, at the intersection
of streets, which is bounded by the curbs (or a line parallel to and
six feet outside the traveled portion of the roadway if there is not
curb) and a line connecting the two points on the curb 25 feet from
the point of intersection of the curb tangents (see Figure 3-10);
or (2) to be in conflict with the vehicular sight distance requirements
of the current edition of the California Department of Transportation
Highway Design Manual.
(b) Driveway
visibility. In any district, no fence, wall, hedge, or other barrier
shall be erected, placed, planted, or allowed to grow so as to materially
impede vision above a height of three feet the triangular area on
the parkway side of the curb, located on both sides of a driveway
entrance. The triangular area is bounded on one side by: (1) the curb
along the street (or a line parallel to and six feet outside the traveled
portion of the roadway if there is not curb) from the intersection
of the street and driveway for a distance of 10 feet; (2) on a second
side for 10 feet inward along the driveway edge from the intersection
of the street and driveway; and (3) the third side, a line connecting
the two (see Figure 3-10).
Figure 3-10 Intersection/Driveway Visibility Requirements
(public/private streets)
|
(Ord. No. 869 § 2)